Scope of Job - Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited
Transcription
Scope of Job - Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Limited
Attachment-2 Page 1 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 Scope of Job JUSTIFICATION For the construction of the New MDPL HO at Sanganer-Jaipur Civil & structural works is required. This Tender enquiry is generated for floating the tender to limited parties for the taking up civil & structural works for the construction of the New MDPL HO at Sanganer. Delivery period - 8 Months Time Period is the essence of the contract. Party to complete job, in 8 months, from the date of placement of LOI/PO/FOA, whichever is earlier. Job site Address - HPCL Depot, Sitapura Industrial Area, Sanganer, Jaipur Scope of Job/Notes 1. The scope of job for the contractor shall be, but not limited to, construction of the MDPL HO building as per the technical specification, Schedule of Rates, Terms & conditions of the contract. 2. The scope shall be include but not limited to, excavation, PCC, RCC, building construction, all types of civil and structural works, construction of the parking sheds, sheeting, brick work, plaster, architectural works, aluminum works, painting works, plumbing and sanitary works, road crossings, drainage works, site grading, cleaning and micro grading, construction of roads & pavements, dismantling of old structures if any etc. as per the technical specifications, terms & conditions & schedule of rates. 3. Party to visit the site ands shall get acquainted with the present condition of the site before quoting. 4. Party has to submit the Quality Assurance Plan for the approval of EIC. 5. Party shall set up laboratory at site for the testing of the various materials at site. Following testing at the minimum shall be done at site. a. Sieve analysis for sand & aggregates b. Cube testing with UTM. c. Any other tests as per the IS or as per the directions of EIC. d. Silt content e. Moisture content f. Weight g. Compressive strength for bricks Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 2 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6. All the testing of the materials and the testing frequency shall be as per IS. 7. Party shall follow the procedures of the HPCL like the gate pass system, material accounting system etc. 8. For all the bought out items and materials to be used in the construction party shall take prior approval pf the EIC and shall form the part of QAP. 9. Party shall keep all the 10 CTE registers updated. Sample of the registers are attached. 10. Party shall follow the SHE procedures of HPCL. 11. Party shall ensure very good house keeping, cleaning at site at all the times during the construction. 12. Only the First Quality material from the approved vendor list shall be used by the contractor. 13. Contractor shall arrange for its own water, electricity, site office etc. All the material, labour, tools, machinery shall be arranged by the contractor. Cost of all the material, labour, tools tackles and machinery if any shall be included in rates quoted by the contractor. 14. Contractor to ensure the deputation of manpower as per the key construction personnel schedule. 15. Contractor shall be responsible for workmanship, quality of construction and shall rectify defects if any as per the direction of EIC. 16. Contractor shall take all the levels before starting of any works and after completion of any works. The level shall be offered for joint verification and after the joint verification the levels shall recorded in the proper CTE registers/formats. No payments will be made to the contractor in the absence of verified levels. 17. Cement shall be of approved brand and shall be PPC-53 grade. 18. In case of contradiction between the various specifications & SOR the decision of EIC shall be final & binding. 19. Contractor shall keep the site in very good & beat condition. Contractor shall be responsible for all the Debris and scattered construction material. Contractor shall be cleaning all the debris & such material on day to day basis. 20. Party shall be responsible for coordinating with the other agencies like electrical etc. and shall be responsible for providing the timely front to the other agency and complete the job in stipulated time. SCOPE OF HPCL- GOOD FOR CONSTRUCTION DRAWINGS ONLY. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 3 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 Technical Terms And Conditions Attachment 2 Page 4 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 GENERAL SPECIFICATION 1.00.01 PREAMBLE 1.01.0 The scope of work involves complete works FOR FOLLOWING a. Product pump house & manifold civil works b. Fire water pump house. c. TTF Gantry. d. Parking sheds e. Watch tower f. Lube warehouse g. Calibration shed h. Sealing platform i. Blue dye, Turbo, Power Dosing system j. Grease Drum Shed k. Underground tank Installation/testing/calibration. l. Catwalk path ways. 1.02.0 The contractor will be required to work in close co-ordination with other contractor working in the area. 1.03.00 The Contractor will have to draw up the program of work in consultation with the Consultants and the project authorities to match with the overall project quirements. 2.00.00 DRAWINGS 2.01.00 The work shall be executed in accordance with the specification and the drawings `issued for construction’. Drawings will be issued in stages in close coordination with the availability of data and sequence of construction. Only latest revisions of the drawings shall be followed. All old revisions shall be clearly marked SUPERCEEDED’ and kept separately or destroyed as directed by HPCL . Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 5 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 3.00.00 SITE RECORDS 3.01.00 All works shall be recorded in appropriate proforma to be firmed up by the contractor in consultation with the HPCL. Where ever required reference to drawings and clauses of specification shall be recorded in the correspondence. 3.02.00 Records of cement and steel receipts, issue, and consumption shall be scrutinized from time to time by Owner. Statement of cement and steel receipts, statement of theoretical consumption and reconciliation accompany every bill. Records of spot levels jointly recorded before the start of the work shall form the basis of all measurements. 4.00.00 4.01.00 SCOPE OF WORK The work to be performed under this specification consists of providing all labour, materials, construction equipment, tools and plant, scaffolding, supplies, transportation, all incidental items not shown or specified, but reasonably implied or necessary for successful completion of the work including Contractor’s supervision and in strict accordance with the drawings and specifications. The nature of work shall generally involve earthwork in excavation including hard rock/ soft rock, extensive dewatering, shoring and strutting, backfilling around completed structures and plinth filling, disposal of surplus excavated materials, piling, concreting including reinforcement and formwork, brick work, inserts, steel gratings, architectural items & finishes such as plastering painting, flooring, etc., anchor bolts, RCC trenches with covers, laying of GI pipes and other ancillary items. 4.02.00 The layout and levels of all structures, etc. shall be made by the owner at his own cost from the general grid of the plot and bench mark given by the owner . He shall provide all instrument, materials and men to the HPCL for checking the layout and levels. However, the Contractor shall be fully responsible for correctness of layout and levels 4.03.00 The drawings included in the Bidding Document provide a general idea about the work to be performed under the scope of this contract. These are preliminary drawings for bidding purposes only and are by no means the final drawings or show the full range of the work under the scope. Work has to be executed according to drawings prepared by the contractor and approved by the Owner . Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 6 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 4.04.00 The contractor will be required to set up site laboratory at his own cost and maintain all the equipment in proper condition with all calibration and certificates of the equipment. The site laboratory will be manned by independent qualified engineer. The cost of setting up site laboratory and performance of all the tests shall be borne by the Contractor. In case any specific test such as testing of reinforcement, testing of specific materials requiring specialist equipment and conditions, shall be done in approved laboratories. The cost of such tests and the arrangements for witnessing such tests shall be borne by the Contractor 4.05.00 The scope of work also includes clearance of site of any vegetation, bushes, scrap, debris, etc. before starting the work and recording spot levels at the site of work as well as storage areas. The cost of such clearance shall be included in the quoted rates. The Contractor shall also clear the construction site of all debris and construction materials before handing over. 4.05.00 All specimens and approved samples shall be retained with the HPCL for reference unless handed over to Contractor for safe custody. The Contractor shall make arrangements for proper storage of the same. 4.06.00 The Contractor shall adopt dewatering methods as approved by HPCL in case ground water is encountered . The period for which the de-watering should be in effect shall be as directed by the HPCL. The cost of dewatering shall be borne by the Contractor for locations. 5.00.00 5.01.00 APPROVAL AND TESTS A high standard of quality is required for all materials and workmanship in construction work. They shall be best of the kind obtainable indigenously in each case and shall be procured from manufacturers of repute in order to ensure uniformity of quality and timely supply. 5.02.00 All materials shall be subjected to inspection and testing. The Contractor shall submit samples for testing as may be required by the Owner . Sampling and testing shall be carried out in accordance with relevant IS Standards. 5.03.00 Where ever IS codes are referred, they shall be latest edition/ publication as on date irrespective of the date of finalisation of the work. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 7 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6.00.00 REJECTION OF MATERIALS 6.01.00 Any material brought to site which, in the opinion of the HPCL is damaged, contaminated, deteriorated or does not comply with the requirement of this specification shall be rejected. 6.02.00 If the routine tests or random site tests show that any of the materials, brought to site, do not comply in any way with the requirements of this specification or of IS codes as applicable, then that material shall be rejected. 6.03.0 The Contractor at his own cost shall remove from site any and all such rejected material within the time specified by the Owner. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 8 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 C-01: EARTH WORK AND BACKFILLING 1.00.0 SCOPE 1.01.00 This section of the specification covers the technical requirements rexcavation and filling & around structures, buildings, pipes, foundations, trenches, pits, drains, channels, cable ducts, underground facilities & similar works. It also covers filling areas and plinths with selected materials, conveyance and disposal of surplus spoils and/or stacking them properly as directed by the Owner . 1.02.00 The contractor shall be fully responsible for proper setting out works, profiling in excavation, stacking, etc. taking adequate safety measures etc. The Contractor shall carry out all works meant within the intent of this specification even if not explicitly mentioned herein. All works shall be executed to the satisfaction of the Owner . 1.03.00 Existing trees, shrubs, any other plants, pole lines, fences, signs, monuments, buildings, pipelines, drains, sewers or other surface or subsurface systems/ dainage facilities within or adjacent to the works being carried out which are not to be disturbed, shall be protected from damage by the Contractor. The Contractor shall provide and install suitable safeguards approved by the Owner for this purpose. 1.04.0 During excavation, the Contractor shall take all necessary precautions against soil erosion, water & environmental pollution, and where required undertake additional works to achieve this objective. Before start of operations, the Contractor shall submit to the Owner for approval, his work plan and the procedure he intends to follow for disposal of waste materials etc. and the schedule for carrying out temporary and permanent control works. However, the approval of the Owner to such plans and procedures shall not absolve the Contractor of his responsibility for safe and sound work. 2.00.00 GENERAL 2.01.0 The Contractor shall make his own surveying arrangements for locating thecoordinates and positions of all work and establishing the reduced levels(RL’s) at these locations based on two reference grid lines and one benchmark which will be furnished by the Owner. The Contractor has to provide atsite all the required survey instruments, along with qualified surveyors, to thesatisfaction of the Owner so that the work can be carried out accuratelyand according to the specification and drawings. 2.02.00 The Contractor shall furnish all skilled and unskilled labour, plant, tools,tackle, equipment, men and materials required for complete execution of the work in accordance with the drawings and as described herein and/or as directed by the Owner. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 9 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 2.03.00 The Contractor shall control the grade in the vicinity of all excavations so that the surface of the ground will be properly sloped or dyked to prevent surface water from running into the excavated areas during construction. 2.04.00 All materials obtained from excavation shall remain the Owner’s roperty. All salvaged materials of archeological importance or of value (in the opinion of the Owner) shall be segregated from the other materials and both stacked separately and in a regular manner at location indicated by the Owner. 2.05.0 Excavation shall include removal of trees including roots & organic remains, vegetation, grass, bushes, shrubs, plants, poles, fences etc. that are in the area to be excavated as well as beyond the excavation line so as to ensure safety of the excavated side slopes and of men and equipment operating in the area.Before start of excavation work, joint measurements of ground level shall betaken after clearing all grass, vegetation etc. Excavation shall include the removal of all materials required to execute thework properly and shall be made with sufficient clearance as decided by theowner to permit the placing and setting of forms, inspection and completion of all works to the satisfaction of the owner for which the excavation was done. 2.06.0 2.07.00 2.07.01 Classification of Earth Work : The earth work shall be classified under the following main categories. a) All types of soils, murrum, boulders. b) Soft rock. c) Hard rock. Ordinary soils: This includes earth, murrum, top deposits of agricultural soil,reclaimed soil, clay, sand or any combination thereof and soft and hard murrum, shingle etc., which is loose enough to be removed with spades shovel and pick axes. Boulders not more than 0.03 cum. in volume found during the course of excavation shall also fall under this classification. 2.07.02 Soft Rock : This shall include all materials which are rock or hard conglomerate, all decomposed weathered rock, highly fissured rock, old masonry, boulders bigger than 0.03 cum in volume but not bigger than 0.5 cum and other varieties of soft rock which can be removed only with pick axes, crow bars, wedges and hammers with some difficulty. The mere fact that the contractor resorts to blasting and / or wedging and chiselling for reasons of his own, shall not mean the rock is classifiable as hard rock. 2.07.03 Hard Rock: This includes all rock other than soft rock mentioned in para 2.07.02 viz. Soft rock, occurring in masses, boulders having approximate volume more than 0.5 cum plain or reinforced cement concrete, which can best be removed by blasting or chiselling and wedging where blasting cannot be permitted owing to any restriction at site. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 10 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 3.00.00 CODES AND STANDARDS 3.01 .00 All standards, specifications, acts and code of practice referred to herein shall be the latest editions including all applicable official amendments and revisions. In case of conflict between this specification and those (IS standards, codesetc.) referred to here-in, the former shall prevail. 3.02.00 3.03.0 Some of the relevant Indian standards, Acts and Codes are referred to here below: IS: 383 1970 Specification for coarse and fine aggregates from natural sources for concrete. IS 2720 (Part- 2) 1973 Methods of test for soils-Determination of water content IS 2720 (Part4-4 ) 1985 Methods of test for soils-Grain size analysis IS 2720 (Part-5 ) 1985 Methods of test for soils-Determination of liquid limit & plastic limit IS 2720 (Part-6 ) 1972 Methods of test for soils-Determination of shrinkage factors IS 2720 (Part-7 ) 1980 Methods of test for soils-Determination of water content-Dry density relation using light compaction IS 2720 (Part-8 ) 1983 Methods of test for soils- Determination of water content-Dry density relation using heavy compaction IS 2720 (Part-14 ) 1983 Methods of test for soils-Determination of dry index(relative density) IS 2720 (Part-21 ) 1977 Methods of test for soils-Determination of total soluble solids IS 2720 (Part-23 ) 1976 Methods of test for soils-Determination of calcium corbonate IS 2720 (Part-24 ) 1976 Methods of test for soils-Determination of cation exchange capacity IS 2720 (Part-27 ) 1977 Methods of test for soils-Determination of total soluble sulphates IS 2720 (Part-29 ) 1975 Methods of test for soils-Determination of dry density of soil in-place by core cutter method IS: 3764 1992 Safety code for excavation work IS: 4081 1986 Safety code for blasting and related drilling operations IS: 4701 1982 Code of practice for earth work on canals IS: 9759 1981 Guide lines of dewatering during construction IS: 10379 1982 Code of practice for field control of moisture and compaction of soils for embankment and sub grade Indian Explosives Act 1940 as updated. 4.00.00 EXCAVATION IN SOIL 4.01.00 Side and bottom of excavation shall be cut sharp and true to line and level. Undercutting shall not be permitted. When machines are used for excavation, the last 300 mm before reaching the required level shall be excavated manually or by such equipment that soil at the required final level will be left in its natural condition. Suitability of strata (at the bottom of excavations) for laying the foundation thereon shall be determined by the Owner. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 11 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 4.02.00 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 Excavation for foundation shall be to the bottom of lean concrete and as shown on drawing or as directed by the Owner. The bottom of all excavations shall be trimmed to required levels and when excavation is carried below such levels by error, it shall be brought back to the specified level by filling with concrete of nominal mix 1:3:6 (cement: coarse sand: 40 mm down aggregates) as directed by the Owner. 4.03.0 The Contractor shall ascertain for himself the nature of materials tobe excavated and the difficulties, if any, likely to be encountered in executing this work., sheeting, shoring, bracing, maintaining suitable slopes, draining etc. shall be provided and installed by the Contractor, to the satisfaction of the Owner. 4.04.0 All excavation for installation of underground facilities, such as pipe ines, sewer line, drain lines etc. shall be open cuts. For deep and huge excavations and in other excavations, if required by the Owner, the Contractor shall submit for Owner’s approval an “Excavation Scheme” showing the methodology to be adopted for excavation in order to maintain the stability of side slopes, means for ensuring safety of existing facilities nearby, dewatering. However, the Contractor shall be fully responsible for the scheme irrespective of any approvals granted. Benching shall be provided for deeper excavation wherever required. 4.05.00 When excavation requires bracing, sheeting or shoring etc. the Contractor shall submit drawings to the Owner, showing arrangements and details of proposed installation. The Contractor shall also furnish all supporting calculations as called for and shall not proceed until he has received written approval from the Owner. However, the responsibility for adequacy of such bracing, sheeting, shorting etc. will rest with the Contractor, irrespective of any approval of the Owner. 4.06.0 The Contractor shall have to constantly pump out any water collected in excavated pits and other areas due to rain water, springs etc. and maintain dry working conditions at all times until the excavation, placement of reinforcement, shuttering, concreting, backfilling is completed. The Contractor shall remove all slush/muck from the excavated areas to keep the work area dry. Sludge pumps, if required, shall be employed by the Contractor for this purpose. 4.07.00 The Contractor shall remove all materials arising from excavations from the vicinity of the work either for direct filling, stacking the subsequent filling or for ultimate disposal as directed by the Owner. In no case shall the excavated soil be stacked within a distance of 1.5 m from the edge of excavation or one third the depth of excavation whichever is more. Material to be used for filling shall be kept separately. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 12 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 5.00.00 5.01.00 5.01.01 EXCAVATION IN ROCK General All clauses from 4.01.00 to 4.07.00 shall be applicable to excavation in rock also. In case of any discrepancy between the above mentioned clause and those specified in this clause then this clause shall govern. 5.01.02 For the work of excavation in rock, Contractor shall engage specialised agency having experience of excavation in rock involving wedging and blasting. The agency shall be subject to approval of owner and the Contractor shall furnish details of relevant experience in support while seeking approval for the agency. 5.01.03 In case of overbreaks in rock excavation, the excavated level shall be brought to the level shown on drawings with plain cement concrete of nominal mix 1:3:6 as described in para 4.02.00. 5.02.00 Excavation by Blasting 5.02.01 Blasting shall be resorted to only with the written permission of the Owner. All the statutory laws, (Explosives Act etc.) rules, regulations, Indian Standards etc. pertaining to the acquisition, transport, storage, handling and use of explosives etc. shall be strictly followed. 5.02.02 The contractor shall obtain Licenses from Competent Authorities for undertaking blasting work as well as for procuring, transporting to site and storing the explosives as per Explosives Act. The Contractor shall be responsible for the safe transport, use, custody and proper accounting of the explosive materials. 5.02.03 The Contractor may adopt any method of blasting as permitted according to explosives act/rule consistent with the safety and job requirements (after approval from the Owner) and so as not to injure men or damage materials/structures during blasting operations. 5.02.04 The magazine for the storage of explosives shall be built by the Contractor to the designs and specifications of the Explosives Department concerned and located at the approved site. No unauthorised person shall be admitted into the magazine which, when not in use, shall be kept securely locked. No matches or inflammable material shall be allowed in the magazine. The magazine shall have an effective lightning conductor and the following shall be hung in the lobby of the magazine. a) A copy of the relevant rules regarding safe storage, both in English and in the language(s) with which the workers concerned are familiar. b) A statement of up to date stock in the magazine. c) A certificate showing the last date of testing of the lightning conductor d) A notice stating that smoking is strictly prohibited. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 13 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 5.02.05 The Contractor shall also observe any specific instructions given by the Owner. The Contractor shall be responsible and liable for damage to property and any accident which may occur to workmen or to the public or to materials on account of any operation connected with the storage, transportation, handling or use of explosives and the blasting operations. The owner or his authorised representative shall frequently check the Contractor’s compliance with these precautions and the manner of storing and accounting of explosives. The Contractor shall provide necessary facilities for this. 5.02.06 All materials, tools and equipments used for blasting operations shall be of approved make and type. In special cases, the owner may specify the type of explosives to be allowed. The fuse to be used in wet locations shall be sufficiently water resistant so as to be unaffected when immersed in water for 30 minutes. The rate of burning of the fuse shall be uniform and precisely known to permit evaluation of the distance to which the firer should move before explosion takes place. Detonators shall be capable of effective blasting of the explosives. 5.02.07 The blasting powder, explosives, detonators, fuses etc. shall be fresh and not damaged due to dampness or any other Cause. Explosives shall be kept dry and shall not be exposed to direct rays of the sun or be stored in the vicinity of fire, stoves, steam pipes, or heated metal etc. They shall be inspected before use and damaged articles shall be discharged totally and removed from site immediately. 5.03.0 Blasting Operations 5.03.01 The blasting operations shall remain in the charge of a responsible, competent, authorised and experienced supervisor (called Man-in-Charge) and workmen who are thoroughly acquainted with the details of handling explosives and blasting operation and with the rules governing such work. 5.03.02 All rules under the Explosives Act and other local rules in force shall be fully observed. All blasting works shall be done in accordance with the stipulations contained in IS: 4081. Blasting shall only be carried out at certain specified times preferably during the mid-day lunch time or at the close of work as directed in writing by the Owner. The hours when blasting will be done, shall be made known to people in the vicinity. All the charges shall be prepared by the Man-in-Charge (as defined in 5.03.01) above) only. Proper precautions for safety of persons and property shall be taken. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 14 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 5.03.03 Prior to blasting, red danger flags shall be displayed prominently around the area to be blasted and shall be kept in position until blasting work i s completed. All people, except those who actually light the fuses, shall be prohibited from entering this area. The flags shall be planted 200 metres from the blasting site and all persons including workmen shall be evacuated from the flagged area atleast 10 minutes before firing. A warning whistle shall be sounded for this purpose. 5.03.04 Controlled Blasting shall be carried out within 200 metres of an existing structure unless otherwise permitted by the owner in writing. Where (generally with in plant area) controlled blasting is to be carried out in the proximity of other structures, then sand bags and/or earth bags etc. shall be used on top of the blast holes to prevent the rock fragments from causing damage to adjacent structures and property. At all stages of blasting operations, precautions shall be taken to preserve the rock in the soundest possible condition below and beyond the lines specified for the excavation. The quantity and strength of explosives used shall be such that it will neither damage nor crack the rock outside the limits of excavation. Any method of blasting which leads to overshooting shall be discontinued. No explosive shall be brought near the work in excess of the quantity required for a particular amount of firing to be done and surplus left after filling holes shall be removed to the magazine. A careful and day to day account of the explosives shall be maintained by the Contractor in an approved manner and in an identified register, which shall be open to inspection by the owner at all time. 5.03.05 5.03.06 At a time not more than ten such charges shall be prepared and fired. The man-inCharges shall blow the whistle in a recognised manner for cautioning the people. The number of blasts to be fired and actual number of shots heard shall be compared and the person responsible shall satisfy himself by examination that all blasts have exploded before any person working in the area is permitted to reapproach the work site. Sufficient time shall be allowed to account for delayed blasts. The Man-in-Charge shall inspect all the charge. The withdrawal of the unexploded charge shall not be permitted under any circumstances. After tamping, the unexploded charge shall be flooded with water and the hole marked in a distinguishable manner. Another hole shall be jumped at a distance of 450 mm from the old hole and fired in the usual way. This process shall be continued till the original blast is exploded. The Man-in- Charge shall at once report to the Contractor’s office and the Owner, al l cases of misfire, the cause for the same and what steps where taken in connection therewith. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page15 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 5.03.07 If misfire is found to be due to defective materials, the whole quantity in the box form which the defective materials was taken must be sent to the Authority directive by the owner for inspection to ascertain whether any of the remaining materials in the box are also defective. 5.04.00 Chiselling / Wedging Where blasting is prohibited for any reasons or it is not practicable in the opinion of the Owner, then the excavation shall be carried out by chiselling, wedging or any other approved method. The decision of the owner in this regard shall be final binding on Contractor. 5.05.00 Line drilling and pre-shearing The number, size and location of holes shall be carefully worked out by the Contractor and shall be subject to the approval of the Owner. Line drilled holes shall generally be 48 mm dia. and, if so directed, interior blasting holes shall also be made. The Contractor shall carry out test to determine the amount of explosives required to ensure an even break at the line drilled holes after the interior holes are blasted and irregularities in the vertical drilled line face shall be removed and trimmed by wedging, splitting, chiselling and barring. 6.00.0 EXCAVATION BELOW GROUND WATER TABLE 6.01.00 Wherever ground water table is met with during excavation, the Contractor shall immediately report this fact to the owner who shall arrange to record the exact level of the water table before start of dewatering operation. The decision of the Consultant regarding sub-soil water level shall be final and binding on the Contractor. Ground Water Table for the purpose of this clause shall be taken as the level of standing water observed during the process of excavation. Capillary action of water in the surrounding soil mass shall not be considered for the above purpose. 6.02.00 The Contractor shall dewater and maintain dry working conditions by maintaining the water table below the bottom of the excavation level by wellpoint dewatering or deep well dewatering or any other method approved by the Owner. He shall continue doing so till excavation, concreting, curing, and all other operation included in the scope of work, which require dry condition in the area are completed. 7.00.00 LIFT The Contractor is required to excavate upto any depth as shown on the drawings or as directed by the Owner. Lifting of excavated materials shall be done either by manual or mechanical or both means if called for by the Owner. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 16 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 8.00.00 CARRIAGE OF MATERIALS 8.01.00 The disposal/ stacking areas for excavated materials shall be indicated by the Owner. The carriage of excavated materials shall be done by the methods mentioned below: a) The excavated materials shall be carried beyond the initial lead of 50 m but upto 500 m by manual /animal labour or by mechanical means. If directed by the Owner this material shall be used directly for filling purposes. b) For leads exceeding 500 m the Contractor shall transport the excavated materials by mechanical means only and as directed by the Owner.The Contractor may be allowed to carry materials through Kuccha roads.Providing and maintaining of the Kuccha roads shall be the responsibilityof the Contractor. The transported material shall be neatly stacked asdirected by the Owner. 8.02.00 9.00.00 9.01 .00 9.01.01 9.01.02 Some excavated materials required for filling purposes, may have to be carried upto a lead of 500 m and stacked as per instructions of the Owner. Excavated materials carried beyond 500 m shall normally be for disposal purpose only. Double handling of materials shall be avoided as far as possible. However, depending on site condition excavated materials carried beyond a lead of 500 m may also be required to be brought back for filling purpose. FILLING Materials Materials to be used for filling purpose shall be stone, sand or other inorganic materials and they shall be clean and free from shingle, salts, organic matter, large roots and excessive amount of sod, lumps, concrete or any other foreign substances which could harm or impair the strength of the substances in any manner. All clods shall be suitably broken to small pieces. When the materialsare mostly rock boulders, these shall be broken into pieces not larger then 150 mm size. Sand used for filling shall be clean, medium grained and free from impurities. Fines less than 75 microns shall not be more than 20%. In any case, the materials to be used for filling purposes shall have the prior written approval of the Owner. If excavated materials are to be used for filling, then the Contractor shall select the materials from the stockpile, land and transport this material and execute the filling. This shall include excavation of earth which may become hard due to laying in stock yard for a long period of time. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 17 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 9.01.03 In case the materials have to be brought from pits/quarries, it shall be the Contractor’s responsibility for identification of such quarry areas, obtaining approval from their use from concerned authorities, excavation/quarryingloading and carriage of such material, unloading and filling at specified locations. The Contractor shall pay any fees, royalities etc. that may have to be paid for utilization of borrow areas. 9.02.00 Filling Procedure 9.02.01 After completion of foundation, footings, walls and other construction below the elevation of the final grades, and prior to filling, all temporary shoring,timber etc. shall be sequentially removed and the excavation cleaned of all trash, debris, and. perishable materials. Filling shall begin only with the written approval of the Owner. Also, areas identified for filling shall be cleared of all soft pockets, vegetation, bushes, slash etc. In case of plinth and similar filling the ground shall be dressed and consolidated by ramming and light rolling. Fill materials shall not be dropped directly upon or against any structure or facility where there is danger of displacement or damage. Filling shall be started after the concrete/masonry has fully set and shall be carried out in such a manner so as not to cause any undue lateral thrust on any part of the structure. 9.02.02 9.02.03 All space between foundation (concrete or masonry) and the sides excavation shall be filled to the original surface after making allowance for settlement, Fill shall be placed in horizontal layers not exceeding 200 mm loose thickness. Each layer shall be watered and compacted with proper moisture content and with such equipment as may be required to obtain a compaction/density as specified. Trucks or heavy equipment for depositing or compacting fill shall not be used within 1.5 meters of building walls, piers for operation. The methods of compaction shall be subjected to approval of Owner under any circumstances. 9.02.04 Fill adjacent to pipes shall be free of stones, concrete etc. and shall be hand placed and compacted uniformly on both sides of the pipe and where practicable up to a minimum depth of 300 mm over the top of pipes. While tamping around the pipes, care should be taken to avoid unequal pressure. 9.02.05 Filling shall be accurately finished to line, slope, cross section and grade as shown on the drawings. Finished surface shall be free of irregularities and depressions and shall be within 20 mm of the specified level. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 18 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 9.02.06 Where filling with stone from excavated materials is specified, it shall be from broken pieces of boulders. At first a 75 mm thick cushion of selected earth shall be laid over which the 200 mm thick graded stones shall be laid in loose layers of 200 mm then the interstices filled with properly graded fine materials consisting of selected earth brought from borrow areas. Each layer shall be watered and compared to the specified density before the next layer is laid. However, no cushion shall be required where filling is over non-rocky surface. 9.02.07 Where filling with 65 mm down graded stone obtained from excavated, it shall be selected stone laid over and initial 50 mm thick cushion layer of selected earth and then stone laid in 200 m loose thick layers, interstices filled with the specified density before the next layer in laid. However, no cushion shall, be required where filling is over non-rocky surface. 9.02.08 Where clean stone fill is specified, it shall consist of clean selected stone metal of 40 mm nominal size. It shall be laid in layers not exceeding 150 mm (loose) and lightly tamped before the next layer is laid. No compaction shall be required for this type stone filling. 9.03.00 Compaction 9.03.01 Where compaction to 95% Standard Proctor Density or more is called for, it shall be by mechanical means only. Where access is possible, compaction shall be by 12 tonne rollers smooth wheeled, sheep foot or wobbly wheeled as directed by the Owner. A smaller weight roller may be permitted by the Owner in special cases, but in any case not less than 10 passes of the roller will be accepted for each layer. Each layer shall be wetted or the material dried by aeration to a moisture content of 35% above the Optimum Moisture Content to be determined by the Contractor. Each layer shall be watered, rammed and compacted to the density as specified Owner. 9.03.02 For compacting each sand layer, water shall be sprayed over it to flood it and it shall be kept flooded for 24 hours to ensure maximum compaction. Vibrocompactors shall also be used if necessary to obtain the required degree of compaction. Any temporary works required to contain sand under flooded condition shall also be undertaken. The surface of the consolidated sand shall be dressed to required levels or slope. 9.03.03 After the compacted fill has reached the desired level, the surface shall be flooded with water for 24 hours, allowed to dry and then rammed and consolidated to avoid any settlement, at a later date. The compacted surface shall be properly shaped, trimmed and consolidated to an even gradient or level. All soft spots shall be excavated, filled and consolidated. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 19 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 9.03.04 The degree of compaction of compacted fill in place will be subject to tests by the Owner as the work progresses, and the contractor shall provide the necessary facilities to make such tests. If any test indicates that the compaction achieved is less than the specified degree of compaction, the Owner may require fill placed subsequent to the last successful test to be removed and recompacted by the Contractor. Compaction procedure shall be amended as necessary to obtain satisfactory results. 9.03.05 When semi-compacted fill is specified by the Owner, the contractor shall fill up such areas with available earth from stock piles of borrow pits or directly from excavation without special compaction except that obtained by moving trucks etc. 10.00.00 SAMPLING, TESTING AND QUALITY CONTROL 10.01.00 10.01.01 General The contractor shall carry out all sampling and testing in accordance with the relevant Indian Standards and/or International Standards and shall conduct such tests as are called for by the Owner. Where no specific testing procedure is mentioned, the tests shall be carried out as per the prevalent accepted Owner ringing practice to the directions of the Owner. Tests shall be done in the field and at a laboratory approved by the Owner and the Contractor shall submit to the Owner, the test results in triplicate within three days after completion of a test. The Owner may, at his discretion, waive some of the stipulations given below, for small and unimportant operations. 10.01.02 Work found unsuitable for acceptance shall be removed and replaced by the contractor. The work shall be redone as per specification requirements and to the satisfaction of the Owner. 10.01.03 Only as a very special case aid that too in non-critical areas, the Owner may accept filling work which is marginally unacceptable as per the criteria laid down. For such accepted work, payment shall be made at a reduced rate pro-rata to the compaction obtained against that stipulated. 10.02.00 Quality Assurance Program The contractor shall submit and finalise a detailed field Quality Assurance Program within 30 days from the date of award of the Contract according to the requirements of the specification. This shall include setting up of a testing laboratory, arrangement of testing apparatus /equipment, deployment of qualified / experienced manpower, reparation of format for record, Field Quality plan etc. On finalised field quality plan the Owner shall identity Customer hold points beyond which work shall not proceed without written approval from the Owner. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 20 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 10.03.00 Frequency of sampling and testing including the methods for conducting the tests shall be as per IS codal provisions. The testing frequencies set forth are the desirable minimum and the Owner shall have the full authority to carry out or call for tests as frequently as he may deem necessary to satisfy himself that the materials and work comply with the appropriate specifications. 10.04.00 Acceptance Criteria 10.04.01 Following Acceptance Criteria shall be as under: a) All individual samples collected and tested should pass without any deviation when only one set of sample is tested. b) For re-test of any sample two additional samples shall be collected and tested and both should pass without any deviation. c) Where a large number of samples are tested for a particular test, 9 samples out of every 10 consecutive samples tested shall meet the specification requirement. d) Tolerance on finished levels for important filling areas at approved interval shall be + 20 mm. However, for an unimportant area, tolerance upto + 75 mm shall be acceptable at the discretion of the Owner. However, these tolerances shall be applicable for localised areas only. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 21 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 SOLING & HARD CORE 1.00.00 GENERAL 1.01.00 The work covered under this specification includes all type of soling work either by rubble stones laid under floors / hard core under foundations, hand packed, complete as per under mentioned specification and applicable drawings. 2.00.00 RUBBLE STONE SOLING 2.01.00 The rubble stone shall be of best variety of black trap / granite / basalt or other approved variety of stone available locally. The stone shall be hard, durable, free from defects and of required size and shall be approved by the Engineer in-charge before incorporation in the work. 2.02.00 Preparation of Surface & laying: 2.02.01 The bed on which rubble soling is to be laid shall be cleared of all loose materials, levelled, watered and compacted and got approved by the Engineer In-charge before laying rubble soling. Cable or pipe trenches if shown in the drawing and as required by the Engineer incharge shall be got done before the soling is started. 2.02.02 Over the prepared surface, the stone shall be set as closely as possible and well packed and firmly set. The stones shall be of full height and shall be laid so as to have their bases of the largest area resting on the sub-grade. Soling shall be laid in one layer of 230mm or 150mm or other specified thickness and no stones shall be less than 230mm or 150mm depth or specified thickness of soling with a tolerance of 25mm. 2.02.03 After packing the stones properly in position, the interstices between them shall be carefully filled with quarry spoils of stone chips of larger size possible to obtain a hard, compact surface. Spreading of loose spoils or stone chips is prohibited. 2.02.04 The entire surface shall be examined for any protrusions and the same shall be knocked off by a hammer and all interstices shall be filled with approved murrum. Excess murrum if any over the surfaces shall be removed. Unless otherwise specified, the murrum shall be supplied by the contractor at his own cost from the selected areas. The surfaces shall then be watered and consolidated with mechanical or sufficiently heavy wooden tampers and logrammers as approved by the Engineer in-charge to give the required slope or level and dense sub-base. After compaction, the surface shall present clean look. Adequate care shall be taken by the contractor while laving and compacting the rubble soling to see that concrete surfaces in contact with soling are not damaged. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 22 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 3.00.00 HARD CORE FOR FOUNDATIONS 3.01.00 Where specifically mentioned in the drawings, hard core layer shall be provided as a preparatory surface to receive blinding concrete/ leveling course. 3.02.00 Hard core layer shall comprise of well graded broken stones 80mm nominal size with the following gradation: IS Sieve designation % passing 80 mm 100 63 mm 85-100 40 mm 0-30 20 mm 0-5 10 mm 0-5 The hard broken stones layer shall be directly placed over the compacted layer of under lying soil in layers. The stones shall be hand packed and crevices filled with broken stones. 3.03.00 3.04.00 Each layer shall be covered with clean river sand and thoroughly worked into the crevices with a water jet. Additional layers of sand shall be placed on top and worked into the void spaces. The process shall be repeated until no more sand and water get into the voids. 3.05.00 earth rammer shall be used to compact each layer if directed by Consultant. 3.06.00 The thickness and area covered beyond the blinding concrete shall be as indicated in the drawings or as indicated by Consultant. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 23 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 PLAIN AND REINFORCED CONCRETE & ALLIED WORKS 1.00.00 SCOPE _ 1.01.00 This specifications covers the general requirements for concreting to be used on jobs using on-site production facilities including requirements in regard to handling, storage of ingredients, proportioning, batching, mixing and testing and quality assurance. This also covers the transportation of concrete from the mixer to the place of final deposit and the placing consolidation, curing, protecting, repairing and finishing of concrete. 1.02.00 The work shall include providing of materials, all necessary plant and equipment, providing adequate engineering supervision and technical personnel, skilled and unskilled labour, etc. as required to carry out the entire work as indicated on the drawings and/or described herein subsequently and/or as directed by the Owner. 1.03.00 The Contractor shall carry out all works meant within the intent of this specification even if not explicitly mentioned herein. All works shall be executed to the satisfaction of the Owner. 2.00.00 GENERAL 2.01.00 The Contractor shall make his own surveying arrangements for locating the coordinates and positions of all work and establishing the reduced levels (RLs) at these locations, based on two reference grid lines and one bench mark, which will be furnished by Owner. The Contractor has to provide at site, all the required survey instruments, along with qualified surveyors, to the satisfaction of the Owner so that the work can be carried out accurately and according to the specifications and drawings. 2.02.00 The contractor shall establish a site laboratory for testing of material and quality assurance as per the requirements of this specification. The laboratory shall be manned by qualified Owner. 2.03.00 Any approval, instructions, permission, checking, review, etc. whatsoever by the Owner, shall not relieve the Contractor of his responsibility and obligation regarding adequacy, correctness, completeness, safety, strength, quality, workmanship, etc. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page24 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 3.00.00 CODES AND STANDARDS 3.01.00 All work shall be carried out as per the stipulations contained in various sections of these specifications and the latest Indian Standards, Acts, Codes and best practices. 3.02.00 All applicable standards, specifications, etc. and codes of practice shall generally be the latest editions, including all applicable official amendments and revisions. A complete set of all these documents shall generally be available at site, with the Contractor. 3.03.00 In case of conflict between the stipulations contained in various sections of these specifications and stipulations of Indian Standards, Codes, etc. the requirements of stipulations contained in various sections of these specifications, shall prevail over that of Indian Standards, Codes, etc. 3.04.00 The following are the various relevant Indian Standards: IS: 383 1970 Specification for coarse and fine aggregates from natural sources for concrete IS:432 (Parts I) 1982 Specification for mild steel medium tensile steel bars and hard drawn steel wire for concrete reinforcement – Mild steel & medium tensile bars IS: 432(Parts II) 1982 Specification for mild steel medium tensile steel bars and hard drawn steel wire for concrete reinforcement - Hard drawn steel wire IS: 456 2000 Code of practice for plain and reinforced concrete IS: 516 1959 Method of test for strength of concrete IS : 650 1991 Specification for standard sand for testing of cement IS: 1200 (Part-II) 1974 Method of measurement of building and civil Engineering works - Concrete works IS: 1200 (Part-V) 1982 Method of measurement of building and civil Engineering works - Form work IS : 4656 1968 Specification for form vibrators for concrete. IS: 8043 1991 Specification for hydrophobic Portland cement IS: 8112 1989 Specification for 43 Grade Ordinary Portland Cement IS : 9103 1999 Specification for concrete admixtures IS : 10262 1982 Recommended guidelines for concrete mix design. IS : 11384 1985 Code of practice for composite construction in structural steel and concrete. IS : 12269 1987 Specification for 53 Grade ordinary Portland cement. IS: 12330 1988 Sulphate resisting Portland Cement IS : 12600 1989 Specification for low heat Portland cement SP : 23 1982 Handbook of concrete mixes. SP : 24 1983 Explanatory Handbook on IS: 456 SP : 34 1987 Handbook on concrete reinforcement and detailing. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 25 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 4.00.00 MATERIALS 4.01.00 4.01.01 General: All the materials used in the manufacture of concrete shall be in accordance with the Technical Specification for Properties, Storage and Handling of Common Building Materials, which shall be deemed to form a part of this specification. 4.01.02 The Owner shall have the right to inspect the sources of materials, the layout and operation of procurement and storage of materials, the concrete batching and mixing equipments and the quality control system. The contractor shall arrange such an inspection and the Owner s approval shall be obtained prior to starting the work. 4.02.00 Aggregates 4.02.01 Aggregate in general designates both fine and coarse inert materials used in the manufacture of concrete. Coarse Aggregate is faction retained on 4.75 mm IS sieve. Fine Aggregate is faction, which passes through 4.75 mm, IS sieve. 4.02.02 Aggregate shall consist of natural sand, crushed stone and gravel from a source known to produce satisfactory aggregate for concrete and shall be chemically inert, strong, hard, durable against weathering, of limited porosity and free from deleterious materials that may cause corrosion to the reinforcement or may impair the strength and / or durability of concrete. Aggregates shall conform to I.S. 383 4.02.03 Properties: Aggregates with a specific gravity below 2.6 shall not be used without special permission of the Owner. Machine-made sand will be acceptable provided the constituent (rock/gravel) is sound, hard, dense and is acceptable to the Owner. Sand, natural gravel and crushed rock shall be prepared for use by such screening or washing, or both, as necessary to remove all objectionable foreign matter. 4.02.04 The coarse aggregate and fine aggregate shall be tested from time to time as required by the Owner to ascertain its suitability for use in construction and the charges for testing aggregate shall be born by the contractor as specified herein after. Sampling of the aggregates for mix design and determination of suitability shall be taken under the supervision of the Owner and delivered to the laboratory, well in advance of the schedule placing of concrete. Records of tests that have been made on proposed aggregates and on concrete made from this source of aggregates shall be furnished to the Owner in advance of the work for use, in determining suitability of the proposed aggregate. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 26 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 4.02.05 The grading of aggregates shall be such as to produce a dense concrete of specified strength and consistency that will work readily into position without segregation and shall be based on the “mix design” and preliminary test on concrete specified herein-after. 4.02.06 Grading of Coarse Aggregate : Coarse aggregates shall be either in single or graded, in both the cases. The grading shall be within the following limits. IS Sieve Designation 75mm 63mm 37.5mm 19mm 16mm 11.2mm 9.5mm 4.75mm 2.36mm 4.02.07 Percentage passing for single sized aggregates of nominal size. 63mm 100 85-100 0-30 0-5 - 40mm 100 85-100 0-20 0-5 0-5 - 20mm 100 85-100 0-20 0-5 - 16mm 100 85-100 0-30 0-10 - Material finer than 75 micron IS Sieve Coal and lignite Clay lumps Soft fragments Total of all the above substances 4.02.08 : IS Sieve Designation 10mm 4.75mm 2.36mm 1.18mm 600 micron 300 micron 150 micron 10mm 100 85-100 0-20 0-5 Foreign Material Limitations: The percentages of deleterious substances in the coarse aggregate delivered to the mixer shall not exceed the following : Substances i) ii) iii) iv) v) 12.5mm 100 85-100 0-45 0-20 0-5 Percentage Passing for graded aggregates of nominal size. 40mm 20mm 16mm 12.5mm 100 95-100 100 30-70 95-100 100 100 90-100 90-100 10-35 25-55 30-70 40-85 0-5 0-10 0-10 0-10 - Percentage by weight of aggregates Uncrushed Crushed 3.00 3.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 3.00 -5.00 5.00 Grading of fine aggregate shall be within the limits indicated hereunder Percentage Passing for Grading Zone -I 100 90-100 60-95 30-70 15-34 5-20 0-10 Grading Zone-II 100 90-100 75-100 55-90 35-59 8-30 0-10 Grading Zone-III 100 90-100 85-100 75-100 60-79 8-30 0-10 Grading Zone-IV 100 95-100 95-100 90-100 80-100 20-65 0-15 Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 27 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 4.02.09 Foreign Material Limitations: The percentages of deleterious substances in fine aggregate, delivered to the mixer shall not exceed the following : 4.02.10 Substances i) ii) iii) iv) v) Material finer than 75 micro IS sieve Shale Coal and lignite Clay and lumps Total of all above substances including items (i) to (iv) for uncrushed sand and items (iii) and (iv) for crushed sand Percent by Weight Uncrushed 3.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 5.00 Crushed 15.00 -1.00 1.00 2.00 4.02.10 Fineness Modulus : The fine aggregate shall have a fineness modulus of not less than 2.2 or more than 3.2. The fineness modulus is determined by adding the cumulative percentages retained on the following I.S. sieve sizes (4.75 mm, 2.36 mm, 1.18 mm, 600 micron, 300 micron and 150 micron) and dividing the sum by 100. 4.02.11 Storage of aggregates: All coarse and fine aggregates shall be stacked Separately in stockpiles in the material yard near the work site in bins properly constructed to avoid inter mixing of different aggregates. Contamination with foreign materials and earth during storage and while heaping the materials shall be avoided. The aggregate must be of specified quality not only at the time of receiving at site but also at the time of loading into mixer. Rakers shall be used for lifting the coarse aggregate from bins or stock piles. Coarse aggregate shall be piled in layers not exceeding 1.00 metres in height to prevent conning or segregation. Each layer shall cover the entire area of the stock pile before succeeding layers are started. Aggregates that have become segregated shall be rejected. Rejected material after re- mixing may be accepted, if subsequent tests demonstrate conformity with required gradation. _4.03.00 Cement 4.03.01 The cement generally used shall be the Ordinary Portland cement 43 / 53 grade. However, any special type of cement such as High strength cement or sulphate resisting cement may be used under specific circumstances. 4.03.02 Cement unless otherwise specified or called for by the Owner shall be measured in 50 kg bags. Use of bulk cement will be permitted only with the approval of the Owner. Changing of brands of type of cement within the same structure will not be permitted. Joint account of cement consumed at site for every day for items of work carried shall be maintained by the Contractor for verification to ensure effective control on quality of work. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 28 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 4.03.03 10000011 / HB / 11094 BRAND OF CEMENT : BIRLA PLUS/ AMBUJA/ACC/ L& T , LAXMI A certified report attesting to the conforming of the cement to IS: specifications by the cement manufacturer’s chemist shall be furnished to the Owner, if demanded. Should at any time the Owner have reasons to consider that any cement is defective, then irrespective of its origin and / or manufacturers test certificate, such cement shall be tested immediately at a National Test Laboratory / Departmental Laboratory or such approved laboratory, and until the results of such tests are found satisfactory, it shall not be used in any work. Cement held in store for a period of ninety (90) days or longer shall be retested before use in work. 4.03.04 The contractor shall make his own arrangements for the storage of adequate quantity of cement. If supplies are arranged by the Department, cement will be issued in quantities to cover work requirements of one month or more, as deemed fit by the Owner and it will be the responsibility of the contractor to ensure adequate and proper storage, which will provide complete protection from dampness, contamination and minimize caking and false set. Cement bags shall be stored in a dry enclosed shed (storage under tarpaulins will not be permitted), well away from the outer walls and insulated from the floor to avoid contact with moisture from ground and so arranged as to provide ready access. Damaged or reclaimed or partly set cement will not be permitted to be used and shall be removed from the site. The storage arrangements shall be such that there is no dead storage. No more than 12 bags shall be stacked in any tier. The storage arrangement shall be approved by the Owner. Consignments in cement shall be stored as received and shall be consumed in the order of their delivery. 4.04.00 Reinforcement 4.04.01 Steel reinforcement bars for concrete shall be TMT Bars manufactured by SAIL, TATA or RINIL. The grade of steel shall be as shown in the drawings, or as mentioned in the schedule of items or as directed by Owner. 4.04.02 Storage: Steel reinforcement shall be stored in such a manner that they are not in direct contact with ground but stacked on top of an arrangement of timbers sleepers or the like. Bars of different classifications and sizes shall be stored separately. In cases of long storage or in coastal areas, reinforcement shall be stacked above ground level by at least 15 cm, and a coat of cement wash shall be given to prevent scaling and rusting at no extra cost to the owner. Fabricated reinforcement shall be carefully stored to prevent, distortion, corrosion and deteriorations. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 29 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 4.04.03 Contractor shall submit the manufacturers test certificate for steel. Random tests on steel supplied by contractor may be performed if the Owner so desires as per relevant Indian Standards. All costs incidental to such tests shall be at contractors expense. Steel not conforming to specifications shall be rejected. 4.05.00 Water 4.05.01 Water used for mixing and curing shall be clean and free from injurious amounts of oils, acids, alkalis, sugar, organic materials or other substances that may be deleterious to concrete or steel. Potable water is generally considered satisfactory for mixing concrete. The maximum permissible values of impurities shall be as given in clause no. 5.4 of lS:456. 4.07.00 4.07.01 . mbedded parts Steel for light structural work and for preparation of inserts and embedments shall conform to IS:2062. _4.07.02 Bolts to be embedded in concrete shall, unless otherwise detailed in drawings, conform to IS:5624. Material for bolts, shall, unless otherwise mentioned in drawings or the schedule of items, be corrosive resistant/coated steel conforming to IS:2062. _4.07.03 Nuts and locknuts shall conform to IS:1363 (Part 1 to 3) for diameters 6 to 39 and IS 3138 for Hexagon Bolts and Nuts (M-42 to M-150)”. 4.07.04 4.07.05 Plain washers shall conform to IS:2016 and spring washers shall conform to IS:3063. Steel pipe sleeves shall conform to Medium class of IS: 1161. _4.08.00 Filling material _4.08.01 General: Filling material shall conform to what is shown in drawing, described in the Schedule of Items or otherwise directed by the Owner. Earth or sand for filling under floors shall correspond to those de scribed elsewhere in these specification. 4.08.02 Mastic Bitumen: Mastic Bitumen shall conform to IS: 3037 or IS: 5871 appropriate. 4.08.03 Flexible Boards: Flexible boards for use in expansion joints shall correspond to the description given in drawing or the Schedule of Items or the instruction of Owner. as Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 30 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 5.00.0 5.01.0 10000011 / HB / 11094 Goncrete Design Mix Concrete a) Design Mix Concrete shall be used for all reinforced concrete works. The mix proportions shall be as per mix design, designed for each grade of concrete, workability and durability requirements. The characteristic strength shall not be less than the appropriate values given in Table-2 of IS:456:2000. b) In proportioning concrete, the quantity of both cement and aggregates shall be determined by mass. Water shall be either measured by volume in calibrated tanks or weighed. All measuring equipment at site shall be maintained in a clean and serviceable condition, and their accuracy shall be periodically checked. c) To keep the water-cement ratio to the designed value, allowance shall be made for the moisture contents in both fine and coarse aggregates and determination of the same in accordance with lS:2386 Part (III) shall be made as frequently as directed by the Owner.. d) With the permission of the Owner, for any of the above mentioned grades of concrete, if the water quantity has to be increased, proportionately cement quantity shall also be increased, to keep the ratio of water to Cement same as adopted in mix design for the corresponding grade of concrete. The extra cement required on account of this shall be at no extra cost to Owner. e) At the beginning of the project, if so desired by the contractor, he/they may be allowed by the Owner , till the designed mix is obtained, to carry out the reinforced concrete work in foundation and plinth as per equivalent nominal mix against the specified design mix concrete as per IS codes. However, all other specification for design mix shall govern for nominal mix also and nothing extra shall be paid for use of extra cement or else on this account whether the cement is supplied by the Owner or procured by the contractor. 5.01.05 Mix design: Mix design shall generally be done at any of the approved laboratory. The following is the guideline to be followed: a) IS:10262 shall be followed as general guidance for mix design. Theminimum value of target strength of design mix of various grades ofconcrete shall be as per clause no. 9.2 of IS:456. However, the Ownermay allow change in target strength values based on adequate numbers of works test results. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 31 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 b) Minimum cement content from durability consideration for different exposures and sulphate attack shall be as given in Table-4 and 5 of IS:456.In case higher value is obtained from strength consideration, same shall be provided. c) Preliminary tests/trial mix, as specified or as required by the `Owner, shall be carried out sufficiently ahead of the actual commencement of the work with different grades of concrete made from representative samples of aggregates and cement expected to be used on the works. These tests are to be conducted to arrive at the grading of aggregates, water-cement ratio, workability and the quantity of cement required to give Preliminary (target) compressive strengths as specified in clause 9.2 of IS 456. d) At least four trial mixes are to be made and minimum six test cubes taken for each trial mix noting the slump for each type of mix. The cubes shall then be properly cured and three cubes for each mix shall be tested in a laboratory (approved by the Owner) at 7 days and others at 28 days for obtaining the compressive strength. The test reports shall be submitted to the Owner. The design mix particulars shall indicate, with the help of graphs and curves etc. the extent of variation in the grading of aggregates which can be allowed. While designing mixes, over wet mixes shall be avoided. For the structures, where assessment of early strength is required the concrete cubes shall also be tested for early age strength at 1 day and 3 days for establishing the values. d) The Contractor shall submit the test reports of mix design to the Owner for his review, indicating design criteria, analysis and proportioning of materials, etc. On the basis of the above test reports, a mix proportion by mass and the water-cement ratio, shall be determined by the Contractor such that concrete prepared with this mix will yield the desired characteristic strength and shall have suitable workability. The mix design to be adopted on the works shall be subject to the approval of the Owner. The proportions, once decided for different grades of concrete, shall be adhered to, during all concreting operations as long as the quality of the materials does not change. If, however, at any time, the quality of materials being used has changed from those for Preliminary mix design, or there is a change either in the required strength of concrete, or water cement ratio or workability, the Contractor shall have to make similar trial mixes and Preliminary tests to ascertain the revised mix proportions and water-cement ratio to be used for obtaining the desired strength and consistency. e) The entire cost of all the trial mixes including all the preparatory works for trial mixes, preparation of test cubes and their testing shall be borne by the Contractor. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 32 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 _5.01.06 Nominal mix Concrete a) Nominal mix concrete shall be used only for plain cement concrete works and where shown on drawings or specifically allowed by the Owner. Such concrete shall not require preparation of trial mixes and all such concrete shall be mixed in a mechanical mixer. Proportions for nominal mix concrete shall be according to Table-9 of IS:456. b) The proportion of mix may be slightly adjusted within limits, keeping the total value of aggregates to a given quantity of cement constant to suit the sieve analysis of both the aggregates. Cement shall on no account be measured by volume, but it shall always be used directly from the bags (i.e. 50 kg/bag). The proportion of cement, sand, aggregate and water for concrete of proportion 1:5:10, 1:4:8, 1:3:6 & 1:2:4 by volume shall generally consist of quantities as given below : Proportion Ingredients 1:5:10 1:4:8 1:3:6 1:2:4 of Cement 1 1 1 1 Fine aggregate (Sand) 170 ltrs. 130 ltrs. 102 ltrs 68 ltrs. Coarse aggregate 340ltrs. 272 ltrs. 204 ltrs. 136 ltrs. Total of fine and coarse aggregates 800 kgs. 625 kgs. 480 kgs 350 kgs. Water 60 ltrs. 45 ltrs 34 ltrs. 32 ltrs. c) The quantity of water used shall be such as to produce concrete of consistency required by the particular class of work and shall be decided by the use of slump cone. Sufficient care should be taken to see that no excess quantity of water is used. The final proportion of the aggregate and quantity of water shall be decided by the Owner on the basis of test in each case. The for each class of work shall in general be as follows: Type of concrete Mass concrete Concrete below water proofing treatment Coping Floor paving Max slump (in mm) 50 50 25 50 d) As a general guidance the Nominal mix concrete of mix proportion 1:5:10 shall approximately correspond to grade M5, 1:4:8 shall correspond to grade M7.5, 1:3:6 to grade M10 and 1:2:4 to grade M15 of IS:456. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 33 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 e) If fine aggregates are moist, the amount of surface water shall bedetermined. Also an allowance shall be made for bulking in case ofvolume batching, in accordance with IS:2386 (Part-Ill). Allowance shall also be made for surface water present in the aggregates, when computing the water requirement. In the absence of exact data the amount of surface water may be estimated as follows: Aggregate Very wet sand Moderately wet sand Moist sand Moist gravel or crushed rock Approximate quantity of surface water Percentage by mass l/cum 7.5 120 5.0 80 2.5 40 1.25-2.5 20-40 f) If nominal mix Concrete made in accordance with specified proportions does not yield the specified strength of the corresponding grade and fails to satisfy the requirements of “acceptance criteria for concrete” as specified in IS:456, such concrete shall be treated in the following manner: i) In case the Owner is satisfied that lower strength of concrete is attributed to material and workmanship of the Contractor, then such concrete shall be replaced by concrete of specified strength. TheOwner may, however, also accept such lower strength concrete but such lower strength concrete shall be classified as belonging to the appropriate lower grade proportion. ii) In case the Owner is satisfied that lower strength of concrete is not attributable to the Contractor, he may direct in writing to increase the cement content to obtain specified strength at no extra cost to Owner. The use of richer mix shall be continued until the Owner instructs otherwise. g) Nominal mix proportion shall not be classified as higher grade proportioneither on the ground that the test strengths are higher than the minimum specified or in the case where the Owner directs use of additional cement over the quantity specified for the particular mix proportion to achieve the minimum specified strength. h) However, only in some exceptional cases including concreting in some isolated areas, the Owner may allow the quantity of aggregates to be determined by an equivalent volume basis after the relationship between weight and volume is well established by trials and the same shall be verified frequently. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 34 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 7.00.00 FORMWORK AND STAGING 7.00.01 The Contractor shall supply, fabricate, erect and dismantle (after use) all staging that is required for all activities covered under the specifications. He shall prepare the scheme and submit along with the supporting calculations for approval of the Owner. Prior to construction of form work for any item where soil will not act as bottom form, approval shall be obtained from Owner as to the suitability of the soil. 7.00.02 7.01.00 Materials 7.01.01 Formwork shall compose of steel, best quality wood or non-` absorbant -type plywood. Timber shall be free from significant knots and shall be of medium grain as far as possible and hard woods shall be used as caps and wedges under or over posts. Timber shall be well seasoned, free from sap, shakes, worm holes, warps or other surface defects and shall have smooth finish. 7.01.02 Staging, unless specified otherwise, shall generally be of mild steel tubes, steel beams and channels etc. or strong sal ballies 150 mm in diameter or above. Bamboos, small diameter ballies etc., shall not be used unless approved by the Owner in specific cases. 7.02.00 Classification of formwork 7.02.01 Ordinary: This shall be used in places where ordinary surface finish is required and shall compose of steel and/or approved good quality seasoned wood. Plywood shuttering can also be used by the Contractor. Plywood: This shall be used in exposed surfaces as shown on drawings or as directed by the Owner where a specially, good finish is required. Such surfaces shall be formed using approved brand of heavy quality water resistant plywood to produce a perfectly levelled, uniform and smooth surface. Reuse of such forms may be permitted only after inspection and approval by the Owner, for each such reuse. 7.02.02 7.03.00 Quality of formwork and staging 7.03.01 Formwork shall consist of all materials required for forming the boxing to pour concrete, Including steel/wood/plywood forms, ties, anchors, hangers, inserts, etc. Formwork shall be so constructed that vertical and horizontal adjustments can be made as required. The design and Engineering of formwork including staging as well as its erection and dismantling shall be the responsibility of the Contractor. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 35 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 7.03.02 7.03.04 7.03.05 10000011 / HB / 11094 The staging shall be true and rigid and thoroughly braced in both directions as well as cross braced, strutted and propped such that it will not deform unduly under weight of concrete and other loads due to men, equipment, etc. Vertical members or props should not be supported on an unpropped lower suspended floor or beam unless it is ensured by the Contractor that the lower floor or beam can safely carry the loads. No propping shall take place until the Owner’s approval has been given to the Contractor’s scheme submitted along with supporting calculations. The forms and staging shall be sufficiently strong to carry without undue deformation, the dead weight of the concrete as a liquid as well as anticipated working loads. Where the concrete is vibrated, the formwork shall be strong enough to withstand the effects of vibration, without appreciable deflection, bulging. distortion or loosening of its components. The joints in the formwork shall be sufficiently tight to prevent any leakage of mortar. The formwork shall be such as to ensure a smooth uniform surface free from honeycombs, air bubbles, bulges, fins and other blemishes. Any blemish or defect found on the surface of the concrete, must be brought to the notice of the Owner immediately and rectified as directed by him. To achieve the desired rigidity, ample studs, braces, bolts, spacer blocks, wires, clamps, ties, straps, shores, etc. shall be used to hold the form in proper position without undue distortion. These shall be approved by the Owner but they must in no way impair the strength of concrete or leave stains or marks on the finished surface. Where there are chances of these fixtures being embedded, only mild steel or concrete of adequate strength shall be used. Bolts passing completely through liquid and or earth retaining walls/slabs, basement walls etc. for the purpose of securing and aligning the formwork, shall not be permitted. 7.03.06 For exposed interior and exterior concrete surfaces of beams and columns, plywood : other approved forms thoroughly cleaned and tied together with approved corrosion resistant devices shall be used. Rigid care shall be exercised ensuring that all column forms are plumb and true and thoroughly cross braced to keep them so. 7.03.07 Bevelled strips 25x25 mm shall be provided to form angles and in corners of columns and beam boxes for chamfering of corners if shown on drawings or directed by the Owner. Temporary openings for cleaning, inspection and for pouring concrete shall be provided at the base of vertical forms and at other places, where these are necessary and as may be directed by the Owner. The temporary openings shall be so formed that they can be conveniently closed rigidly when required and must not leave any mark on the concrete. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page36 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 7.03.08 If it is so desired by the Owner, the Contractor shall prepare, before commencement of the actual work, designs and drawings for formwork and staging and get them approved by the Owner. Formwork shall -be so designed and positioned that it can be removed without damage to concrete. 7.03.09 The Contractor shall maintain necessary camber in centering for all floor slabs and beams in all spanning directions, so as to offset the deflection and assume correct shape. The camber shall have the crown of not less than 8 mm for every 5 metres span unless otherwise shown on the drawings. For cantilever, camber at free end shall be 1 in 100. 7.03.10 The Contractor shall provide the shuttering for complete stretch of work upto expansion joints for the structures like shell, folded plate etc. and/or as directed by the Owner. 7.04.00 Cleaning and treatment of forms 7.04.01 All forms shall be thoroughly cleaned of old concrete, wood shavings, saw dust, dirt and dust sticking to them before these are fixed in position. All rubbish, loose concrete, chippings, shavings, saw dust etc. shall be scrupulously removed from the interior of the forms before concrete is poured. Wire brushes, brooms, compressed air jet and/or water jet etc. shall be kept handy for cleaning, if directed by the Owner. 7.04.02 Before formwork is placed in position, the form surfaces, that will be in contact with concrete shall be treated with approved non-staining oil or composition which is insoluble in water and not injurious to concrete. Care shall be taken that the oil or composition does not come in contact with reinforcing steel or stain the concrete surfaces. Burnt oil shall not be allowed to be used specially where the concrete surface will require finishing and/or plaster. 7.05.00 Removal of forms 7.05.01 The Contractor shall begin the removal of formwork only after approval of the Owner. He shall place on record the dates on which the concrete is placed in different parts of the work and the dates of the removal of formwork there from. This record shall be checked and countersigned by the Owner. The Contractor shall be responsible for the safe removal of formwork but the Owner may delay the time of removal if he considers it necessary. Any work showing signs of damage through premature removal of formwork, shall be entirely removed and reconstructed by the Contractor at no extra Cost to Owner. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 37 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 7.05.02 The formwork shall be so designed and erected that the forms for slabs and the sides of beams, columns and walls may be removed first, leaving the beam bottoms and their supports in position. Re-propping of beams shall not be done except with the approval of the Owner. Formwork for columns and walls at each stage of concreting shall be erected only upto the particular lift of construction. Wedges, spacer bolts, clamps or other suitable means shall be provided to allow accurate adjustment of the formwork and to allow it to be removed gradually without jerking the concrete. 7.05.03 Forms of various types of structural components shall, under normal circumstances, not be removed before the minimum periods specified in Cl. 11.3 of IS:456, which shall also be subject to the approval of the Owner. However, in any case formwork shall not be struck until the concrete has reached a strength, at least twice that of the stress to which the concrete may be subjected -to at the time of removal of forms. The removal of form work shall generally be as per the following guidelines: Part of Structure Walls, Columns and vertical sides of beams Slabs(Props left under) Beams soffits(Props left under) Removal of props to slabs i)Spanning up to 4.5 m ii) Spanning over 4.5 m Removal of props to beams and arches i) Spanning up to 6 m. ii) Spanning over 6 m Cantilever slabs 7.05.04 7.05.06 7.05.07 7.05.10 Earliest concrete age at stripping Ordinary Portland cement concrete 16 to 24 hours or as directed by the Owner 3 days 7 days Portland Pozzolana cement concrete 3 days 7 days 10 days 7 days 14days 10 days 14 days 14 days 21 days 14 days 14 days 21 days 14 days The number of props left under, their sizes and disposition shall be such as to be able to safely carry the full dead load of the slab, beam or arch as the case may be together with any live load likely to occur during curing or further construction. Where the shape of the element is such that the formwork has reentrant angles, the formwork shall be removed as soon as possible after the concrete has set, to avoid shrinkage cracking occurring due to the restraint imposed. Contractor shall record on the drawings or a special register, the date up in which the concrete is placed in each part of the work and the date on which the shuttering is removed there from. In case of cantilever slabs, the removal of forms shall begin from the outer edge and proceed towards the support, where as in the case of slabs supported on two/four sides, the removal of forms shall begin from centre to supports. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 38 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 7.05.11 The formwork shall be so made as to produce a finished concrete, true to shape, lines, plumb and to dimensions as shown on the drawings. The Owner may call for finished work at any time to set standards of workmanship. Once approved, these will become the accepted Sample. 7.05.12 In case PPC/PSC is used instead of OPC, the removal of shuttering/ support shall be after 50% more time from that being applied for OPC, unless otherwise permitted by the Owner. For concrete temperature above 40°C, stripping time shall be increased. 7.05.13 In case of special structures, such as shells, folded plates, etc, the sequence of removal of forms shall be as per drawings or as directed by the Owner. 7.06.00 Re-use of forms Before reuse, all forms shall be thoroughly scraped, cleaned, all nails and adhering substances removed, holes and leaks satisfactorily plugged, joints examined and where necessary repaired and inside surfaces treated as specified herein before. Formwork shall not be used/re-used, if declared unfit or unserviceable by the Owner. 8.00.00 8.00.01 REINFORCEMENT PLACEMENT All reinforcement for concrete works shall be provided as per the drawings or as indicated in the schedule of items. The Contractor shall prepare and furnish to the Owner, bar bending schedules for all RCC works for his review and approval. No work shall commence without the approval of the bar bending schedules by the Owner in writing. The contractor shall plan the procurement of steel well in advance and complete the surface treatment, if specified in a planned manner. In case of non availability of certain diameters Owner may permit substitution of bars. However such substitutions shall be the last resort and shall not be a reason for delay. The Contractor shall modify the bar bending schedule, and specific approvals of Owner obtained. 8.00.02 8.00.03 All bars shall be thoroughly cleaned before being fabricated. Pitted and defective bars shall not be used. All steel for reinforcement shall be free from loose scales, rust coatings, oil, grease, paint or other harmful matters immediately before placing the concrete. To ensure this, reinforcements with rust coatings shall be cleaned thoroughly before bending/placement of the same. 8.01.00 Bending and placing Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 39 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 8.01.01 10000011 / HB / 11094 Bending shall be as under: a) Reinforcing bars supplied bent or in coils, shall be straightened before these are cut to size. Straightening of bars shall be done in cold and without damaging the bars. This is to be considered as a part of reinforcement bending and fabrication work. b) Unless otherwise specified, reinforcing steel shall be bent in accordance with procedure specified in lS:2502 and/or as approved by the Owner. Bends and shapes shall comply strictly with the dimensions shown on the approved bar bending schedules and they shall be rechecked by the Contractor before bending and he shall be entirely responsible for their correctness. Bars correctly bent, shall only be used. Unless specified otherwise or directed by the Owner, the detailing of reinforcement shall be in accordance with lS:5525 and SP:34. c) Bending of longitudinal bars for laps shall be done with 1:6 slopes. The ends of column bars at the top of columns shall be bent horizontally at the just below the beam bars permitting full development length ofeam bars. The beam column junction reinforcement shall be tied by U-stirrups to develop full moment connection with good confined concrete. d) No reinforcement shall be bent when in position in the work without approval of the Owner, whether or not it is partially embedded in concrete. Where reinforcement bars are bent aside, at construction joints and afterwards bent back into their original positions, care shall be taken to ensure that, at no time, the radius of the bend is less than 4 times the bar diameters for plain mild steel or 6 times the bar diameters for deformed bars. Care shall also be taken while bending back bars, to ensure that the concrete around the bar is not damaged. e) Welding of bars to obtain continuity shall not be allowed, particularly for cold twisted bars, unless specifically approved by the Owner. If welding is approved, the work shall be carried out as per IS:2751 and lS:9417, according to the best practice and as directed by the Owner. 8.01.02 Placing in Position shall be as under: a) Spacing of bars shall be as indicated in the drawings. Minimum distance between reinforcing bars shall be in accordance with clause 26.3.2 of IS:456. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 40 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 a) All reinforcement shall be accurately fixed and maintained in position as shown on the drawings by such approved means as steel chairs, and/or concrete spacer blocks as per IS:2502. Bars intended to be in contact at crossing points, shall be securely bound together at all such points by two numbers annealed steel wire of 0.9 mm to 1.6 mm size conforming to IS:280 in such a manner that they do not slip over each other at the time of fixing & concreting. The tying of bars shall be in criss-cross manner. b) Binders shall tightly embrace the bars with which these are intended to be in contact and shall be securely held. The vertical distance between successive layers of bars shall be maintained by provision of spacer bars. These shall be so spaced that the main bars do not sag perceptively between adjacent spacers. Bundled bars shall be provided wherever shown on the drawing to facilitate concreting. Location of laps and development lengths, shall be as indicated on the drawings or as directed by Owner. c) The placing of reinforcement shall be completed well in advance of concrete pouring. The reinforcement shall be checked by the Owner, for accuracy of placement and cleanliness. Necessary corrections, as directed by the Owner shall be carried out. Care shall be taken to ensure that projecting ends of ties and other embedded metal do not encroach into the concrete cover. Where concrete blocks are used for ensuring the cover and positioning of reinforcement, these shall be made of mortar 1:2 (1 cement:2 sand) by volume and cured for at least seven days. The sizes and locations of the concrete blocks shall be approved by the Owner. The 28 days crushing strength of cover blocks shall be at least equal to the specified strength of concrete in which the blocks will be embedded. d) Laps and anchorage length of reinforcing bars shall be in accordance with IS:456, unless otherwise specified. If the bars in a lap are not of the same diameter, the smaller diameter will guide the lap length. Laps shall be staggered as far as practicable and as directed by the Owner and not more than 50% of bars shall be lapped at a particular section. Mechanical connections, for splicing reinforcement bars in congested locations may be used by the Contractor, only if approved by the Owner. Reinforcement bars shall not be lapped unless the length required exceeds the maximum available lengths of bars at site. e) Unless otherwise specified by the Owner-, reinforcement shall be placed within the following tolerances : Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 41 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 Tolerance in spacing For effective depth 200 mm or less For effective depth more than 200 mm. +/- 10 mm + /-15 mm 8.02.00 Cover to reinforcement 8.02.01 The correct cover shall be maintained by cement mortar briquettes areother approved means. Reinforcement for footings, grade beams and slabs on sub grade shall be supported on precast concrete blocks as approved by the Owner. The use of pebbles or stones shall not be permitted. 8.02.02 Unless shown otherwise on the drawings, minimum clear concrete cover for reinforcement (exclusive of plaster or other finishes) shall be as follows: a) At each end of a reinforcing bar, not less than 25 mm, nor less than twice the bar diameter, b) For a longitudinal reinforcing bar in a column, 40 mm or bar diameter hichever is more. 25 mm cover may be adopted for columns of minimum dimension 200 mm or under and with longitudinal reinforcement diameter not exceeding 12 mm. c) For longitudinal reinforcing bars in a beam, not less than 25 mm or less than the bar diameter. d) For reinforcement in slabs and walls; not exposed to weather or ground not less than 15 mm nor less than the bar diameter. e) For bottom reinforcement in footings; 75 mm, if concrete is laid against the ground or 50 mm if laid on a layer of lean concrete. f) For retaining walls, grade beams, top and sides of footings and similar surfaces exposed to weather or ground; 50 mm for bars larger than 16 mm and 40 mm for bars upto 16 mm. g) For liquid retaining structures; 40 mm or diameter of main bar, `hichever is larger. h) For any other reinforcement not less than 15 mm, nor less than the diameter of such bar. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 42 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 8.02.03 10000011 / HB / 11094 Special requirements in corrosive atmosphere: Unless special protective coatings are used, the following measures shall be adopted for structures exposed to sever conditions. a) Increased cover thickness may be provided when surfaces of concrete members are exposed to the action of harmful chemicals, acid vapour, saline atmosphere, sulphur smoke, etc. such increase may be between 15 to 50 mm beyond the figures indicated above as may be specified by Owner. b) For reinforced concrete members totally immersed in sea water, the cover shall be 40 mm. more than specified in 8.02.02 c) For reinforced concrete members, periodically immersed in sea water or subject to sea spray, the cover of concrete shall be 50 mm. more than that specified in 8.02.02. 8.02.03 8.02.04 d) For concrete of grade M 25 and above, the additional thickness of cover specified in (a), (b) and (c) above may be reduced to half. In all such cases the covers should not exceed 75 mm. e) Protection to reinforcement in case of concrete exposed to harmful surroundings may also be given by providing a dense impermeable concrete with approved protective coating, as specified on the drawings. In such case the extra cover, mentioned in (c) and (d) above, may be reduced by the Owner, to those shown on the drawing. Unless otherwise specified the tolerance for cover from the required nominal cover shall not deviate by (+) 10/ (-) 0 mm. The bars shall be kept in correct position by the follwing methods : a) In case of beam and slab construction precast cover blocks in cement mortar 1 : 2 (1 cement : 2 coarse sand) about 4 x 4 cm section and of thickness equal to the specified cover shall be placed between the bars and shutterings so as to secure and maintain the requisite cover of concrete over reinforcement. b) In case of cantilevered and doubly reinforced beams or slabs, the vertical distance between the horizontal bars shall be maintained by introducing chairs spacers or support bars of steel at 1.0 metre or at shorter spacing to avoid sagging. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 44 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 c) In case of columns and walls the vertical bards shall be kept in position by means of timber templates with slots accurately cut in them; or with block of cement mortar 1 : 2 (1 cement : 2 coarse sand) of required size suitably tied to the reinforcement to ensure that they are in correct position during concreting. d) In case of other R.C.C. structure such as arches domes, shells, storage tanks etc. a combination of cover blocks, spacers and templates shall be used as directed by Owner. 8.03.00 Inspection & testing 8.03.01 Erected and secured reinforcement shall be inspected and approved by Owner prior to placement of concrete. 8.03.02 Sample bent bars shall be checked to ensure that they conform to the bar bending schedules. Reinforcement in position shall be checked for proper positioning, and rigidity, cover, spacing of bars, placement of chairs and spacers. etc. Also it shall be checked that all bars at crossings are properly tied. 8.03.03 Each batch of reinforcement procured shall be accompanied with manufacturer’s test certificate. In addition, Owner may direct the reinforcement to be tested independently. Reinforcement shall tested in reputed testing laboratory, approved by Owner. The frequency of testing shall be as stipulated by Owner. The cost of testing shall be borne by the contractor. EMBEDDED PARTS 9.00.00 9.00.01 Embedded steel parts shall be supplied, fabricated and erected by the Contractor as as indicated in drawings. 9.00.02 Embedded steel parts shall be supplied, fabricated and erected by the contractor and shall include items such as, but not limited to, foundation grillages, anchor bolts, pipe sleeves, equipment mounting plates, steel rolled sections with or without properly welded lugs, plate inserts, edge protection angles, as shown on the drawings, auxiliary framing for equipment supports, pegstay plugs for door and window frames, miscellaneous frames, etc. Cold worked deformed steel bars shall not be used for lugs. 9.01.00 9.01.01 Foundation bolt assembly Foundation bolt assembly shall comprise of foundation bolts, stiffener plates, washers, nuts, lock nuts, pipe sleeves, etc. Contractor’s scope shall include supply, fabrication, erection and installation in position as per drawings. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 45 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 9.01.02 9.01.03 10000011 / HB / 11094 The fabrication and erection of bolt assemblies shall include threading, cutting, grinding, drilling, welding, etc. complete. The bolts shall have coarse pitch screw thread in the diameter range, 8 to 64 mm and 6 mm pitch screw for diameter greater than 64 mm, as per IS : 4218. For fabrication of any particular size of bolt indicated on the drawing, the diameter of the threaded portion of the bolt shall be considered as th diameter of the bolt unless otherwise mentioned in the drawings. 9.01.04 Fabrication & erection shall be carried out as per lS:800. Welding shall conform to IS:816 and IS:9595, 9.01.05 Every bolt shall be provided with a steel washer, under the nut. The washer shall be flat and minimum outside inscribed circle have a diameter 2.50 times that of the bolt and of suitable thickness. All nuts shall be of steel with well formed hexagonal heads, unless specified otherwise, forged from solid metal and shall be dipped in hot boiled linseed oil as soon as these are made. The nuts shall fit good on the bolts. 9.01.06 During erection, the Contractor shall provide necessary template, temporary bracings, supports, etc. to ensure proper positioning of the assemblies and holding them firmly during concreting or until they are grouted and the grout has set. All materials shall be erected in plumb and in level (unless otherwise specified) and at true locations as shown on the drawings. Threads shall be protected by using PVC tape._All threads for bolts and inserts shall be greased at intervals and kept covered to prevent damage. 9.02.00 Embedded plates, pipes, etc. 9.02.01 The Contractor shall fabricate, transport to site and erect accurately in position all embedded steel parts either by welding, bolting or any other means as approved by the Owner. Exposed surfaces of embedded parts other than holding down bolts, unless otherwise stated, are to be painted with two coats of approved anticorrosive paint (as per lS:2074) and/or bituminous paint as directed. The threads of holding down bolts shall be greased and protected with waterproof tape. 9.02.02 During erection, the Contractor shall provide necessary strong temporary bracings and supports to ensure proper installation of the embedded parts which shall be erected at the true location as shown on the drawings and these shall be in plumb and level (unless otherwise shownon drawings). The drawings prepared for embedded steel parts showing the erection proedure, for major items, wherever necessary. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 46 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 9.02.03 Fabrication & erection shall be carried out as per IS: 800. Welding rods & site/field welding shall conform to IS: 816 and IS: 9595. IS:7634 (part-Ill) shall be followed for PVC pipe works. _9.02.04 Exposed surfaces of embedded materials shall be painted with one coat of anticorrosive paint or bituminous paint, as desired, without any extra cost to the Owner. If welding is to be done subsequently on the exposed surfaces of the embedded parts, the painting for a length of 50 mm beyond each side of the weld line shall be cleaned off _10.00.00 MIXING OF CONCRETE 10.00.01 Concrete shall be mixed in a mechanical mixer conforming to IS:1791. However, mixing shall preferably be done at a single central batching plant, conforming to IS:4925, situated within the area allocated for the Contractor’s particular use as directed by the Owner. The plant shall have a mechanically operated mixer of an approved size and type, capable of ensuring a uniform distribution of the materials throughout the mass and the mass is uniform in colour and consistency. 10.00.02 Water shall not be added into the drum of the mixer, until all the cement and aggregates constituting the batch are already in the drum and dry mixed for at least one minute and are uniformly distributed. Water shall then be added and mixing of each batch shall be continued until there is a uniform distribution of the materials and the mass but in no case shall mixing be done for less than one and half minutes and for at least 40 revolutions after all the water and materials are in the drum. When absorbent aggregates are used or when the mix is very dry, the mixing time shall be extended as directed by the Owner. Mixers shall not be loaded above their rated capacity as this prevents thorough mixing. 10.00.03 The entire contents of the drum shall be discharged before the ingredients for the next batch are fed into the drum. No partly set or remixed or excessively wet concrete shall be used and it shall be immediately removed from site. Each time if the work stops for more than 30 minutes, the mixer shall be thoroughly cleaned and when the next mixing commences, the first batch shall have 10% additional cement. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 47 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 10.00.04 All plain concrete should be preferably mixed in a drum type powder driven machine with a loading hopper which will permit the accurate measure of various ingredients. In exceptional circumstances and/or work in remote areas, hand mixing may be allowed by the Owner, subject to adding 10% extra cement at no extra cost to Owner. The mixing shall be carried out on watertight platform and mixing shall be continued till a uniform colour and consistency of the mix is achieved. 10.01.00 Batching of Concrete 10.01.01 Cement shall always be batched by weight. A separate weighing device shall be provided for weighing cement. Where the weight of cement is determined by accepting the weight per bag, number of bags shall be weighed separately to determine the average net weight of cement per bag and the same shall be checked regularly. 10.01.02 Aggregates shall always be batched by weight.In particular cases, or where weighbatching is not possible proportioning by volume batching may be allowed by the Owner, provided Contractor guarantees the uniformity of aggregates through out the period of construction. For this purpose, the Contractor shall submit to the Owner sufficient data indicating the weight/volume relationship of aggregates for different types of concr ete and after such approval, periodic checks on the weight/volume relationship of the aggregates shall be made by the Contractor to the satisfaction of the Owner. 10.01.03 Where the aggregates are moist and volume batching is adopted, allowance shall be made for bulking in accordance with IS 2386 (Part-III). Suitable adjustments shall be made for the variation in the weight of aggregates due to variation in their moisture contents. 10.01.04 Water may be measured either by weight or by volume. When measured by volume, it shall be by well calibrated conical shaped jar or vessel or from a calibrated tank fitted to the mixer. It is very important to maintain the water cement ratio constant at its correct value. For the correct determination of amount of water to be added in the concrete mix, to maintain the water cement ratio constant, the amount of moisture content in both coarse and fine aggregates shall be taken into consideration, be as frequently as possible. The frequency for a given job being determined by the Owner according to weather conditions. 10.01.05 Any solid admixture, to be added, shall be measured by weight, but liquid or semi-liquid admixture may be measured by weight or volume. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 48 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 10.01.06 The accuracy of batching shall be within the following tolerance: Cement Aggregate Water 2% by weight 5% by weight 0.5% by weight 10.02.00 Ready mix concrete supplied by commercial ready mix concrete plants shall be used only with the approval of Owner. Unless otherwise mentioned in the items no extra will payable on this account. _11.00.00 TRANSPORTATION OF CONCRETE 11.00.01 Concrete shall be handled and conveyed as rapidly as practicable, from the place o f mixing to the place of final laying, by approved means, before the initial setting of the cement starts. Concrete shall be conveyed in such a way that there is no segregation or loss of any of the ingredients and maintaining the required workability. If segregation does occur during transport, the concrete shall be remixed. During very hot or cold weather, if directed by the Owner, concrete shall be transported in deep containers which will reduce the rate of water loss by evaporation in hot weather and heat loss in cold weather, at no extra cost to Owner. 11.00.02 Conveying equipment for concrete shall be mortar tight, well maintained and thoroughly cleaned before commencement of concrete mixing. Such equipment shall be kept free from set concrete. Chutes shall not be used for transport of concrete without the written permission of the Owner. The chute in case permitted to be used shall be of such size and design as to ensure practically continuous flow. Slope of the chute shall be so adjusted that the concrete flow without the use of an excessive quantity of water and without segregation of its ingredients. The delivery end of the chute shall be as close as possible to the point of deposit. 11.00.03 Concrete may be conveyed and placed by mechanically operated equipment, e.g. pumps or pneumatic placers only with the written permission of the Owner, who shall also review the entire scheme for which comprehensive details shall be furnished by the Contractor. 11.00.04 All equipment used for mixing, transporting and placing of concrete shall be maintained in clean condition. All pans, buckets, hoppers, chutes, pipe lines and other equipments shall be thoroughly cleaned after each period of placement. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 49 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 12.00.00 CONCRETE PLACING 12.01.00 Final inspection and approval prior to concrete placement: 12.01.01 Before the concrete is actually placed in position, the inside of the form work shall be inspected to see that they have been cleaned and oiled. Temporary openings shall be provided to facilitate inspection, especially at bottom of columns and wall forms, to permit removal of saw dust, wood shavings, binding wire, rubbish, dirt etc., Opening shall be placed or holes drilled so that these materials and water can be removed easily. Such openings / holes shall be later suitably plugged. 12.01.02 The various traders shall be permitted ample time to install drainage and plumbing lines, floor and trench drain, conduits, hangers, anchors, inserts, sleeves, bolts, frames and other miscellaneous embedments to be cast in the concrete as indicated on the drawing or as necessary for the proper execution of the work. All such embedments shall be correctly positioned and securely held in the forms to prevent displacement during depositing and vibrating of concrete. 12.01.03 Prior to concrete placement, all works shall be inspected and approved by Owner , and if found unsatisfactory, concrete shall not be poured until all defects have been corrected at contractors cost. Approval by Owner of any and all materials and work as required herein shall not relieve contractor from his obligations to produce sound concrete in accordance with the drawings and specifications 12.01.04 Formwork and reinforcement shall be approved in writing by the Owner before concrete is placed. Concrete shall be placed only after all preparations for casting have been approved by the Owner and approval given to proceed with the casting in writing on pour card to be maintained by the Contractor for this purpose and to be submitted alongwith the Contractor’s bills. Placement Concrete shall be placed and compacted in its final position before the cement reaches the initial set and normally concrete shall be compacted in its final position within 30 minutes of leaving the mixer. 12.02.00 12.02.01 12.02.02 Where direct placement is not possible, the Contractor shall provide suitable arrangements such as chutes, tremie, elephant trunks, etc. to confine the movement of concrete as directed by the Owner. Concrete shall not be dropped from a height or handled in a manner which may cause segregation. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 50 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 12.02.03 If concrete is placed by pumping, the consistency shall be the minimum necessary for such conveyance of concrete. Before commencement of regular pumping, the pipeline shall be lubricated by cement mortar (1:2), and once pumping commences, stoppages shall be avoided. 12.02.04 The placing of concrete shall be a continuous operation with no interruption in excess of 30 minutes between the placing of continuous portions of concrete. Concrete shall be placed in continuous horizontal layers of 150 mm or higher thickness as directed by the Owner and thoroughly compacted before placing next layer. The thickness of each layer shall be such that it will be deposited before the previous layer has stiffened. When placing concrete through reinforcing steel, care shall be taken to prevent segregation of the coarse aggregates. 12.02.05 Slabs, beams and similar members shall normally be poured in one operation. In special circumstances, with the approval of the Owner, these can be poured in horizontal layers, but it must be ensured that the under layer is not already hardened. Bleeding of under layer, if any, shall be effectively removed. Moulding, throating, drip course, etc. shall be poured as shown on the drawings or as desired by the Owner. Mass Concrete shall be poured in lifts not exceeding 1.0 m in height unless otherwise indicated on drawings or as directed by the Owner. Horizontal lift shall not be more than 150 cm in thickness, according to provision of IS:457. 12.02.06 12.02.07 No concrete shall be placed in wet weather or an a water covered surface. Any concrete that has been washed by heavy rain shall be entirely removed, if there is any sign of cement and sand having been washed away from the concrete mixture. To guard against damage which may be caused by rain, theworks shall be covered with tarpaulins immediately after the concrete has been placed and compacted before leaving the work unattended. Any water accumulating on the surface of the newly placed concrete shall be removed by approved means and no further concrete shall be placed thereon until such water is removed. To avoid flow of water over / around freshly placed concrete, suitable drains and sumps shall be provided. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 51 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 12.02.08 Concrete, when deposited, shall have a temperature of not less than 5 degrees Centigrade and not more than 40 degree Centigrade. When depositing concrete in very hot weather, precautions shall be taken so that the temperature of wet concrete does not exceed 40 degrees Centigrade while placing. This shall be achieved by stacking aggregates under the shade and keeping them moist, using cold water, reducing the time between mixing by sprinkling water, starting curing before concrete dries out, etc. However, before mixing/placing concrete, when the above temperature conditions vary on either side, approval of the Owner shall be obtained for the method of execution. 12.02.09 Concrete must be placed in its final position before it becomes too stiff to work. On no account water shall be added after the initial mixing. Concrete which has become stiff or has been contaminated with foreign materials and which has not been placed within half an hour of mixing water with cement shall be rejected. 12.02.10 For members involving vertical placing of concrete (eg. Columns, walls, etc.), each lift shall be deposited in horizontal layer extending the full width between shutterings and of such depth that each layer can be easily and effectively vibrated and incorporated with the layer before by means of compaction. 12.02.11 Should any unforeseen occurrence results in a stoppage of concreting for one hour or such other time as might allow the concrete, already placed, to begin to set before the next batches can be placed, the Contractor shall make at his own cost, suitable tongue, and groove construction joint, as approved by the Owner. Any additional reinforcement required as directed by the Owner shall also be provided by the Contractor at his own cost. Before placement of new batches of concrete over that construction joint, the surface preparation according to this specification stipulated earlier, shall be done by the Contractor at his own cost. 12.03.00 Work in Extreme Weather Conditions: 12.03.01 During hot weather (atmospheric temperature above 40 degree centigrade) or cold weather (atmospheric temp at 5 degree centigrade and below) the concreting shall be done as per the procedures and precautions set out in lS:7861 (Parts I and II) 12.03.02 All concrete work performed in hot weather shall be in accordance with IS :456, except as herein modified. Admixtures may be used only when approved by Owner. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 52 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 12.03.04 Adequate provision shall be made to lower concrete temperatures by cool ingredients, eliminating excessive mixing, preventing exposure of mixers and conveyers to direct sunlight and the use of reflective paint, on mixers etc., The temperature of the freshly placed concrete shall not be permitted to exceed 300 deg.C. 12.03.05 Aggregate shall be stock piled in shade and prevented from direct sun rays. Spraying stock piles with water, use of cold water available and burying, insulation, shading and / or painting white the pipe lines and water storage tanks and conveyances. 12.03.06 12.03.07 In order to reduce loss of mixing water, the aggregates, wooden forms, subgrade, adjacent concrete and other moisture absorbing surfaces, shall be well wetted prior to concreting placement and finishing shall be done as quickly as possible. Extra precautions shall be taken for the protection and curing of concrete, Consideration shall be given to continuous water curing and protection against high temperatures and drying hot wind for a period of at least 7 days after concrete has set and after which normal curing procedures may be resumed. 13.00.00 COMPACTION 13.00.01 After the concrete has been placed, it shall be spaded and thoroughly compacted by approved mechanical vibrators to a maximum subsidence without segregation and thoroughly worked around reinforcement or other embedded fixtures into the correct form and shape. Hand tamping in some cases may be allowed subject to the approval of the Owner. Care must be taken to ensure that the inserts, fixtures, reinforcement and formwork are not displaced or disturbed during placing of concrete. 13.00.02 Vibrators shall penetrate both the layer poured and the under layer to ensure good bond and homogeneity and to prevent the formation of cold joints. Immersion vibrators shall not be allowed to come in contact with steel reinforcement after start of initial set. Also, they shall not be allowed to come in contact with forms or finished surfaces. Immersion vibrators shall have a ‘no load’ frequency, amplitude and acceleration as per lS:2505 depending upon the size of the vibrator. Immersion vibrators shall be operated by experienced men. These vibrators shall be immersed not more than 450 mm apart and withdrawn when air bubbles cease to come to the surface. Such vibrators shall in no case be used to push concrete inside the forms and vibrators shall be withdrawn slowly. 13.00.04 13.00.05 Whenever vibration has to be applied externally, the design of formwork and the disposition of vibrators shall receive special consideration to ensure efficient compaction and to avoid surface blemishes. Surface vibrators and form attached vibrator shall not be permitted under normal conditions. Their use shall require written approval of the Owner. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 53 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 14.00.00 PROTECTION AND CURING OF CONCRETE 14.01.00 Protection: 14.01.01 Newly placed concrete shall be protected by approved means from rain, sun and wind. Concrete placed below ground level, shall be protected from falling earth, during and after placing. Concrete placed in ground Containing any deleterious substances, shall be kept free from contact with such ground or with water draining from such ground, during placing of concrete and for a period of at least three days or as otherwise instructed by the Owner. The ground water around newly poured concrete shall be kept down to an approved level by pumping or other approved means of drainage. Adequate steps shall be taken to prevent floatation or flooding. Steps, as approved by the Owner, shall be taken to protect immature concrete from damage by debris, excessive loading, vibration, abrasion, mixing with earth or other deleterious materials, etc. that may impair the strength and durability of the concrete. 14.01.02 14.00.00 PROTECTION AND CURING OF CONCRETE 14.02.00 Curing: 14.02.01 As soon as the concrete has hardened sufficiently, it shall be kept in a damp or wet condition by ponding or by covering with a layer of sacking, canvas, hessian or similar materials and kept continuously wet for at least seven days after final setting. This period may be extended, at the discretion of the Owner, upto fourteen days. Curing of horizontal surfaces exposed to drying winds shall begin immediately after the concrete has hardened. Concrete slabs and floors shall be cured for the periods mentioned above by flooding with water of minimum 25 mm depth. 14.02.02 Quantity of water applied shall be such as to prevent erosion of freshly placed concrete. 14.02.03 Approved curing compounds may be used in lieu of moist-curing with the permission of the Owner. However, such permission may be granted only in specific cases. Such compounds shall be applied to all exposed surfaces of the concrete, as soon as possible after the concrete has set. Curing compounds shall be liquid type while pigmented, conforming to U.S. Bureau of Reclamation Specification. No curing compound shall be used on surface where future blending with concrete, water or acid proof membrane or painting is specified. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 54 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 15.00.00 REPAIRING AND FINISHING OF CONCRETE SURFACES 15.01.00 Inspection and repair of concrete surfaces: 15.01.01 Immediately after the shuttering is removed, the surface of concrete shall be inspected very carefully for all defects. Owner who may permit patching of the defective areas or else reject the concrete unit either partially or entirely. 15.01.02 Holes left by form bolts etc., shall be filled up and made good with mortar composed of one part of cement to one and half parts of sand passing through 2.36 mm IS sieve after removing any loose stones adhering to the concrete. Mortar filling shall be struck off flush at the face of the concrete. Concrete surface shall be finished as described under the particular item of work 15.01.03 Superficial honey combed surfaces and rough patches shall be similarly made good immediately after removal of shuttering, in the presence of Owner and superficiant water and air holes shall be filled in. The mortar shall be well worked into the surface with wooden float. Excess water shall be avoided. Unless instructed otherwise by Owner , the surface of the exposed concrete placed against shuttering shall be rubbed down immediately on removal of shuttering to remove fine or other irregularities, care being taken to avoid damaging the surfaces. Surface irregularities shall be removed by grinding. 15.01.04 If reinforcement is exposes or the honey combing occurs at vulnerable position e.g. ends of beams or columns, it may be necessary to cut out the member completely or in part and reconstruct. The decision of Owner shall be final in this regard. Rejected concrete shall be removed and replaced by Contractor at no additional expense. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 55 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 15.01.05 10000011 / HB / 11094 If only patching is necessary, the defective concrete shall be cut out till solid concrete is reached (or to a minimum depth of 25 mm), the edges being cut perpendicular to the affected surface or with a small under cut if possible, anchors, tees or dowels shall be provided in slots whenever necessary to attach the new concrete securely in place. An area extending several centimeters beyond the edges and the surfaces of the prepared voids shall be saturated with water for 24 hours immediately before the patching material is placed. The area shall be repaired as follows: a) Small size holes having surface dimensions about equal to the depth of the hole, holes left after removal of form bolts, grout insert holes and slots cut for repair of cracks shall be repaired as follows : b) The hole to be patched shall be roughened and thoroughly soaked with clean water until absorption stops. c) A 5 mm thick layer of grout of equal parts of cement and sand shall be well brushed into the surface to be patched followed immediately by the patching concrete which shall be well consolidated with a wooden float and left slightly proud of the surrounding surface. The concrete patch shall be built up in 10mm thick layers. After an hour or more, depending upon weather conditions, it shall be worked off flush with a wooden float and a smooth finish obtained by wiping with hessian. Steel trowel shall not be used for this purpose. The mix for patching shall be of the same materials and in the same proportions as that used in the concrete being repaired, although some reduction in the maximum size of the coarse aggregates may be necessary and the mix shall be kept as dry as possi ble.d) Mortar filling by air pressure (guniting) shall be used for repair of areas to large and / or too shallow for patching with mortar. Patched surfaces shall be given a final treatment to match the colour and texture of the surrounding concrete. White cement shall be substituted for ordinary cement, if so directed by Owner , to match the shade of the patch with the original concrete. 15.01.06 Curing of Patched Work : The patched area shall be covered immediately with an approved non-staining water saturated material such as gunny bags, which shall be kept continuously wet and protected against sun and wind for a period of 24 hours. Thereafter, the patched area shall be kept wet continuously by a fine spray of sprinkling water for not less than 10 days. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 56 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 15.01.07 Approval by Owner : All materials, procedures and operations used in the repair of concrete and also the finished repair work shall be subject to the approval of Owner. All fillings shall tightly bonded to the concrete and shall be sound, free from shrinkage cracks after the fillings have been cured and dried. 15.01.08 Use of bonding agent: The use of epoxy for bonding fresh concrete used for repairs will be permitted upon written approval of Owner. Bonding agents shall be applied in strict accordance with the instruction of the manufacturer. 15.02.00 Finish for formed and un-formed surfaces 15.02.01 The type of finish for formed concrete surfaces shall be as follows, unless otherwise specified by the Ownera. For surfaces against which backfill or concrete is to be placed, no treatment is required except repair of defective areas. b. For surfaces below grade, which will receive waterproofing treatment, the concrete shall be free of surface irregularities which would interfere with proper application of the water proofing materials which is specified for use. 15.02.02 The type of finish for un-formed concrete surfaces shall be as follows, unless otherwise specified by the Owner a. Unless specified, surfaces which will be exposed when the structure is in service shall receive no special finish, except repair of damaged or defective concrete, removal of fins and abrupt irregularities, filling of holes left by form ties and rods and clean up of loose or adhering debris. b. Surfaces which will be exposed to the weather and which would normally be levelled, shall be sloped for drainage, Unless the drawing specify a horizontal surface or shows the slope required, the tops of marrow surfaces such as staircase treads, walls, curbs and parapets shall be stoped across the width approx. as 1 in 30. Broader surfaces such as walkways, roads, parking areas and platforms shall be sloped about 1 In 50. Surfaces that will be covered by backfill or concrete, sub floors to be covered with concrete topping, terrazzo or quarry tile and similar surfaces shall be smooth, screeded and levelled to produce even surfaces. Surface irregularities shall not exceed 6mm. Surfaces which will not be cover ed by backfill, concrete or tile topping such as outside decks, floors of galleries and sumps, parapets, gutters, sidewalks, floors and slabs shall be consolidated, screeded and floated. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 57 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 c. Excess water and laitance shall be removed before final finishing. Floating may be done with hand or power tools and started as soon as the screeded surface has attained a stiffness to permit finishing operations and these shall be the minimum required to produce a surface uniform in texture and free from screed marks or other imperfections. Joints and edges shall be tooled as called for on the drawings or as directed by Owner. 15.03.00 Standard Finish for Exposed Concrete: 15.03.01 Exposed concrete shall mean any concrete other than floors or slabs exposed to view upon completion of the job. Unless otherwise specified on the drawings, the standard finish for exposed concrete shall be of smooth finish. 15.03.02 A smooth finish shall be obtained with the use of forms having smooth and even surfaces and edges. Panels and form linings shall be of uniform size and be as large as practicable and installed with closed joints. Upon removal of forms, the joint marks shall be smoothened off and all blemishes, projections etc. removed leaving the surfaces reasonably smooth and unmarred. Integral Cement Concrete Finish: 15.04.00 15.04.01 When specified on the drawings, an integral cement concrete finish of specified thickness for floors and slabs shall be applied either monolithic or bonded, as specified in the drawings and as per IS :2571. The surface shall compacted and then floated with a wooden float or power floating machine. The surface shall be tested with a strainght edge and any high and low spots eliminated. Floating or trowelling of the finish shall be permitted only after all surface water has evaporated. Dry cement or a mixture of dry cement and sand shall not be sprinkled directly on the surface of the cement finish to absorb moisture or to stiffen the mix. 15.05.00 Rubbed Finish: 15.05.01 A rubbed finish shall be provided only on exposed concrete surfaces as specified on the drawings. Upon removal of forms, all fins and other projections on the surfaces shall be carefully removed, off sets levelled and voids and / or damaged sections immediately saturated with water and repaired by filling with concrete or mortar of the same composition n as was used in the surfaces. The surfaces shall then be thoroughly wetted and rubbed with carborundum or other abrasive. Cement mortar may be used in the rubbing, but the finished surfaces shall not be brush coated with either cement or grout after rubbing. The finished surfaces shall present a uniform and smooth appearance. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page58 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 16.00.00 JOINTS IN CONCRETE : deleted 17.00.00 CEMENT ADDITIVES/ADMIXTURES IN CONCRETE : DELETED 19.00.00 PRECAST CONCRETE ELEMENTS 19.00.01 Precast concrete elements such as columns, fencing posts, door and window frames, lintels, chajjas, copings, sills, shelves, cover slabs, louvers etc., shall be of grade of mix as specified in the drawings. Concrete for Precast concrete shall comply with IS : 456. 19.00.02 Precast concrete elements shall be cast in forms or moulds. The forms / mould shall be of fiber glass or of steel sections for better finish. Provision shall be made in the forms and moulds to accommodate fixing devices such as nibs, clips, hooks, bolts and forming of notches and holes. 19.00.03 Elements shall be cast on suitable bed or platform with firm foundation and free from wind. The contractor may precast the units on a cement or steel platform which shall be adequately oiled provided the surface finish is of the same standard as obtained in the forms. Each unit shall be cast in one operation. Contractor shall be responsible for the accuracy of the level or shape of the bed or platform 19.00.05 Precast elements shall have a dense surface finish showing no coarse aggregate and shall have no cracks, crevices or other defects that would interfere with the proper placing of the units. All angles of the precast units with the exception of the angles resulting from the splayed or chamfered faces shall be true right angles. The arises shall be clean and sharp except those specified or shown to be rounded. The wearing surface shall be true to the lines. On being fractured, the interior of the units should present a clean homogenous appearance. 19.01.00 Marking, Curing & Lifting: 19.01.01 If so required, Pre-cast units shall be clearly marked with identification name, the top of member and its location and orientation in the structure. The reinforced side of the units shall be distinctly marked. 19.01.01 After having been cast in the mould or form the concrete shall be adequately protected during setting in the first stages of hardening from shocks and from harmful effects of frost, sunshine, drying winds and cold. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 59 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 19.01.02 All precast work shall be cured for at least 7 days after casting and during that period each units shall be kept constantly watered or preferably by completely immersed in water if the size of unit so permits. 19.01.03 No precast unit shall be lifted until the concrete reaches a strength of at least twice the stress to which the concrete may be subjected at the time of lifting. The precast articles shall be matured for 28 days before erection or beig built in so that the concrete shall have sufficient strength to prevent damage to units when first handled 19.01.04 Precast units shall be stored, transported and placed in position in such a manner that they will not be overstressed or damaged. The lifting and removal of precast units shall be undertaken without causing shocks, vibration or under bending stresses to or in the units. Before lifting and removal takes place, contractor shall satisfy Owner or his representative that the methods he proposes to adopt for these operations will not over stress or otherwise affect seriously the strength of the precast units. 20.00.00 SAMPLING, TESTING AND QUALITY ASSURANCE 20.01.00 General 20.01.01 Concrete cubes for works tests shall be cured under laboratory conditions, except when in the opinion of the Owner, extreme weather conditions prevail at which time, these may require curing under job conditions. 20.01.02 For the purposes of statistical analysis, any substandard cube result, which in the opinion of the Owner, is due to improper sampling, moulding or testing shall be discarded and a dummy result shall be substituted. The value of a dummy result shall be equivalent to the average value of the cubes from the same grade of concrete tested immediately before and after the discarded result. The number of such substandard cubes shall not exceed 5%. 20.01.03 If the ‘strength’ of the laboratory controlled cubes, for any portion of the concrete work, falls below the compressive strength specified, the Owner shall have the right to order a change in the proportions or the water content for the remaining portion of the structure. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 60 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 20.01.04 If the ‘strength’ of the works cured test cubes falls below the specified strength, the Owner shall have the right to require provisions for temperature and moisture control during the period of curing as necessary to secure the required strength, and may require retests in accordance with the ‘standard method of securing, preparing and testing specimens from hardened concrete for compressive and flexural strengths, or load tests to be made on the portion of the building so affected. All such tests shall be made at the Contractor’s expense. 20.01.05 Unacceptable concrete work shall be dismantled by the Contractor and replaced by fresh work, meeting the specification requirements. In the course of dismantling, if any damage is done to the embedded items or adjacent structures, the same shall be made good, by the Contractor, to the satisfaction of the Owner, at no extra cost. 20.01.06 Only as a very special case and that too in non-critical areas, the Owner may accept concrete work which is marginally unacceptable as per the criteria laid down in lS:456. For such accepted work, payment shall be made at a reduced rate prorata to the concrete cube strength obtained, against that stipulated. 20.01.07 If directed by Owner, Ultrasonic tests on structures to ascertain the quality and grade of concreting shall be carried out. Contractor shall arrange for the specialized agency for conducting the test at his cost. The Contractor shall provide all the necessary facilities and arrangement for conducting the test at site in terms of access, scaffolding etc. In case of any defects, the Contractor shall rectify the same as directed by the Owner. Rebound hammer test shall be carried out for ascertaining the quality of concrete work, as directed by the Owner. Test shall be conducted for the water tightness of the liquid retaining structures as per lS:3370 and IS:6494. The details and sequence of tests shall be as given hereunder: a) All arrangements, including supply of water for testing purposes, shall be kept ready when the tank is nearing completion. b) Water supply to the tank shall be in stages of 300 to 450 mm height in order to check the water tightness of the tank at full water level and location of leakage of various levels. c) The permissible drop in level in 24 hours shall be 6 mm in case of covered reservoir/tank and 12 mm in the case of open reservoir-tank. If the structure does not satisfy the conditions of test and the daily drop in water level is decreasing the period of test may be extended for further seven days and if specified limit is then reached, the structure may be considered satisfactory. 20.01.08 Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 61 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 d) The leakage points shall be marked and separately treated after dewatering e) The underground structures /water retaining structures shall be retested for water tightness after rectification. For basement type structures like basin, neutralising pit, etc. the Contractor shall examine the water tightness against ingress of sub-soil water. 20.01.09 Optional Tests : a) Owner , if he so desires, may order for tests to the carried out on cement, sand, coarse aggregate, water etc., in accordance with the relevant Indian Standards. b) Tests on cement will be carried out by department and shall include (I) fineness test, (ii) test for normal consistency, (iii) test for setting time, (iv) test for soundness (v) test for compressive strength, (vi) test for heat of hydration (by experiment and by calculations) in accordance with IS :269. c) Tests on sand shall included (i) sieve test, (ii) test for organic impurities, (iii) decantation test for determining clay and silt content, (iv) specific gravity test, (v) test for unit weight and bulkage factor, (vi) test for sieve analysis and fineness modulus. d) Tests on coarse aggregate shall include (i) sieve analysis, (ii) specific gravity and unit weight of dry, loose and rodded aggregate, (iii) soundness and alkali aggregate reactivity, (iv) petrographic examination, (v) deleterious materials and organic impurities, (vi) test for aggregate crushing value. 20.02.00 Sampling of Concrete 20.02.01 Samples from fresh concrete shall be taken according to lS:1199 and tested as per IS:516. 20.02.02 Normally only compressive test shall be performed but the Owner may require other tests to be performed in accordance with lS:516. 20.02.03 Trial Mixes & mix design: At least four trial mixes shall be made with minimum 6 test cubes for each mix. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 62 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 20.02.04 10000011 / HB / 11094 Works Tests: a) The minimum. frequency of sampling of concrete of each grade shall be according to clause 15.2.2 of lS:456. However, after getting continuo us satisfactory results and in the case of voluminous concrete works, the Owner, may at his discretion reduce the frequency of sampling as follows. b) For each grade of concrete, and for each 8 hours (shift) of work or part thereof, at least one sample consisting of six specimens shall be taken from each 150 cum. of concrete or part thereof, 3 specimens shall be tested at 7 days and remaining 3 shall be tested at 28 days. However, in all cases, the 28 days compressive strength shall alone be the criterion for acceptance or rejection. c) To control the consistency of concrete from every mixing, slump tests and compaction factor tests in accordance with lS:1199 shall be carried out by the Contractor every two hours or as directed by the Owner. Slumps corresponding to the test specimens shall be recorded for reference. d) The strength of sample shall be the average of the strength of three specimens. The individual variation should not be more than ± 15% `of the average. 20.03.00 Acceptance Criteria 20.03.01 The acceptance criteria of concrete shall be in accordance with clause no.16 of IS456. However, in exceptional circumstances, the Owner may. at his discretion, accept a concrete of lower strength than that specified at reduced rates. 20.03.02 In case of doubt regarding the grade of concrete used or results of cube strength are observed to be lower than the designed strength as per specifications at 28 days, compressive strength test of concrete based on core test, ultrasonic test and / or load test shall be carried out by the digital ultrasonic concrete tester by an approved agency as directed by the Owner all at the cost of the contractor 20.03.03 Core Test: a) The points from which cores are to be taken and the number of cores required, shall be at the discretion of the Owner and shall be representative of the whole of concrete concerned. In no case, however, shall fewer than three cores be tested. Cores shall be prepared and tested as described in IS : 516-1959. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 63 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 b) Concrete in the member represented by a core test shall be considered acceptable if the average equivalent cube strength of the cores is equal to at least 85% of the cube strength of the grade of concrete specified for the corresponding age and no individual core has a strength less than 75%. c) In case the core test results do no satisfy the requirements as above or where such tests have not been done, load test may be resorted to. 20.03.04 Other non-destructive test such as ultrasonic sound methods may be adopted, in which case the acceptance criteria shall be agreed upon between the Owner and the contractor and the test shall be done under expert guidance. 20.03.05 Load Test: If in the opinion of the Owner, the safety of the structure, or any part of the structure is in doubt and the results of other tests are not encouraging, the Owner may direct load lest to be conducted before ordering its removal and reconstruction, in accordance with the provision of clause no.17.60 of IS:456-2000. 20.03.06 Load Tests on Parts of Structure : a) Load tests should be carried out as soon as possible after expiry of 28 days from the time of placing of concrete. b) The structure should be subjected to a load equal to full dead load of the structure plus 1.25 times the imposed load for a period of 24 hours and then the imposed load shall be removed. Dead load includes weight of the structural members plus weight of finishes and walls of partitions, if any, as considered in the design. c) The deflection due to imposed load only shall be recorded. If within 24 hours of removal of the imposed load, the structure does not recover at least 75% of the deflection under super imposed load, the test may be repeated after a lapse of 72 hours. If the recovery is less than 80% the structure shall be deemed to be unacceptable. d) If the maximum deflection in mm shown during 24 hours under load is less than 40 L/D, where L is the effective span in M and D the overall depth of the section in mm, it is not necessary for recovery to be measured and the recovery provision as above will not apply. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 64 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 20.03.07 In case these tests do not satisfy the requirements, the Owner will be at liberty to reject the concrete, and the contractor, at his own cost, has to dismantle and redo the same or carry out such remedial measures as approved by the Owner. 21.00.00 Application of Live Load The designated live load shall be allowed on any structure only after 28 days, after proper curing is carried out on the last concrete poured in structure. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 65 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 1.00.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 MASONRY AND ALLIED WORKS SCOPE This section of the specification covers, furnishing, installation including handling, transporting, batching, mixing. laying, scaffolding, centering, shuttering, finishing, curing, protection and repairing till handing over of brick masonry and allied works including DPC and plinth protection. 2.00.00 GENERAL REQUIREMENTS 2.01 .00 The Contractor shall furnish all skilled and unskilled labour, plant, equipment, scaffolding, materials, etc. required for complete execution of the work in accordance with the drawings and as described herein and/or as directed by the Owner. 2.02.00 All workmanship shall be in accordance with the latest standards and best possible practice. Masonry work shall be true to line & level as shown on drawings. All such masonry shall be tightly built against structural members and bonded with dowels, anchors, inserts, etc. as shown on the drawings. 2.03.00 The Contractor shall carryout all works for setting out the building lines,locating the co-ordinates and establishing the reduced levels (RL’s) on the basis of reference grid lines and bench mark, which shall be furnished by the Owner, at one or more locations. 2.04.00 Any approval, instructions permission, checking, review, etc. whatsoever by the Owner shall not relieve the Contractor of his responsibility and obligation regarding adequacy, correctness, completeness, safety, strength, quality, workmanship, etc. 3.00.00 CODES AND STANDARDS 3.01.00 All applicable standards, acts and codes of practice referred to shall be the latest editions including all applicable official amendments and revisions. A complete set of all these documents shall generally be available at site, with the Contractor. 3.02.00 In case of conflict between this specification and those (IS Standards, Codes etc.) referred to in clause 3.03.00 the former shall prevail. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 66 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 3.03.0 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 Some of the applicable Indian standards, Codes, etc. are referred to here below: IS: 516 1959 Method of strength test for concrete IS: 702 1988 Specification for industrial bitumen IS: 1077 1992 Specification for Common burnt clay bricks IS: 1200 (Part 3) 1976 Method of measurement of building and civil Engineering works - Brickwork IS: 1200 (Part 4) 1976 Method of measurement of building and civil Engineering works – Stone masonry IS: 1200 (Part 8) 1974 Method of measurement of building and civil Engineering works – Demolition & dismantling IS : 2116 1980 Specification for sand for masonry mortars IS:2212 1991 Code of practice for brick work IS:2250 1981 Code of practice for preparation and use of masonry mortar IS: 2386 (Part 1) 1963 Methods of test for aggregate for concrete – Particle size & shape IS: 2386 (Part 2) 1963 Methods of test for aggregate for concrete – Estimation of deleterious materials and organic impurities IS: 2691 1988 Specification for burnt clay facing work IS 3025 (Part 15) 1984 Methods of sampling and test (physical & chemical) for water & waste water – Total residue (totals solids dissolved and suspended) IS:3414 1968 Design and installation of joint in buildings IS: 3495 (Part 1) 1992 Method of tests for burnt clay building bricks – Determination of compressive strength IS: 3495 (Part 2) 1992 Method of tests for burnt clay building bricks – Determination of water absorption IS: 3495 (Part 3) 1992 Method of tests for burnt clay building bricks – Determination of efflorescence IS: 3495 (Part 4) 1992 Method of tests for burnt clay building bricks – Determination of warpage IS:3696 (Part 1) 1987 Safety code for scaffolds and ladders - Scaffolding IS:3696 (Part 2) 1991 Safety code for scaffolds and ladders - Ladders IS: 4031 (Part 5) 1998 Methods of physical tests for hydraulic cements - Determination of initial and final setting time IS: 4031 (Part 7) 1998 Methods of physical tests for hydraulic cements - Determination of compressive strength of masonry cement IS:4130 1991 Safety code during demolition of buildings IS:4326 1993 Code of practice for earth quake resistant design and construction of buildings SP : 20 1991 Hand book on masonry design & construction SP: 25 1984 Handbook on causes and prevention of cracks in buildings 4.00.0 BRICK MASONRY 4.01.0 Materials 4.01.01 Properties of common building materials for masonry, viz., burnt clay bricks, sand, lime accordance with the technical specification for Handling of Common Building Materials. 4.01.02 IS:2250 shall be followed as general guidance for preparation and use of mortar. Only cement-sand mortar shall be used. Lime shall be added for composite mortar with specific approval of the Owner. 4.01.03 Unless otherwise specified, mortar for brickwork having one or more brick thickness shall be 1 part cement and 6 parts sand by volume. Mortar for halfbrick thick walls shall be 1 part cement and 4 parts sand by volume. Richer mix proportion shall be used, whenever specified or as per design requirement. Mortar shall meet the compressive strength requirement as per IS:2250 and IS:1905. Sand shall conform to IS:2116. Grading of sand shall be tested as per IS:2386 (Part 1) Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 67 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 4.01.04 Sand, whose grading falls outside the specified limits due to excess or deficiency of coarse or fine particles, may be processed to comply with the standard by screening through a suitably sized sieve and/or blending with required quantities of suitable sizes of sand particles. 4.01.05 Cement and sand shall be thoroughly mixed dry in a mechanical mixer and water shall then be added to obtain a mortar of the consistency of a stiff paste, care being taken to add just sufficient water for the purpose. Water shall be clean and free from injurious amount of deleterious matter such as oil, acid, alkali, salt and vegetable growth. Hand mixing may be allowed by the Owner on clean approved platform in special cases only. Mortar shall be used as early as possible after mixing, before it begins to set and preferably within 30 minutes after water is added to the dry mixture. Mortar unused for more than 30 minutes shall generally be rejected and removed from site of work. However, the Owner may allow the use of mortar upto 2 hours. Surplus mortar droppings while laying masonry, if received on a su rface free from dirt, may be mixed with fresh mortar if permitted by the Owner, who may direct for addition of extra cement and this shall be implemented. 4.02.00 Laying 4.02.01 Bricks shall be soaked in water before use for at least six (6) hours. The contractor shall provide tanks of sufficient capacity to allow the specified immersion. Bricks shall be laid in water by hand and not thrown. The bricks shall not be too wet at the time of use, as they are likely to slip on the mortar bed and there will be difficulty in ensuring plumb ness of the wall. _4.02.02 Brickwork in general shall be as per IS 2212-1991. Bricks shall be laid in English bond, unless otherwise specified, with frogs upward over a full bed of evenly laid mortar, and slightly pressed and tapped into final position to the lines levels and shape as shown in the drawing fully embedded in mortar. All joints including inside faces shall be flushed and packed. Not more than 8 courses shall generally be laid in a day. The first course itself shall be made horizontal by providing enough mortar in the bed joint to fill up any undulations. The horizontality of courses and the verticality of wall sh all be checked very often with spirit level and plumb bob respectively. Damaged or broken brick or brick bats shall not be used in brick work. Cut bricks may be used to complete bond or as closers or around irregular openings. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 68 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 _4.02.03 Half-brick masonry Half-brick work shall be done in the same manner as for brick work except that all courses shall be laid in stretchers. Both faces shall be true to plane and the joints raked on both faces. 4.03.00 Raking Out Joints Joint of brick work shall be raked out to a depth of 12 mm using appropriate tool , at the time of laying and face of brickwork shall be kept clear of all mortar. 4.04.00 Corbelling, Cornices, String Courses Corbelling shall be effected by 1/4 brick projection for ordinary work and 1/8 brick projection required from consideration of strength. Reinforcing Anchorage For external walls, the anchors in the form of flats or rods from spandrel beams and columns and any other anchoring and reinforcement as shown on drawing shall be adequately embedded in the masonry. 4.05.00 4.06.00 Protection of brick work The brick work shall be protected and covered with gunny bags or water proof sheets from the effects of inclement weather, rain, frost, etc., during the construction and until the mortar sets. 4.07.00 Curing: All brick works shall be kept moist for 10 days after laying. 4.08.00 Brick-on-edge coping, brick paving and cut brick corner: The top course of all plinths, parapets, steps and tops of walls below R.C.C. slabs, beams and paving etc. shall be laid with brick-on-edge, unless specified otherwise. Care shall be taken that bricks forming the top corners and ends of walls shall be properly radiated and keyed into position as specified in IS:2212. 5.00.00 SCAFFOLDING Double scaffolding having two sets of vertical supports shall be provided except in case of building upto two storeys where single scaffolding may be used if permitted by the Owner. The supports shall be sound and strong and of steel tubular construction unless otherwise permitted by the Owner. The vertical posts shall be tied together with horizontal pieces over which the scaffolding planks shall be fixed. In cases where single scaffolding has been allowed by the Owner, the inner ends or horizontal scaffolding poles shall rest in a hole provided in the header course only. One header for each hole shall be left out. Such holes, however, shall not be allowed in pillars having width less than one metre, or immediately near the skew backs of arches. The holes left in masonry work for supporting the scaffolding shall be immediately filled and made good before plastering. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 69 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6.00.00 STONE MASONRY 6.01.00 Random rubble masonry : 6.01.01 The rubble shall be of the best quality trap / granite / ballast stones obtained from the approved quarry. The sample of the stone, to be used shall be got approved from the Engineer-in-Charge. All stones shall, generally be freshly quarried and shall be sound, dense, hard, free from segregation, cracks, weathered portions and other structural defects or imperfections, tending to off set soundness and strength. The percentage of water absorption shall generally not exceed 5% by weight. All stones shall be wetted before use. Stones shall be neatly worked to requisite sections and forms and shall have fully dressed beds and joints. At least 50% of the stones shall be 0.015 cum. in content when reckoned individually. The length of stones for stone masonry shall not exceed three times the height and the breadth or base shall not be greater than three fourth the thickness of wall, or not less than 15 cm. The height of stone may be upto 30 cm. Stones shall be laid on the natural beds and shall run sufficiently inside the wall thickness. No hollow space shall be left out and inter spaces of stones being filled with mortar and stone chips, driven hard and not with mortar only. 6.01.02 All mortar to be used shall be of the type and proportion mentioned in the item. Cement, sand and water to be used shall conform to their relevant specifications as described under cement concrete. The masonry shall be laid to plumb, lines levels, curves, shapes as shown in drawings. All required holes for passage of water or pipes are to be embedded during construction as specified. 6.02.03 All stones shall be wetted before laying in masonry. Concrete surfaces of columns, beams, lintels, chajjas etc. coming in contact with masonry shall be properly chipped, washed and wetted before start of masonry work. The concrete surface coming in contact of masonry shall be given a thick coat of cement slurry as the masonry work progress in height. Clean chips and spawls carefully selected to fit in the space shall be wedged into the mortar joints and beds wherever necessary to avoid thick beds or joints or mortar. However, proper shaping and dressing of stones shall be done prior to their layin g in masonry and hammering shall not be resorted to often after the stones are laid in position. The bond stones shall be used in every square meter area of masonry wall and shall extend from front to back to thin walls having width of 600 mm. and shall overlap by at least 150 mm. in walls having thickness more than 600 mm. when laid from both sides. When the work has to be started on the old or the one completed a long while ago or in the previous working seasons. Care shall be taken to roughen and clean old surface satisfactorily without disturbing the masonry before laying the new. It shall be wetted before laying the bedding mortar. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 70 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6.02.04 When practicable, the whole masonry in any structure shall be carried out upto a uniform level throughout. But when breaks are unavoidable in carrying the work continuously in uniform level, sufficiently long steps shall be left. All junction of walls shall be formed at the time when walls are being built. Cross walls should be carefully bonded into the main walls. All masonry built in cement mortar shall be kept continuously wet for 14 days from the date of laying. Should the mortar perish i.e. becomes dry, white or powder through neglect of watering and if the masonry shows hollow joints or non adherence of mortar to the stones or if the work does not conform to drawings and specifications, the work shall be pulled down and rebuilt by the contractor at his own cost and risk. All masonry shall be thoroughly cleaned and washed down on completion and all stains, adhering mortar removed from the surface and raking of joints carried out as the scaffolding is being lowered and removed. Holes left in masonry for supporting scaffolding shall be filled and made good before pointing / plastering. 6.02.00 Coursed rubble masonry : 6.02.01 The specifications for Random rubble masonry as given in Para 6.01.00 shall generally apply to these for quality of stones, workmanship etc. except for the following. The face of the stones shall be square / rectangular in shape and shall be so dressed all-round that those can be set on proper bases and shall render uniform joints. The stones may have bushing on the face but shall not project more than 40 mm. the external faces shall be laid in courses of about 200 mm. height or as specified and the internal face shall be finished with rubble backing. 6.02.02 6.02.03 The other specifications shall be same as per specifications for R.R. Masonry mentioned above. 7.00.00 PRECAST CEMENT CONCRETE SOLID BLOCK MASONRY : 7.01.01 Precast cement concrete solid blocks shall be of best quality locally available / manufactured at site and should be approved by the Engineer-in-Charge before incorporation in the work. The ingredient and cement concrete used stall confirm to relevant I.S. as stipulated in specification for cement concrete works herein before. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 71 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 7.01.02 Minimum crushing strength of the solid blocks shall be 40 to 60 kg / Sqcm. at 28th day after curing. The type of the bond to be adopted will be decided by the Engineer-in-Charge but vertical joints shall be staggered. The size of the blocks shall be 390 x 1 40 mm and 390 x 190 x 100 mm. and the proportion used in making the blocks shall be 1:11 (1 cement : 11 fine and coarse aggregates). The blocks shall be cured well at least for 14 days before incorporation in to the work. The cement mortar for concrete blocks masonry shall be 1:4 and joints shall not be more than 10 mm. thick. 7.01.03 The workmanship shall be as stipulated in the specification for brick work as applicable. The rate quoted shall include cost of all materials, labour including form work in casting the blocks curing transporting, handling, hosting the blocks to proper level, curing masonry etc. complete. 8.00.00 DAMP PROOF COURSE (DPC) 8.01.00 Damp proof course shall be 50 mm thick (unless specified otherwise) consisting of cement concrete in the proportion 1:1 1/2:3 (1 cement, 1 ½ sand, 3 stone chips 10 mm down) with admixture of a water proofing compound as approved by the Owner. The percentage of admixture shall be as per manufacturer’s specification. 8.02.00 The surface of the brick work/ stone masonry work shall be leveled and prepared before laying the cement -concrete. Edges of DPC shall be straight and even. The side shuttering shall consist of wooden forms and shall be strongly and properly fixed so that it does not get disturbed during compaction and mortar does not leak through. The concrete mix shall be of workable consistency and dense. When the side shuttering is removed the surface should come smooth without any honey combing. The top surface shall be double chequerred and cured by ponding for at least 7 days. Cement concrete shall be allowed to dry for 24 hours after curing and hot bitumen of grade 85/25 Conforming to IS: 702 at the rate of 1.7 kg/sqm shall be applied over the dried surface of cement concrete properly cleaned with brushes and finally with a cloth soaked in kerosene oil. The bitumen shall be applied uniformly so that no blank spaces are left anywhere. 8.03.00 9.00.00 PLINTH PROTECTION 9.01.00 Unless otherwise shown on drawing plinths of all buildings shall be protected with 1000 mm wide plinth protection consisting of 50 mm thick PCC M20 grade with 12 mm maximum size aggregate over 200 mm thick stone soling using 40 mm nominal size rammed consolidated & grouted with fine sand. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 72 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 9.02.00 For the purpose of stone filling, the ground shall be dressed consolidated by ramming or by light rolling & a 12 mm thick cushion of sand be laid. Over this 75 mm thick layer of stone aggregate, with stone size not more than 40 mm, shall be spread uniformly. This shall be then compacted by light roller (by 1/2 ton roller & 4 to 5 passes) or any other means as approved by Owner. After compacting, sand shall be uniformly spread & water shall be sprayed over it to ensure that the voids are filled with sand. Water shall be spread in such a manner that bulking in sand does not take place. 9.03.00 This process shall be repeated till the filling reaches the desired level. When it reaches the finished level, surface shall be flooded with water for 24 hours, allowed to dry & then rammed & consolidated to avoid any settlement at a later stage. 9.04.00 Plinth protection shall be laid with a minimum outward slope of 1:50. 10.00.00 SAMPLING TESTING AND QUALITY CONTROL 10.01.00 General a) The Contractor shall carry out all sampling and testing in accordance with the relevant Indian Standards and/or International Standards and shall conduct such tests as are called for by the Owner. Where no specific testing procedure is mentioned, the tests shall be carried out as per the prevalent accepted Engineering practice to the directions of the Owner. Tests shall be done in the field and at a laboratory approved by the Owner and the Contractor shall submit to the Owner, the test results in triplicate within three days after completion of a test. The Owner may, at his discretion, waive -off some of the stipulations given below, for small and unimportant operations. b) Material/work found unsuitable for acceptance, shall be removed and replaced by the Contractor. The works shall be redone as per specification requirements and to the satisfaction of the Owner. 10.02.00 Quality Assurance Programme The Contractor shall submit and finalise a detailed Field Quality Assurance Programme within 15 days from the date of award of the Contract according to the requirements of the specification. This shall include setting up of a testing laboratory, arrangement of testing apparatus/equipment, deployment of qualified/experienced manpower, preparation of format for record, field quality plan etc. On finalised field quality plan, Owner shall identify, customer’s hold points beyond which work shall not proceed without written approval from the Owner. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page73 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10.03.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 Frequency of sampling and testing including the methods for conducting the tests are given in Table below. The testing shall be done at site. The testing frequencies set forth are the desirable minimum and the Owner shall have the full authority to carry out or call for tests as frequently as he may deem necessary to satisfy himself that the materials and works comply with the appropriate specifications. Some of the type tests and performance tests which are not included in the table shall be carried out at the manufacturers premises or at an independent Government approved laboratory. FREQUENCY OF SAMPLING AND TESTING SL NO. I Type of Material /Work Burnt bricks & Fly ash lime Bricks Nature of Test / Characteristics Method of test Dimensions Relevant clause of IS : 1077 for burnt clay bricks and IS:12894 for fly ash lime bricks IS:3495(Part-I) Compressive Strength Water absorption II III IV V Sand Cement Water Mortar General Quality Visual Deleterious material IS:2386(Part-II) Grading Sieve analysis as per IS:2386 (Part-I) Setting time IS:4031(part 5) Compressive Strength IS:4031(part 7) Harmful substances, pH Value Initial setting time Compressive strength Compressive Strength IS:3025(part 11) Consistency Appendix-B of IS:2250 Appendix-C of IS:2250 Visual & Physical measurement Physical measuement Water Retentivity VI Masonry Construction IS:3495(Part-II) Workmanship Verticality and Alignment IS:4031(part 5) IS:516 Appendix-A of IS:2250 No. of Samples & frequency of Test Remarks Max. 8 % deviation for non modular bricks. For modular bricks as per clause no. 5.2 of IS:1077. for face bricks as per IS:2691. For fly ash lime bricks as per IS:12894 As specified A set of 20 bricks (min.) for each lot of 50,000 or part thereof for all tests(a to c) One set of samples from each source of material per 100 cu.m. or part thereof One set of samples from each source of material per 100 cum or part thereof. One set of sample from each source of material per 100 cum. or part thereof. One set of sample for each lot of material received One set of sample for each lot of material received Once a month for each source Once a month for each source Once a month for each source One sample( Consisting of min. 3 specimens) One sample for each type of mix One sample for each type of mix All work Max. 20%. However 15% for face bricks only As Specified Clause 3.3. of IS:2116 Table 1 of IS:2116 No separate testing is required in case cement is tested for preparation of concrete mix. No separate testing is required in case cement is tested for preparation of concrete mix. No separate testing is required in case water is tested for preparation of concrete mix. No separate testing is required in case water is tested for preparation of concrete mix. No separate testing is required in case water is tested for preparation of concrete mix. Table-1 of IS:2250 Clause 7.2 of IS:2250 Clause 7.3 of IS:2250 As per specification and clause no. 11.0 of IS:2212 for brickwork. All work Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 74 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10.04.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 All masonry shall be built true and plumb within the tolerances prescribed as below. Care shall be taken to keep the perpends properly aligned. a) Deviation in verticality in total height of any wall of a building more than one storey in height shall not exceed +/- 12.5 mm. b) Deviation from vertical within a story shall not exceed +/- 6 mm per 3 m height. c) Deviation from the position shown on the plan of any brickwork more than one storey in height shall not exceed 12.5 mm. d) Relative displacement between load bearing walls in adjacent storeys intended to be in vertical alignment shall not exceed 6 mm. e) Deviation of bed joint from horizontal in any length upto 12 m shall not exceed 6mm, and in any length over 12m it shall not exceed 12.5 mm total. f) Deviation from the specified thickness of bed-joints, cross-joints or perpends shall not exceed ± 3 mm. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 75 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 PLASTERING & POINTING 1.00.00 SCOPE 1 .01.00 This specification covers the plastering work on brick or concrete faces of specified thickness with architectural features wherever necessary. For application of Cement and Cement lime - plaster finishing IS:1661-1972 “Code of practice for application of cement and lime plaster finishes” shall be applicable. 2.00.00 MIX 2.01.00 Mortar for plastering in the proportion as specified on drawings/ specification, shall be mixed in a dry state and then wetted and mixed thoroughly to obtain the required consistency. The mortar shall be mixed in an approved manner including machine mixing if desired by the Owner and in batches so that the mortar is consumed within half an hour of mixing. Any mortar for plaster which is partially set shall be rejected and removed from site. 2.02.00 The mix for plastering shall be as follows: 230 brick wall Outside Plaster Inside Plaster 115 brick wall (To be used only for inside walls) Concrete Ceiling Plaster 3.00.00 3.01.00 3.02.00 3.03.00 3.04.00 First layer (base coat) of 12 mm thick 1:6 (1 Cement, 6 Fine sand and second layer (finish coat) of 6 mm thick 1 : 4 (1 Cement, 4 Fine sand) 12 mm thick 1 : 6 (1 Cement, 6 Fine sand) 12 mm thick 1: 4 (1Cement, 4 Fine sand) 6 mm thick - 1 : 4 (1Cement, 4 Fine sand) APPLICATION Before application of plaster, surface is to be prepared conforming to IS:1661 latest revision. In all plaster work, mortar shall be applied with somewhat more than that the required thickness and well pressed into the joint and in the surface and rubbed and levelled with a flat wooden rule to give required thickness. Plaster, when more than 12 mm thick, shall be applied in two coats base coat followed by the finishing coat. Thickness of base coat shall be just sufficient to fill up all unevenness in the surface; no single coat, however, shall exceed 12 mm in thickness. The undercoat shall be thicker than the upper coat. The overall thickness of the plaster shall not be less than the minimum thickness shown in the drawings or specified in the specification. The undercoat shall be allowed to dry and shrink before applying the second coat of plaster. Cement mortar for plastering work shall be used within 30 minutes after adding water to cement and should be kept agitated at intervals of 20 minutes. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 76 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 3.05.00 The undercoat shall be scratched or roughened before it is fully hardened to form a mechanical key. The method of application shall be ‘thrown on’ rather than ‘applied by trowel’. The finished surface shall be true to line and plumb and the Contractor shall without any extra cost to Owner make up any irregularity in the masonry/ concrete work with plaster. The mortar shall adhere to the surface intimately when set and there should be no hollow sound when struck. All vertical edges of pillars, door jambs etc. shall be chamferedor rounded off as directed by the Owner. All corner must be finished to their true angles or rounded. Any plastering that is damaged shall be repaired and left in good condition at the completion of the job without any extra cost to Owner. 4.00.00 Cement Pointing 4.01.00 Where shown on drawing, Schedule of Items, or as directed by the Owner, exposed brick faces shall be cement rule pointed. The mortar shall be raked out of the joints to a depth of 12 mm. The dust shall be brushed out of the joints and the wall well wetted.The pointing shall be kept wet for 7 days. During this period it shall be suitably protected from all damages. 5.00.00 CURING 5.01.00 Each undercoat shall be damp cured for at least 2 days and kept damp continuously till the next coat is applied. All final plastered surfaces after laying and sufficiently hardened shall be kept wetted for a minimum period of seven (7) days and shall be protected from excessive heat and sunlight by suitable approved means. 6.00.00 LIME PUNNING (NEERU FINISH) 6.01.00 For plastered surface, where an even smooth surface is specified, lime punning with 5 parts of shell lime properly slaked, sieved and aged, mixed with 1 part clean, washed, sieved, fine sand by volume shall be done. The thickness of lime punning shall not be less than 2 mm and not more than 3 mm. The plastered surface shall be saturated with water before application of the lime punning. The lime punning shall be applied by skilled workmen and given a smooth and even finish. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 77 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: C-06: 1.00.00 1.01.00 2.00.00 2.01.00 2.02.00 2.03.00 2.03.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 FLOORING & ALLIED WORKS SCOPE This specification covers furnishing, installation, finishing, curing, testing, protection, maintenance till handing over various types of floor finishes and allied items of work as listed below: a) In situ Terrazzo finish b) Integral finish to concrete base. d) Metallic hardener like ‘Ironite’ finish e) IPS Flooring f) Terrazzo Tiled finish g) Glazed tile finish h) Acid resistant tile finish i) PVC tile finish General Base: The base to receive the finish either formed concrete sub-base or floor slab covered under other relevant specifications. Commencement, scheduling and sequence of the finishing works shall be planned in detail and must be specifically approved by the Engineer, keeping in view the activities of other agencies working in the area. However, the contractor shall remain fully responsible for all normal precautions and vigilance to prevent any damage whatsoever till handing over. Only workers specially experienced in particular items of finishing work shall be engaged; where such workers are not readily available, with the Engineer’s permission, experienced supervisors recommended by the manufacturer shall be engaged. In particular cases where the Consultant so desire, the Contractor shall get the finishing items installed by the manufacturer. The surface to the treated shall be thoroughly examined by the Contractor. Any rectification necessary shall be brought to the notice of the Consultant and his approval shall be obtained regarding method and extent of such rectification work. For all types of flooring, skirting, dado and similar works the base to receive the finish shall be adequately roughened by chipping, raking out joints and cleaning thoroughly all dirt, grease etc., with water and hard brush and (detergent if required, unless otherwise directed by the manufacturer of any special finishing treatment, the base shall be thoroughly soaked with water and all excess water mopped up. The surface shall be donedry where adhesive are used for fixing the finishes. Prior to commencement of actual finishing the approval of the Consultant shall be taken as to the acceptability of the surface. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 78 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 3.00.00 3.01.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 CODES AND STANDARDS All applicable standards, acts and codes of practice referred to shall be the latest editions including all applicable official amendments and revisions. A complete set of all these documents shall generally be available at site, with the Contractor. In case of conflict between this specification and those (IS Standards, Codes etc.) referred to in clause 3.03.00 the former shall prevail. Some of the applicable Indian standards, Codes, etc. are referred to here below: 3.02.00 3.03.00 IS :1237 1980 Specification for Cement concrete flooring tiles IS : 1443 1972 Code of practice for laying and finishing of cement concrete flooring tiles. IS : 2114 1984 Code of practice for laying in situ terrazzo floor IS : 2571 1970 Code of practice for laying-in-situ concrete flooring IS : 5318 1969 Laying of flexible sheet and tile flooring IS: 4441 1980 Code of practice for use of silica type chemical resistant mortar IS : 4457 1982 Specification for Ceramic unglaged vitreous acid resistant tiles. IS : 13753 1993 Specification for dust pressed ceramic tiles with water absorption of E> 10% Group (B IiI) IS : 13753 1993 Specification for dust pressed ceramic tiles with water absorption of 6% <E< 10% Group (B II b) IS : 13753 1993 Specification for dust pressed ceramic tiles with water absorption of 3% <E< 6% Group (B II a) IS : 13753 1993 Specification for dust pressed ceramic tiles with low water absorption of E< 3% Group (B I) 4.00.00 MATERIALS 4.01.00 Materials required for individual finishing items are specified under respective items. In general, all such materials shall be as per relevant IS Codes where available. In all cases these materials shall be of the best quality available indigenously unless specified otherwise. The materials for finishing items must be procured from well-reputed specified manufacturers and on the basis of approval of samples by the Engineer. The materials shall be ordered, procured and stored well in advance to avoid compulsion to use substandard items to maintain the construction schedule. 4.02.00 5.00.00 INTEGRAL FINISHING TO CONCRETE BASE 5.01.00 While the surface of the concrete laid as per specification for “cast-in situ concrete and allied works” has been fully compacted and levelled but the concrete is still ‘green’ a thick slurry made with neat cement shall be applied evenly and worked in with iron floats. When the slurry starts to set, it shall be pressed with iron floats, to have a firm compact smooth surface without any trowel mark or undulations. This finish shall be as thin as possible by using 2.2 Kg of cement per sqm. of area. The surface shall be kept in shade for 24 hours and then cured for at least 7 days continuously by flooding with water. The surface shall not be subjected to any load or abrasion till 21 days after laying. As desired by the Engineer, the surface, while still ‘green’ shall be indented by pressing strings. The markings shall be of even depth, in straight lines and the panels shall be of uniform and symmetrical patterns. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 79 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6.00.00 IN-SITU TERRAZZO FINISH 6.01.00 It shall consist of an underbed and a topping laid over an already laid and matured concrete base. 6.02.00 Thickness 6.02.01 Unless otherwise specified the total thickness of the finish shall be minimum 50mm for horizontal and 25 mm for vertical surface of which the topping shall be not less than 12 mm and 10mm respectively. While the topping shall be of uniform thickness the thickness of underbed may vary, to provide necessary slopes. The vertical surface shall project out 6 mm from the adjacent plaster or other finishes. Necessary cutting into the surface receiving the finish shall be done to accommodate the specified thickness. 6.02.02 All junctions of vertical with horizontal shall be rounded neatly to uniform radius of 25 mm. 6.03.00 Mix 6.03.01 Underbed : the underbed for floors and similar horizontal surface shall consist of a mix of 1 part cement, 2 part sand and 4 parts stone chips by volume. For vertical surfaces the mix shall consist of 1 part cement to 3 parts of coarse and by volume. The stone chips shall be 12.5mm down well graded. Just sufficient water shall be added to give a workable consistency. 6.03.02 Topping : The mix for the topping shall be composed of cement, colour pigment, marble powder and marble chips. Proportions of the ingredients shall be such as to produce the terrazzo of colour, texture and pattern approved by the Engineer. The cement shall be grey, to which pigment shall be added to achieve the desired colour. To 3 parts of this mixture 1 part marble powder by weight shall be added and thoroughly mixed dry. To 1 part of this mix, 1.5 parts of marble chips by volume shall be added and thoroughly mixed dry again. The pigment added shall conform to the relevant Indian Standard specification and must be stable and non fading. It must be very finely ground. The marble powder shall be from white marble and shall be finer than I S Seive No. 30. the size of marble chips may be between 3 mm to 20 mm. Sufficient quantity to cover each visible area shall be prepared in one lot to ensure uniform colour. Sufficient water to make it just workable shall be added, to a quantity of mix that can be used up immediately before it starts to set. Laying The underbed shall be laid in panels. The panels shall not be more than 5 sq.m. in area of which no side shall be more than 2.5 m long. For exposed locations the maximum area of a panel shall be 2.0 sq.m. The panels shall be laid in alternate bays or chequered board pattern. No panels shall be in contact with another already laid until the latter has contracted to the full extent. 6.04.00 6.04.01 Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 80 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6.04.02 Dividing strips made of aluminium shall be used for forming the panels. The strips shall exactly match the total depth of underbed plus topping. 6.04.03 After laying, the underbed shall be levelled compacted and brought to proper grade with a screed or float. The topping shall be laid after about 24 hours while the underbed is still somewhat ‘green’ but firm enough to receive the topping. A slurry of the mixture of cement and pigment already made shall be spread evenly and brushed in just before laying the topping. The topping shall be rolled for horizontal areas and thrown and pressed for verical areas to extract all superfluous cement water and to achieve a compact dense mass fully bonded with the underbed. The surface of the topping shall be trowelled over, pressed and brought to a smooth dense surface showing a minimum 75% area covered by marble chips in an even pattern of distribution. Curing: The surface after laying shall be left for about 12 to 18 hours and then cured by allowing water to stand on the surface or by covering with wet sack for four days. 6.05.00 6.06.00 Grinding and Polishing 6.06.01 When the surface has sufficiently hardened it shall be watered and ground evenly with rapid cutting coarse grade (No. 60) grit blocks, till the marble chips are exposed and the surface is smooth. Then the surface shall be thoroughly washed and cleaned. A grout, with already prepared mixture of cement and pigment shall be applied to fill up all pinholes. 6.06.02 This surface shall be cured for 7 days by keeping it moist and then ground with fine grit block (No. 120). It shall again be cleaned with water, the slurry applied again to fill up pinhole that might have appeared and allowed to be cured again for 5 days. Finally the surface is ground a third time with very fine grit blocks (No. 320) to get smooth surface without any pinhole. The grinding shall be done by a suitable machine. Where grinding machine cannot be used hand grinding may be allowed when the first rubbing shall be with carborundum stone of coarse grade (No. 60), second rubbing with medium grade (No. 80) and final rubbing and polished with fine grade (No. 120). The surface shall be cleaned with water, dried and 4 covered with oil free clean sawdust. The final polishing shall be postponed until just before handing over, if desired by the Engineer. 6.06.03 Just before handing over, the surface shall be dusted with Oxalic acid at the rate of 0.33 gm per sq. m., water sprinkled on it and finished by buffing with felt or hessain bobs. The floor be cleaned with soft moist rag and dried. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 81 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 7.00.00 METALLIC HARDENER FINISH 7.01.00 It shall consist of an underbed and a topping (incorporating iron particles) laid over an already laid and matured concrete base. Thickness: 7.02.00 7.02.01 7.03.00 7.03.01 7.04.00 Unless otherwise specified the total thickness of the finish shall be minimum 50mm for horizontal surface of which topping shall not be less than 12 mm. While topping shall be of uniform thickness, the underbed may vary in thickness to provide necessary slope. The vertical surface shall project 6 mm from adjacent plaster or other finishes. Necessary cutting into the surface receiving the finish shall be done to accommodate the specified thickness. Material: The hardening compound shall be uniformly graded iron particles, free from nonferrous metal impurities, oil, grease, sand, soluble alkaline compounds or other injurious materials. When desired by the Engineer, actual samples shall be tested. Mix 7.04.01 The underbed for floor and similar horizontal surfaces and for vertical surface shall be as per clause 6.03.01 of this section. 7.04.02 Proportion of metallic hardener shall be as specified or as indicated by the manufacturer. However, in absence of any such direction 1 part metallic hardener shall be mixed dry with 4 parts cement, by weight. To this mixture 6 mm nominal size stone chips shall be added in proportion of 1 part cement mixed with hardener to 2 parts of stone chips by volume and uniformly mixed. Minimum quantity of water shall be added to make it workable. Laying 7.05.00 7.05.01 7.05.02 7.05.03 The concrete floor shall be laid in panels of 1m x 1m or as directed by the Engineer. Alternate panels shall be laid on one day followed by the other group of alternate panels the next day. The edges of the panels shall be supported either by wooden strips or flat angle iron pieces fixed in position property. The concrete floor shall be laid upto the required grade. The forms if any shall remain sufficiently projecting to take the finish. The surface shall be roughened by wire brush as soon as possible. The junction of floor and walls, floors and dado or skirting shall be rounded off as directed. Wooden strips or flat iron pieces shall be removed from their places before the succeeding alternate layers are laid. The finish shall be laid while the concrete underbed is still very ‘green’ within about 3 hours of laying of the later. The finish shall be of uniform thickness and even dense surface without trowel marks, pinhole etc. The topping layer shall be pressed firmly and worked vigorously and quickly to secure full bond with the concrete base. Just when the initial set starts the surface shall be finished and smoothened with steel trowel. The finish floor shall be cured for 7 days by keeping it wet. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 82 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 8.00.00 IPS FLOORING (Concrete Floor finish with floating Coat of Neat Cement) 8.01.00 It shall consist of an underbed and topping laid on an already laid and matured concrete base. 8.02.00 Thickness 8.02.01 It shall have thickness of 50 mm for horizontal and 20 mm for verticalsurfaces unless otherwise specified. All junctions between vertical andhorizontal work shall be rounded neatly to a uniform radius of 25 mm. 8.03.00 Underbed Mix 8.03.01 The underbed for floor and similar horizontal surfaces consists of a mix of 1 part cement, 2 parts sand and 4 parts stone chips by volume. For vertical surfaces the mix shall consist of 1 part cement to 3 parts sand by volume. The sand shall be coarse. The stone chips shall be 12.5 mm down well graded. Only sufficient water to be added to give a workable consistency. 8.04.00 Topping Mix 8.04.01 The topping shall be floating coat of neat cement using not less than 2.2 kg of cement per sq. m. area. 8.05.00 Laying 8.05.01 The IPS flooring including the underbed shall be laid in alternate bays or in chequered board pattern. No panel shall be cast in contact with another already laid till the contraction of the latter has already taken place. The maximum area of each panel shall be 5 m x 5m. A cement grout shall be applied and worked in to the surface to receive the finish, the underbed then laid, compacted and levelled to proper grade with a screed or float. The requisite slope as shown in the drawings or directed by the Consultant shall also be provided in under bed only maintaining a minimum thickness of 25 mm at the edges. The topping shall be applied evenly on the underbed while it is not fully set but firm enough and rolled and pressed to get full bond. The topping shall be trowelled to a dense finish to the satisfaction of the Engineer. After the surface is sufficiently set, the finished floor shall be kept moist for 7 days for curing. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 83 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 9.00.00 TERRAZZO TILE FINISH 9.01.00 These shall include terrazzo tiles finish over already laid and matured base of concrete or masonry by means of underbed cement : sand (1:4) mortar. Thickness 9.02.00 9.02.01 The total thickness including the underbed shall be minimum 50 mm for floors and 32 mm for walls unless otherwise specified. The skirting, dado and similar vertical surfaces shall project out 6 mm uniformly from the adjacent plaster or other wall finishes. The necessary cuttings into the surface receiving tiled finish, to accommodate the specified thickness shall be done. 9.03.00 Terrazzo Tiles 9.03.01 The tiles shall, unless specifically permitted in special cases, be machine made, under quality control in a shop. The tiles shall be pressed hydraulically to a minimum of 140 kg. per sq. cm. Each tile shall bear on its back permanent and legible trade mark of the manufacturer. All angles of the tiles shall be right angles, all edges sharp and true, colour and texture of the wearing face uniform throughout. Tolerance on length, breadth and thickness of tiles shall be as specified in lS:1237 latest edition. Wearing faces of the tile shall be plane, free from pinholes and other blemishes. 9.03.02 The tiles shall be composed of a backing and topping. The topping measured as per IS:1237 (latest edition) shall be of uniform thickness not less than 8 mm. The total thickness including the topping shall be as specified but not less than 20 mm in any case. The backing shall be composed of 1 part ordinary grey cement 2 parts of sand and 3 parts of stone chips by weight mixed with water. 9.03.03 The topping shall be, as specified under Clause 6.03.00 of this section. The tiles shall be cured at the shop for at least 14 days before delivery to the site. First grinding shall be given to the tiles at the shop before delivery. Tiles shall be packed properly to prevent damage during transit and storage. The tiles must be stored carefully to prevent staining by damp, rust, oil and grease, or other chemicals. Tiles made in each batch shall be kept and used separately so that colour of each area of the floor may remain uniform. The manufacturer shall supply alongwith the tiles the grout mix containing cement and pigment in exact proportions as used in topping of tiles. The container for the grout mix shall be suitably marked to relate it to the particular type and batch of tiles Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 84 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 9.04.00 Mix : Underbed 9.04.01 The underbed for floor and similar horizontal surfaces shall be 1 parts cement : 2 parts coarse sand : 4 parts stone chips by volume (12.5 mm nominal size), mixed with sufficient water. For skirting and dado and all vertical surface it shall be 12 mm thick and composed of 1 part cement and 3 parts coarse sand by volume. Laying 9.05.00 9.05.01 The underbed mortar shall be evenly spread and brought to proper grade and consolidated to a smooth surface. The surface shall be roughened for better bond. Before the underbed had time to set and while it is still fairly moist but firm, cement shall be hand dusted over it or a cement slurry applied and the tiles shall immediately be placed upon and firmly pressed by wooden mallet on to the underbed until it achieves the desired level. The tiles shall be kept soaked for about 10 minutes just before laying. The joints between tiles shall be as close as possible and not more than 1.5 mm wide. Special care shall be taken to check the level of the surface and the lines of the joints frequently so that they are perfect. When tiles are required to be cut to match the dimensions, these shall be sawn and edges rubbed smooth. The location of cut tiles shall be planned in advance and approval of the Consultant shall be taken. 9.05.02 At the junction of horizontal surface with vertical surface the. tiles on the former shall enter at least 12 mm under the latter. After fixing, the floor shall be kept moist and allowed to mature undisturbed for 7 days. Heavy traffic shall not be allowed. If desired dividing strips as specified under Clause 6.04.00 may be used for dividing the work into suitable panels. Grinding and Polishing 9.06.00 9.06.01 Procedure shall be same as Clause 6.06.00. Only grinding shall not commence earlier than 14 days after laying of tiles. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 85 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10.00.00 10.01.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 10.02.00 GLAZED TILE FINISH This finish shall be composed of glazed earthware tiles of approved make and quality, with an underbed laid over a concrete or masonry base. Thickness 10.02.01 The total thickness shall be minimum 20 mm including the underbed. 10.02.02 The tile finish on vertical surface shall project out 6 mm uniformly from the adjacent plaster or other wall finishes. The necessary cutting into surface receiving the finish, to accommodate the specified thickness shall be done. Tiles - Glazed 10.03.00 10.03.01 10.04.00 10.04.01 The tiles shall be of earthware, covered with glaze, white or coloured, plain or with designs, of 150 mm x 150 mm nominal sizes and 5 mm thick unless otherwise specified.. The tolerance shall be + 1.5 mm for length and breadth and + 0.5 mm for thickness. Specials like internal and external angle beads, covers, cornices, corner pieces etc. shall match. The top surface of the tiles shall be glazed with a gloss or matt unfading stable finish as desired by the Engineer. The tiles shall be true in shape and size. The colour shall be uniform and fractured section shall be fine grained in textures, dense and homogenous. The tiles shall be strong. and free from flaws like cracks, chips craze, spacks, crawlings etc. and other imperfections. The edges and the underside of the tiles shall be completely free from glaze and the underside shall have ribs or indentations for better anchorage with the fixing mortar. The coloured tiles, when supplied shall preferably come from one batch to avoid difference in colour. Mix - Underbed 10.05.00 The mix for the under bed shall consist of 1 part cement and 3 parts coarse sand by weight mixed with sufficient water or any other mix if specified. Laying: Same as Clause 9.05.00. 10.06.00 Finishing 10.06.01 The joints shall be cleaned and flush pointed with white cement and cured for 7 days by keeping it wet. The surface shall be cleaned with soap or suitable detergent, washed fully and wiped with soft cloth to prevent scratching before handing over. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 86 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 11.00.00 PVC TILE FINISH (Rubberised) 11.01.00 This shall include various types of tiles manufactured from rubber, set with an adhesive on a concrete or masonry base. An underbed may be required to obtain a satisfactory surface and grade. Thickness 11.02.00 11.02.01 11.03.00 11.03.01 11.03.02 11.04.00 11.04.01 12.00.00 12.01.00 The thickness of the tiles shall be 3mm unless otherwise specified. The thickness including underbed shall be 50 mm for floors and 30 mm for walls, unless otherwise specified. Tiles Unless otherwise required the tiles shall be square and of approved dimensions. The tolerance in dimensions shall be +/-1.5 mm. The face of the tiles shall be free from porosity, blisters, cracks, embedded foreign matter or other physical defects which affect appearance or serviceability. All edges shall be cut true and square. The colour shall be nonfading and uniform in appearance, insoluble in water and resistant to alkalis, cleaning agents and all usual floor polishes. Finishing If any adhesive marks are present on the surface a soft cloth soaked in solvent shall be used to wipe them off. The surface shall be cleaned with soft soap, dried and polished or sealed with an approved type of polish or sealant just before handling over. ACID RESISTANT TILE FINISH 12.02.00 This finish shall be composed of ceramic unglazed vitreous tiles of approved make and quality, with an underbed laid over a concrete or masonry base. The tile are laid with chemical resistant mortars. Thickness 12.02.01 The total thickness shall be minimum 25 mm including the underbed. 12.02.02 The tile finish on vertical surface shall project out 12 mm uniformly from the adjacent plaster or other wall finishes. The necessary cutting into surface receiving the finish, to accommodate the specified thickness shall be done. Tiles – Ceramic unglazed vitreous acid resistant shall generally conform to IS: 4457. 12.03.00 Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 87 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 12.0 The tiles shall be of vitreous ware and shall be free from deleterioussubstances. The acid resistant shall be determined in accordance with appendix –F of IS: 4457. The size of tile shall be 150 mm x 150 mm or 200 mm x 200 mm nominal sizes and 12 mm thick unless otherwise specified.. The tolerance shall be +/- 2.5 % for length, breadth and thickness. Specials like internal and external angle beads, covers, cornices, corner pieces etc. shall match. The tiles shall be true in shape and size. The colour shall be uniform and fractured section shall be fine grained in textures, dense and homogenous. The tiles shall be strong. and free from flaws like cracks, chips craze, spacks, crawlings etc. and other imperfections. The edges and the underside of the tiles shall be completely free from glaze and the underside shall have ribs or indentations for better anchorage with the fixing mortar. The coloured tiles, when supplied shall preferably come from one batch to avoid difference in colour. 12.04.00 Mix – Underbed & Mortar 12.04.01 The mix for the under bed and joint filling mortar shall be also of chemical resistant type conforming to IS: 4441. 12.05.00 Laying: The laying shall be done by approved specialist agency as per recommendation of manufacturer 13.00.00 ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA The finish shall be checked specially for a) Level, slope, plumb as the case may be b) Pattern, and symmetry c) Alignment of joints, dividing strips etc. d) Colour, texture e) Surface finish f) Thickness of joints g) Details of edges, junction etc h) Performance i) Precautions specified for durability Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 88 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-30201 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 STEEL DOORS, WINDOWS, VENTILATORS & LOUVERS 1.00.00 COPE 2.00.00 The work in general shall consist of supplying, erecting and installing of all metal doors, windows, ventilators, louvers, glazed partitions etc. as stipulated here or elsewhere in these specifications with all materials complete including labour and equipment. GENERAL: 2.01.00 The contractor shall submit 6 copies of shop drawing covering all types of work under this specification before manufacture. The drawing shall show all dimensions, details of construction, installation, relating to adjoining and related work etc 3.00.00 ODES AND STANDARDS 3.01.00 All applicable standards, acts and codes of practice referred to shall be the latest editions including all applicable official amendments and revisions. A complete set of all these documents shall generally be available at site, with the Contractor. 3.02.00 In case of conflict between this specification and those (IS Standards, Codes etc.) referred to in clause 3.03.00 the former shall prevail. 3.03.00 Some of the applicable Indian standards, Codes, etc. are referred to here below: IS : 1038 1983 Specifications for Steel doors, windows and ventilators IS : 1081 1960 Code of practice for fixing and glazing of metal (steel and aluminium) doors, windows & ventilators IS : 1361 1978 Specifications for Steel windows for industrial building IS: 1477 (Part 1) 2000 Code of practice for painting ferrous metals in buildings - Pretreatment IS: 1477 (Part 2) 2000 Code of practice for painting ferrous metals in buildings - Painting IS: 2074 1992 Specifications for ready mixed paint, air drying, red oxide zinc chrome, priming IS: 3564 1996 Specifications for hydraulically regulated door closers IS : 4351 2003 Specifications for Steel door frames IS : 7452 1990 Specifications for Hot rolled steel sections for doors, windows and ventilators Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 89 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 4.00.00 MATERIALS 4.01.00 Steel sections used for fabrication of doors, windows, etc. shall be standard rolled steel section specified in IS:1038, lS:1361 and IS:4351 or as specified in drawing. The Mild Steel sheets for frames, shutters, louvre blades etc. shall be of approved quality and of gauge mentioned in this specification. Hardware and fixtures of the best quality from approved manufacturers shall only be used. The Contractor shall specifically state the particular manufacturer’s materials he proposes to use. All hardware and fixtures shall be able to withstand repeated use. Door closers shall conform to IS:3564 and shall be suitable for doors weighing 61-80 kg unless otherwise stated. Each closer shall be guaranteed against manufaturing defect for one year and any defect found within this period shall be rectified or the closer replaced free of charge. Concealed door closes shall be either floor mounted or transom mounted, suitable for installation with metal doors. It shall conform to the performance requirements and endurance test stated in IS:3564 - Appendix A. 4.02.00 The Contractor shall submit samples of each type of hardware to the Consultant. The approved samples shall be retained by the Consultant for comparison with bulk supply. The mastic for caulking shall be of best quality from a manufacturer approved by the Consultant. 5.00.00 ABRICATION 5.01.00 oor Frames 5.01.01 Frames shall be reinforced for door closers. They shall be mortised,reinforced, drilled and tapped for hinges, lock and bolt strikes. Flush butt welding to form a solid fused joint, so that all frames are square and flat shall be used with sections cut to required length and mitred. Rubber door silencers shall be furnished for the striking jamb. Loose “T” masonry anchors shall be provided. Frames shall finish flush with floor and adjustable floor anchors shall be supplied. Frames shall be brought to site with floor ties/weather bars installed in place. 5.02.00 Double Plate Flush Door Shutters Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 90 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 5.02.01 Door shutters shall be 45 mm thick, completely flush design and shallcomprise of two sheets of 18G steel sheets, rigidly connected and reinforced inside with continuous vertical 20G stiff ners, spot welded in position at not more than 150 mm on centres. Both edges of doors shall be joined and reinforced full. height by steel channels placed immediately inside and welded to the door faces. Top and bottom of doors shall be reinforced horizontally by steel channels running full width of door. Doors shall not have more than 2.5 mm clearance at jambs and head, shall have proper level on lock stiles and rails to operate without binding, and shall be reinforced at corners to prevent sagging or twisting. Pairs or double doors shall have meeting stile edges beveled or rebated. 5.02.03 Doors shall be mortised, reinforced, drilled and tapped in shop for hinges, locks and bolts. They shall also be reinforced for closer, push-plates and other surface hardware where necessary. Any drilling and tapping required for surface hardware shall be done at site. Wherever required, provision shall be made for fixing glazing, vision panels, louvers etc. Glazing mouldings shall be of 18G mild steel or extruded aluminum sections with profiles shown in drawings and suitable for fixing 6 mm glass. Louver blades shall be V or Z shaped and made out of 16G sheets. liding Doors 5.03.00 5.03.01 5.04.00 5.04.01 Sliding doors shall be either single or double plate construction as required and made out of 18 Gauge steel sheets with adequate stiffeners. The Contractor shall specify the weight of the door in his shop drawing and submit the manufacturer’s catalogue of the sliding gear he proposes to use. Where shown on the drawings the Contractor shall make provisions for openings in the door for monorail beams. Door shall close positively to exclude rain water from seeping in. Sliding doors shall withstand specified wind loads without buckling or jamming. The door shall slide freely under all ambient conditions. teel Windows, Sashes, Ventilators etc. These shall conform in all respects to IS:1038, lS:7452 and lS:1361 and are asshown on drawings. The details as called for in the above codes shall be applicable for coupling mullions, transom, weather bars, pivot arrangements for ventilators etc. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 91 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 5.04.02 Windows: Window shutters shall be hung on projecting hinges. One leaf of the hinges shall be welded into a slot in the outer frame and the other leaf of the hinges riveted to the opening shutters. Hinges may be of the friction type in which case the window shall not be fitted with peg stay. In case of nonfriction projecting hinges, a brass or bronze three holes peg stays 300mm. Long with pegs and brackets, welded or riveted to the frame shall also be provided. Handles shall be of brass or bronze, and shall be mounted on a mild steel handle plate welded to the shutter in such a way that it should be fixed after the shutter is glazed. The handles shall have a two point nose which shallengage with brass, bronze or aluminium alloy as specified, striking plate, on the fixed frame so that it can hold the shutters in a slightly openable as well in a fast position. 5.04.03 Top hung ventilators: These shall be fixed with plain hinges, riveted to the fixed frames or welded to it after cutting a slot in it. A peg stay 300mm long of brass or bronze with three holes, as in case of windows shall be provided. The locking bracket shall either be fitted to the fixed frame or to the ventilators. 5.04.05 Centre Hung Ventilators: These shall be hung on two pairs of brass of lead / tin/ bronze cup pivots, riveted to the inner and outer frame of the ventilates to permit these to swing through an angle of approximately 85 deg. The opening portion of the ventilators shall be so balanced that it remains open at any desired angle under normal weather condition. 5.04.05 A bronze or brass spring catch shall be provided at the top centre of theventilator. A brass cord pulley wheel in a mild steel or malleable ironbrackets, shall be fitted with screws or welded at the sill and a cord eye shallbe fixed to inner frame of ventilators to facilitate opening of ventilators. 5.05.00 All welds shall be flush butt welded to form a solid fused joint so that all frames are square and flat. 5.06.00 Where composite unit openings are shown on drawings, the individual window units shall be jointed together with requisite transoms and mullions.All windows shall be inside glazed, fixed with metal glazing beads. Allwindows, ventilators, sashes shall be fixed with handles, peg stays etc. ofapproved make and best quality. 5.07.00 ressed Steel Louvers 5.07.01 The louver blade shall be ‘Z’ shaped and made out of 18G sheets in EZ7 steel frames. The frames shall be of ISMC 100. 5.08.00 Fabrication drawings shall be submitted by the contractor which shall also inclusive weights of the materials used and got approved from the Consultant. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 92 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6.00.00 HOP COAT OF PAINT 6.01.00 Unless otherwise specified in Sub-section, the shop paint for steel doors, windows, ventilators, louvers etc. shall be best quality Zinc Chromate primer paint from approved manufacturer conforming to lS:2074. All surface shall be thoroughly cleaned of rust, grease, loose mill scales and foreign matter as per lS:1477 Part-I, and given one coat of shop paint. Portions like mullions, transom etc. which will be inaccessible after assembly of units shall be given an extra coat of paint before assembly. 6.02.00 All steel doors, windows, etc. shall have one shop coat and one site coat of Zinc chromate paint (Primer) conforming to IS:2074 with a pigment to be specified by the Consultant and two coats of synthetic enamel paint of approved quality and conforming to relevant l.S. Code, unless specified otherwise in these specifications. Wherever required, all steel doors, windows, etc. shall be hot dip galvanized to give a coating weight of 460 gms to 610 gms per sq.m. One coat zinc chromate primer coat shall then be applied as shop paint. 7.00.00 HANDLING AND STORAGE All metal doors, windows, etc. shall be packed and crated properly before despatch, to ensure that there will be no damage to the fabricated materials. Loading into wagons and trucks shall be done with all care to ensure safe arrival of materials at site in undamaged condition. All metal doors, windows etc. shall be stored under cover in a way to prevent damage or distortion. 8.00.00 SSEMBLY AND ERECTION 8.01.00 In general, the fixing of metal doors, windows ventilators, louvers, etc. shall conform to IS:1081. The Contractor shall assemble and install all steel doors, windows, sashes, fixed metal louvers, etc. including transoms and mullions for composite units in respective places keeping proper lines and levels, and in approved workmanlike manner, to give trouble free and leak-proof installation. If required by the Consultant, the installation shall have to be carried out under the supervision of the manufacturer’s staff. The contractor shall take every precaution against damage of the components during installation. Necessary holes chases etc. required for fixing shall be made by the contractor and made good again as per original, after installation. 8.02.00 After installation of metal doors, windows, etc. all abrasions to shop-coat of paint shall be retouched and made good with the same quality of paint used in shop-coat. 8.03.00 All coupling mullions, transoms, frames. etc. in contact with unpainted steel and other members, shall be well embedded in mastic. The contractor shall bring to the site the mastic cement in original sealed containers of manufacturer and shall apply it as per the instructions. 8.04.00 Door shutters, partitions, hardware fixtures etc. shall be fixed only after major equipments have been installed in rooms. Wherever required, nylon cords of approved quality shall be supplied alongwith pivoted sashes and shall be of adequate length to terminate one meter from the floor. Loose ends of cords shall end in metal or plastic pull as approved by the Consultant. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 93 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 9.00.00 ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA 9.01.00 For Fabricated Items a) Overall dimension shall be within + 1.5 mm of the size b) Mullions, transoms etc. shall be in one length and permissible deviations from straightness shall be limited to n 1.5 mm from the axis of the member. c) Door and window shutters shall operate without jamming. The clearance at head and jamb for door shutters shall not exceed 1.5 mm. For double leaf doors, the gap at the meeting of stiles shall not be more than 1.5mm. d) Door leaves shall be undercut wherever required. e) Doors, windows, frames etc. shall be on a true plane, free from warp or buckle. f) All welds shall be dressed flush on exposed and contact surfaces. g) Correctness of location and smoothness of operations of all shop installed hardware and fixtures. h) Provision for hardware and fixtures to be installed at site. i) Glazing clips, fixing devices etc. shall be supplied in adequate numbers j) Shop coats shall be properly applied. k) Glazing beads shall be cut with mitered corners. 9.02.00 For Installed Items a) Installations shall be at correct location, elevation and in general, on a true vertical plane. b) Fixing details shall be strictly as shown on drawings. c) Assembly of composite units shall be strictly as per the drawings with mastic caulking at transoms and mullions, gaskets, weather strips etc. complete. d) All frames on external walls shall be mastic caulked to prevent leakage through joint between frames and masonry. e) All openable sections shall operate smoothly without jamming. f) Locks, fasteners etc. shall engage positively. Key shall be non interchangeable. g) Cutting to concrete or masonry shall be made good and all abrasions to shop paint shall be touched up with paint of same quality as shop paint. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 94 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 C-08: 1.00.00 1.01.00 GLASS & GLAZING SCOPE The work in general shall consist of supplying and fixing all glass and glazing including all clips, putty, mastic cement etc. wherever required as shown on drawings. 2.00.00 2.01.00 CODES AND STANDARDS All applicable standards, acts and codes of practice referred to shall be the latest editions including all applicable official amendments and revisions. A complete set of all these documents shall generally be available at site, with the Contractor. In case of conflict between this specification and those (IS Standards, Codes etc.) referred to in clause 2.03.00 the former shall prevail. Some of the applicable Indian standards, Codes, etc. are referred to here below: 2.02.00 2.03.00 IS : 419 1967 Putty for use on window frames IS : 1081 1960 Code of practice for fixing and glazing metal (steel & aluminium) doors, windows and ventilators IS : 2835 1987 Flat transparent sheet glass IS : 3548 1988 Code of practice for glazing in building IS : 5437 1994 Figured rolled and wired glass IS : 14900 2000 Specification for transparent float glass 3.0000 3.01.00 MATERIALS The Contractor shall supply and install all glass and glazing as required for various doors, windows, sashes, ventilators, and fixed louvers, miscellaneous glazing and partitions, unless otherwise stated, from approved manufacture having uniform refractive index and free from flaws, specks and bubbles. The glass shall be brought to site in the original packing from the manufacturer and cut to size at site. The cut edges shall be straight and free from chips, spall or any other damages. 3.02.00 The glass shall be plain float glass from approved manufacture, as specified and it shall be free from bubbles, flaws specs, waves, air holes, distortion, scratches or other defects. The glasses in bulk quantities shall be brought to site in Makers original packings and Makers guarantee shall be produced if called for by the Consultant. The glass shall be of required thickness as mentioned in the items of schedule of quantities and / or drawing or as directed by the Consultant. The contractor shall submit the sample of the glass which he proposes to use on the work and only such approved quality of glass shall be used in the works. The glass brought to site shall be protected against damages. Wherever frosted (obscure) glass is mentioned in the item of schedule of quantities and / or shown in drawings, the glass shall be of sand blown pattern and shall also be got approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 95 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 3.03.00 After the inspection is over and permitted by the Consultant, glass panes shall be cleaned off any labels paints smears and spots and shall be washed from both the sides and all glazing left elar, perfect and free from rattling. The contractor shall provide all the scaffolding tools and plants for fixing the glass panes at his own cost. In case of steel 3.04.00 Glare reducing (tinted) or heat absorbing glass shall be “Calores” of Hindustan Pilkington or approved equivalent and special care shall be taken to grind smooth and round off the edges before fixing. 3.05.00 Clear glass shall be flat drawn and shall be at least 4 mm thick, Conforming to lS:2835. Sheet glass for doors shall be minimum 6.3 mm thick. 3.06.00 3.07.00 Wired glass shall be 6 mm thick rolled glass with centrally embedded 24 G wire mesh of Georgian type. This may be of clear or coloured glass, as required by Engineer and shall conform to lS:5437. Obscure glass shall have a cast surface on one side. 3.08.00 Coloured and figured glass shall be as per approved sample. 3.09.00 In general, the putty shall conform to lS:419 and be of best quality from approved manufacturer. it shall be brought to site in the manufacturer’s original packing. Quick setting putty shall be used for windows and sashes except when glare reducing glass is used where it shall be of non-setting type. Neoprene gaskets with snap-fit glazing shall be fixed as per manufacturer’s instruction and shall fit firmly against the glass to give a leak proof Installation. 3.10.00 4.00.00 FIXING 4.01.00 The glass shall be cut to the required sizes of panels where it is to be fitted and it shall be so cut that it fits properly in the frames without rattling. Premeasurement of each panel prior to the cutting of glass is essential. 4.02.00 The beading shall then be fixed to glass panes and screwed at close intervals not more than 10 cm. from each corner and the intermediate not more than 20 cm. apart. When glass panes are fixed with wooden beadings having mitred joints or aluminium beading thin layer of glazier putty shall be applied covering the area in contact between the glass and sashbars and beadings. In case of louvers, all the exposed edges of the glass shall be ground properly 4.03.00 All glazing clips, bolts, nuts, putty, mastic cement, etc. as required shall be supplied by the Contractor. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 96 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 4.04.00 All glass shall be thoroughly cleaned before placing in positions. Each glass pane shall be held in place by special glazing clips of approved type. As specified in relevant l.S. Codes, four glazing clips shall be provided per glass pane, except for large panes where six or more clips shall be used as per Engineer’s instructions. All holes that may be necessary for holding the clips, glazing beads and all other attachments shall be drilled by the Contractor. 4.05.00 Glass pane shall be set without springing, and shall be bedded in putty and back putted, except where mouldings or gaskets are specified. Putty, mastic cement etc. shall be smoothly finished to a true even line. Obscure and figured glass shall be set with smooth. side out. 4.06.00 After completion of glazing work, the Contractor shall remove all dirt, stains, putty etc. clean the glass panes and leave the work in perfectly acceptable condition. All broken, cracked or dameged glass shall be replaced by new ones 4.07.0 The beading shall be of teak wood of superior quality timber in case of teak wood doors and windows and / or required sizes mentioned in the items of schedule of quantities and / or shown in drawing. In case of steel doors and windows the beading shall be anodised aluminium beading of channel section as per size mentioned in the item and / or shown in the drawing. The junction of the beadings shall be mitre jointed. 5.00.00 ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA a) All installations shall be free from cracked, broken or damaged glass. Edges of large panes of thicker glass and heat absorbing glass shall be inspected carefully for chipped, cracked or unground edges. b) Glazing shall be carefully done to avoid direct contact with metal frames. c) All glass shall be embedded in mastic or fixed by neoprene gaskets to give a leak-proof installation. d) At completion, the panes shall be free from dirt, stains, excess putty etc. and to complete satisfaction of the Engineer. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 97 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 C-09: PAINTING, WHITE WASHING, DISTEMPERING AND OTHER FINISHING WORKS 1.00.00 SCOPE 1.01.00 This Specification covers painting, white washing. polishing, distempering etc. of both interior and exterior surfaces of masonry, concrete, plaster, plaster of Paris, structural and other miscellaneous steel items, rain water down comer, floor and roof drains, waste and service water pipes, and other ferrous and non-ferrous metal items as indicated elsewhere in these specifications or as directed by the Consultant. 1.02.00 If surface to be finished cannot be put in suitable condition for painting by customary preparatory methods, the Contractor shall notify the Consultant in writing or assume responsibility for and rectify and unsatisfactory f inishing. Before commencing painting, the Contractor shall obtain the approval of the Consultant in writing regarding the scheduling of work to minimise damage, disfiguration or staining by other trades. He shall also undertake normal precautions to prevent damage, disfiguration or staining to work of other trades or other installations. 2.00.00 CODES AND STANDARDS 2.01.00 All applicable standards, acts and codes of practice referred to shall be the latest editions including all applicable official amendments and revisions. A complete set of all these documents shall generally be available at site, with the Contractor. 2.02.00 In case of conflict between this specification and those (IS Standards, Codes etc.) referred to in clause 2.03.00 the former shall prevail. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 98 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 2.03.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 Some of the applicable Indian standards, Codes, etc. are referred to here below: 75-1973 77-1976 102-1962 103-1962 104-1979 133-1993 137-1965 158-1981 168-1993 217-1988 218-1983 290-1961 337-1975 338-1952 339-1952 340-1978 341-1973 345-1952 347-1975 348-1968 419-1967 427-1965 428-1969 524-1983 525-1968 533-1973 712-1984 1200-(Pt.-XII)1976 1200-Pt.-XIII)1987 1200-(Pt.-XV)1987 Linseed oil, raw and refined Linseed oil, boiled, for paints Ready mixed paint, brushing, red, lead, nonsetting, priming Ready mixed paint, brushing, white lead, for priming and general purposes Specification for ready mixed paint, brushing, zinc chrome, priming Enamel, interior (a) under coating (b) finishing colour as required Ready mixed paint, brushing, matt or egg-shell flat, finishing interior, to Indian Standard Colour, as required Ready mixed paint, brushing, bituminous, black lead free acid alkali, water and heat resisting for general purposes. Ready mixed paint, air drying for general purpose. Cut back bitumen Creosote and anthrakene oil for use as wood preservatives Coal tar black paint Varnish, finishing interior Varnish, under coating exterior, natural resin Varnish, under coating, exterior, synthetic resin Varnish, mixing Black Japan, type A, E, & C Wood filler, Transparent, liquid Varnish, shellac for general purpose French polish Putty for use of window frames Distemper, dry, colour as required Distemper, oil emulsion colour as required Varnish, finishing, exterior, synthetic Varnish, finishing, exterior and general purposes Gum spirit of turpentine (oil of turpentine) Specification for building limes Method of measurements of plastering and pointing Method of measurements of white washing, colour washing, distempering and other finishes Methods of measurements of painting, polishing & varnishing IS : 1477 (I & II) Code of Practice for painting of ferrous metals in building 2095-1982 2096-1992 2339-1963 IS : 2395 (Iand II) 2547-1976 2932-1994 2933-1975 5410-1992 5411-(Pt.-I)-1974 6278-1971 IS : 13467 BS : 5493 Gypsum plaster boards. Asbestos cement flat sheets. Aluminium paint for general purposes, in dual container Code of Practice for painting concrete, masonry and plaster surface Gypsum building plaster Enamel synthetic, exterior (a) Under coating (b) Finishing. Enamel, Exterior (a) Under coating (b) Finishing Cement paint, colour as required Plastic emulsion paint for interior use Code of practice for white washing & colour washing Specification for chlorinated rubber for paints Code of practice for protective coating of Iron & Steel structure against corrosion Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 99 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 3.00.00 MATERIALS 3.01.00 Materials shall be of highest grade products of well-known approved manufacturer and shall be delivered to the site in original sealed containers, bearing brand name, manufacture’s name and colour shade, with label intact and seals unbroken. All materials shall be subject to inspection & approval by the Consultant. It is desired that materials of one manufacturer only shall be used as far as possible and paint of one shade be obtained from the same manufacturing batch. 3.02.00 All paint shall be subjected to analysis from random samples taken at site from painters bucket, if so desired by the Consultant. 3.03.00 All prime coats shall be compatible to the material of the surface to be finished as well as to the finishing coats to be applied. All unspecified materials such as shellac, turpentine or linseed oil shall be of the highest quality available and shall conform to the reputed recognised manufacturer’s and shall be approved by the Consultant. 3.04.00 All colour shall be as per painting schedule and tinting and matching shall be done to the satisfaction of the Consultant. In such cases, where samples are required, they shall be executed in advance with the specified materials for the approval of the Consultant. 4.00.00 WHITE WASHING 4.01.00 Shall be done from pure shell lime or fat lime, or a mixture of both as instructed by the Consultant, and shall conform to IS: 712. Samples of lime shall be submitted to the Consultant for approval, and lime as per approved sample shall be brought to site in unslaked condition. After slaking, it shall be allowed to remain in a tank of water for two days, and then stirred up with a pole, until it attains the consistency of thin cream. 100 grams of gum t o 6 litres of white wash water and a little quantity of indigo or synthetic ultramarine blue shall be added to the lime. 5.00.00 WATERPROOF CEMENT PAINT 5.01.00 Shall be made from best quality white cement and lime resistant colours with accelerators, waterproofing agents and fungicides. The paint shall conform to IS: 5410. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 100 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6.00.00 ACRYLIC EMULSION PAINT 6.01.00 Shall be water based acrylic copolymer emulsion with rutile titanium dioxde and other selected pigments and fungicide. It shall exhibit excellent adhesion to plaster and surface and shall resist deteoration by alkali salts. The aint film shall allow the moisture in wall to escape without peeling or blistering. The paint, after it is dried, shall be able to withstand washing with mild soap and water without any deterioration in colour, or without flaking, blistering or peeling. 7.00.00 SYNTHETIC ENAMEL PAINT 7.01.00 Shall be made from synthetic resin and drying oil with rutile titanium dioxide and other selected pigments to give a smooth, hard, durable and glossy finish to all exterior and interior surfaces. white and pastel shades shall resist yellowing and darkening with aging. The paint shall conform to IS: 2932 and IS: 2933. 8.00.00 DRY DISTEMPER 8.01.00 Dry distemper of required colour conforming to IS:427 and of approved brand and manufacturer shall be used. The primer where used shall be cement primer or distemper primer. The shade shall be got approved from the Consultant. Dry distemper as required shall be stirred slowly and in clean water using 0.6 litre of water per kg of distemper or as specified by the manufacturer. Distemper shall not be mixed in larger quantity than is actually required for one days work. Warm water shall preferably be used. The treatment shall consists of a priming coat of whiting followed by the application of two or more coats of distemper till the surface shows an even colour. 9.00.00 OIL BOUND DISTEMPER 9.01.00 Oil bound distemper (IS:428-1969) of approved brand and manufacturer shall be used. Any unevenness in surface shall be made good by applying putty. The patched surface shall be allowed to dry thoroughly before the coat of distemper is applied. One coat of distemper properly diluted with thinner as specified by the manufacturer applied with brushes in horizontal strokes followed immediately by vertical ones together will constitute one coat. Two or more coats of distemper as found necessary shall be applied to obtain even shade. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 101 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 10.00.00 COLOUR WASH 10.01.00 It shall be done with mineral colours, not affected by lime added to white wash. No colour wash shall be done until a sample of the colour wash to the required tint or shade has been approved by the Consultant. The colour shall be of even tint or shade over the whole surface. If it is blotchy or otherwise badly applied, it shall be redone by the Contractor at no extra cost to Owner. 11.00.00 CHLORINATED RUBBER BASED PAINT 11.01.00 Chlorinated rubber is the product obtained from the reaction of chlorine with rubber. The product contains an average chlorine content of about 65%. 11.02.00 Chlorinated rubber shall be formulated with resins (for adhesion and gloss), plasticizers (for flexibility and toughness), pigments (for colour), stabilizers and solvents (for fluidity). This shall meet the general requirement s of IS:13467 & BS:5493. 12.00.00 STORAGE 12.01.00 The Contractor shall arrange for safe and proper storage of all materials and tools. Paints shall be kept covered at all times and mixing shall be done in suitable containers. All necessary precautions shall be taken by the Contractor to prevent fire. 13.00.00 PREPARATION OF SURFACE 13.01.00 Before starting the work the Contractor shall obtain the approval of the Consultant regarding the soundness and readiness of the surface to be painted on. 13.02.00 Masonry, Concrete and Plastered Surfaces shall be free from all oil, grease, efflorescence, mildew, loose paint or other foreign and loose materials. Masonry cracks shall be cleaned out and patch filled with mortar similar to the original surface and uniformly textured. Where this type of resurfacing may lead to the finishing paint being different in shade from the original surfaces, the resurfaced area shall be treated with minimum one coat of cement primer which should be continued to the surrounding area for a distance of minimum 100 mm. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 102 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 13.03.00 Surface with mildew, efflorescence shall be treated as -below. a) Mildew: All mildewed surfaces shall be treated with an approved fungicide such as ammoniacal wash consisting of 7 gm of copper carbonate dissolved in 80 ml liquid ammonia and diluted to 1 litre ith water or 2.5 per cent magnesium silico-fluoride solution and allowed to dry thoroughly before paint is applied. b) Efflorescence: All efflorescence shall be removed by scrubbing the affected surfaces with a solution of muriatic acid in water (1 : 6 to 1 : 8) and washed fully with clear water and allowed to dry thoroughly. 13.04.00 Metal Surfaces 13.04.01 All metal surfaces shall be absolutely clean, dry and free from wax, grease or dried soap films. All steel and iron surfaces in addition shall be free from rust. All galvanized iron surfaces shall be pre-treated with a compatible primer according to the manufacturer’s direction. Any abrasion in shop coat shall be touched up with the same quality of paint as the original coat. 14.00.00 APPLICATION 14.01.00 The method of application shall be as recommended by the manufacturer in case of selection of special shades and colour (not available in standard shades) the Contractor shall mix different shades and prepare test panels of minimum size 1 metre square as per instruction of the Consultant and obtain his approval prior to application of finishing paints. 14.02.00 Proper tools and implements shall be used. Scaffoldings if used shall be independent of the surface to be painted to avoid shade differences of the freshly repaired anchor holes. Painting shall be done by skilled labourers in a workman like manner. All materials shall be evenly applied, so as to be free of sags, runs, crawls or other defects. All coats shall be of proper consistency. In case of application by brush, no brush marks shall be visible. The brushes shall be clean and in good condition before application of paint. All priming undercoats for painting shall be applied by brush only and rollers,spray equipments etc. shall not be used. 14.03.00 14.04.00 No work shall be done under conditions that are unsuitable for production of good results. No painting shall be done when plastering is in progress or is drying. Application of paint which seals of surface to moisture shall be done after the moisture on and under the surface has dried out. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 103 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 14.05.00 14.06.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 All coats shall be thoroughly dry before being sand papered or before the succeeding coat is applied. Coats of painting as specified are intended to cover surfaces perfectly. In case the surface is not covered properly by applying the specified number of coats, further coats shall be applied by the Contractor when so directed by the Consultant, without any extra cost to Owner. All primers and undercoats hall be tinted to approximate the colour of the finishing coats. Finished coats shall be of exact colour and shade and as per approved samples and finish shall be uniform in colour and texture. All parts of mouldings and ornaments shall be left clean and true to finish. 14.07.00 White Washing: The surface where white washing is to be applied shall be cleaned of all loose materials and dirt. All holes and irregularities of the surface shall be filled up with lime putty and shall be allowed to dry up before application of the lime solution. One coat of white wash shall consists of one stroke from top downwards, another from bottom upwards over the first stroke and another from eft to right before the previous one dries up. Second coat shall be applied after the first dries up completely and similarly the third coat shall be applied and in case the Consultant feels that one or more coats are required the Contractor shall do so without any extra cost to the Owner. No brush marks shall show on the finished surface. The inner plastered surfaces of walls shall be given three or more coats of white washings. 14.08.00 Waterproof Cement Paint: Surface to be coated with cement paint shall be washed and brushed down. As soon as the moisture has disappeared, the surface shall be given one coat of paint. Care shall be taken so that the paint does not dry out too rapidly. After 4 to 6 hours, the water shall be sprinkled ver the surface to assist curing and prevent cracking. After the first coat has dried (24 to 48 hours) the second coat shall be applied. In a similar manner the finished surface shall be kept moist by occasional sprinkling with water for seven days after painting. 14.09.00 Acrylic Enamel Paint: Lime gauged cement plastered surfaces shall not be painted for at least one month after plastering. A sample patch shall be painted to check alkali reaction if so desired by the Consultant. Painting shall be strictly as per manufacturer’s specification. Minimum two coats shall be applied. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 104 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 14.10.00 Synthetic Enamel Paint: Shall be applied on properly primed surface. Subsequent coats shall not be applied till the previous coat is dry. The previous coat shall be lightly sand papered for better adhesion of subsequent coats. Minimum two coats shall be applied. 14.11.00 Dry Distemper: The treatment shall consists of a priming coat of whiting followed by the application of two or more coats of distemper till the surface shows an even colour as per manufacturer’s instruction. The entire surface shall be coated with the mixture uniformly, with proper distemper, in horizontal strokes followed immediately by vertical ones which together shall constitute one coat. Subsequent coats shall be applied only if the previous coat has dried. 14.12.00 Oil Bound Distemper: Any unevenness in the surface shall be made good by applying putty. The patched surface shall be allowed to dry thoroughly before coat of distemper is applied. One coat of distemper properly diluted with thinner as specified by the manufacturer shall be applied with brushes in horizontal strokes followed immediately by vertical ones which together will constitute one coat. Two or more coats of distemper, as found necessary shall be applied to obtain even shades. 14.13.00 Colour Washing: For new work, the priming coat shall be of white wash with lime or with whiting. Two or more coat shall than be applied on the entire surface till it represents a smooth and uniform finish. The finished dry surface shall not be powdery and shall not readily come off on hand when rubbed. Indigo (neel) shall however, not be added. 15.00.00 PAINTING OF IRON & STEEL WORKS 15.01 .00 Paint to be used for various items of work shall be of best quality and shall be obtained ready mixed in sealed containers from approved manufacturer. The contractor shall obtain the Consultant’s approval for the make and colour of the paint he proposes to use. 15.02.00 All surfaces shall be thoroughly cleaned of all dirt, loose particles and rust, and approved prior to application of paint. Workmanship shall conform to lS:1477 (Part - I & III). 15.03.00 Specific number of coats shall be applied and at least 24 hours shall elapse between the applications of successive coats. No painting shall be carried out on exterior work in wet weather or on surfaces which are not entirely dry. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 105 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 16.00.00 CHEMICAL RESISTANT PAINT 16.01.00 For chemical resistant paint stipulation of BS: 5493 shall also be followed. 17.00.00 PROTECTION 17.01.00 Furniture and other movable objects, equipments, fittings and accessories shall be moved, protected and replaced upon completion of the painting work. All stationary items of equipments shall be well covered so that no paint can fall on them. All protection shall be as per instruction of the Consultant. 18.00.00 CLEANING UP 18.01.00 The Contractor shall, upon completion of painting etc. remove all marks and make good the surface, where paint has been spilled, splashed or splattered, including all equipments, fixtures, glass, furniture, fittings etc. to the satisfaction of the Consultant. 19.00.00 ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA a) All painted surfaces shall be uniform and pleasing in appearance. b) The colour, texture etc. shall match exactly with approved samples. c) All stains, splashes and splatters of paints shall be removed from surrounding surfaces. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 106 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 C-10: 1.00.00 PILING WORKS -BORED CAST IN-SITU PILES SCOPE 1.00.01 This specification covers the technical requirements for bored cast in situ concrete piles. 1.00.02 This specification also covers the Supplying of all materials, plant, labour, equipment, tools and services for complete and proper installation of bored cast. in situ concrete piles, as shown on the Drawing. or specified, includingall surveying and setting out necessary for correct location of piles, furnishing everything necessary for forming working pile., test piles and anchor pile, excavations (if required) for pile cut-off, cut-off of all piles to a true plane at elevations specified, load test of single pile, and for pile groups as specified and designated for the purpose or as directed by the CONSULTANT during the, progress of the work and clean-up of the working area. The CONTRACTOR shall also exhume test pile, before/after load tests as directed by the CONSULTANT and when so specified for checking the quality of the pile shafts after installation. The CONTRACTOR shall provide everything requisite and necessary to exhume the pile as instructed. 2.00.00 General 2.01.00 Bored cast in situ piles are formed by any of the following techniques: a) Using Direct Mud Circulation or Reverse Mud Circulation Method with bentonite slurry as drilling mud and appropriate equipment, and with temporary guide casing through unstable strata only upto a maximum of 5 m below working ground level b) Using percussion type of boring technique and bentonite slurry to stabilise the hole, with temporary guide casing through unstable strata only upto a maximum of 5m below working ground level c) Using permanent rigid liner of steel or any other material approved by the CONSULTANT. Temporary casings of length exceeding 5 m below working ground level shall not be used for forming the pile bores. Concrete piles formed shall be free of any necking and excessive bulging. 2.02.00 All works shall have to be carried out in accordance with the relevant standards and codes of practice or in their absence, in accordance with the best accepted current Engineering practices or as directed by the CONSULTANT from time to time. Items for which separate specifications have not been included shall be carried out in consultation with and as directed/approved by the CONSULTANT. The decision of the CONSULTANT as regards the specification to be adopted and their interpretation and the mode of execution of work shall be final and binding on the CONTRACTOR and no claim whatsoever will be entertained on this account. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 107 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 2.03.00 Notwithstanding what is contained in this document, the CONTRACTOR shall execute all the work in a professional manner, exhibiting workmanship of the best quality. Prior to mobilisation, the CONTRACTOR shall submit to the OWNER/CONSULTANT for approval, his programme for Quality Assurance and Quality Control that be will adopt for the work, along with three copies of documentation format for enabling enforcement of his QA-QC programme. 2.04.00 Prior to submitting his proposal, the CONTRACTOR shall acquaint himself fully in regard to the scope of the work in accordance with the intent and meaning of the subsurface data as indicated by the geo-technical investigation report and other data given by the OWNER, and the drawings and specifications. He is deemed to have examined the site and premises sufficiently to compare them with the Drawing. and specifications and satisfy himself in regard to the condition of the site, obstructions, accessibities, etc. required in connection with the work. Failure to comply with this requirement shall in no way relieve the CONTRACTOR of his responsibility to perform the work complete in accordance with the specification. The information given in the geotechnical investigation report has been made available to the CONTRACTOR in good faith. The OWNER will not be held responsible for any inaccuracies or discrepancies therein and no claim whatsoever from CONTRACTOR on this account will be entertained by the OWNER. 2.05.00 Nothing contained in the contract documents will relieve the CONTRACTOR from, the responsibility of obtaining approval from the CONSULTANT for all the installation criteria. 2.06.00 Access to the work areas shall be kept unobstructed and clear at all times so as not to hamper the work of other trades. 2.07.00 The CONTRACTOR shall remove overhead, surface and underground obstructions as directed by the CONSULTANT at, no extra cost and backfill the voids in the ground with suitable material through which sound pile. can be readily bored and constructed. 3.00.00 CODES AND STANDARDS 3.01.00 All applicable documents, including standards, codes, rules, laws, regulations of regulatory bodies referred to herein shall be of latest issue or edition and shall be considered part of this specification, except as may otherwise be stated herein. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 108 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 3.02.00 4.00.00 4.01.00 5.00.00 5.01.00 5.02.00 5.03.0 10000011 / HB / 11094 Unless otherwise stated ,the design, materials and workmanship shall conform to the following standards : IS: 2911 -Code of Practice for Design and Construction of Pile Foundations a) Part-1 -Concrete piles, Section-2. b) Part-2 -Bored cast in situ piles c) Part-4 Load test on piles IS: 2131 -Method of standard penetration Test for soils IS: 456 -Code of practice for plain and Reinforced Concrete. IS: 8112 -Specification for Ordinary Portland Cement, 43 grade. IS: 1489 -Portland pozzolana cement. IS: 8112 -High strength ordinary portland cement. IS: 12330 -Sulphate resistant cement. IS: 383 -Specifications for Coarse and fine aggregates from natural sources for concrete. IS : 2386 -Method of Test for Aggregates for concrete. IS : 432 -Specification for Mild Steel and Medium Tensile Steel bars and Hand Drawn Steel Wire for concrete Reinforcement. IS : 1786 -Specification for cold twisted steel Bars for concrete Reinforcement. IS: 3764 -Safety code for Excavation work. IS: 1200 -Method of measurement of Building works – Part XXIII. GEOTECHNICAL INVESTIGATIONS Copies of geo-technical investigation report will be available with the OWNER or Consultant as indicated in Data sheet A. The CONTRACTOR shall note that all the above information has been given in good faith and no claim from the CONTRACTOR will be entertained for any accuracy or discrepancy in the same. TYPE OF PILES This specification covers bored cast in situ concrete piles of circular crosssection only. These piles shall be formed by boring to the specified depth as shown and called for on the drawings or as directed at site by the CONSULTANT. Execution of the pile bore shall be by one of the methods outlined in Clause 1.01.01 above and in Data Sheet-A. The temporary casing or permanent liner and the pile bore shall be of diameter adequate enough to give the necessary nominal finished diameter of the concrete piles. The inner diameter of the upper guide casing shall not be less than the specified nominal diameter of the pile. In case a permanent liner is used, the liner diameter of the permanent liner shall correspond to the specified nominal diameter of the pile. The bored hole shall exclude any subsoil or detrimental material before reinforcement and concrete is placed inside the casing borehole. The CONTRACTOR shall, in his Bid, fully outline the methods that he proposes to adopt to accomplish this. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 109 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6.00.00 TRIAL BOREHOLES FOR LOCATING FOUNDING STRATUM 6.01.00 To ascertain the subsurface strata and their characteristics, the CONTRACTOR may be permitted to conduct trial boreholes only with the permission of the OWNER/ CONSULTANT. The locations of trial bore holes shall be subject to approval by the CONSULTANT / OWNER. Completion of the investigations, all trial bore holes shall be back filled upto below cut off level of the piles in that area by sand and subsequent filling shall be done by excavated clay or cement bentonite grout unless directed otherwise by the CONSULTANT. The CONSULTANT’s approval shall be obtained prior to commencement of back filling of the trial boreholes. Cost of all such trial bore holes including all necessary back filling shall be to the CONTRACTOR’S account. No concessions in time schedule will be granted on this account. SETTING OUT 6.02.00 6.03.00 6.04.00 7.00.00 7.01.00 7.02.00 The CONTRACTOR will be furnished with one reference benchmark and with two mutually perpendicular reference axes. The CONTRACTOR shall locate accurately the position of piles and install stakes as directed or as required by Drawings, with reference to the reference bench mark and axes furnished. The CONTRACTOR shall make good to the satisfaction of the CONSULTANT, defective or infructuous work arising out of error in field layout, notwithstanding that the layouts and marking may have been checked and approved by the CONSULTANT. The CONTRACTOR shall check the coordinates of initial guide casing or permanent liner position for each pile during and immediately after placing the casing on the ground prior to its driving and confirm the same with the coordinates of that pile as shown on the Drawing. 8.00.00 CONTINUITY OF CONSTRUCTION 8.01.00 Any pile that is taken up for execution from boring to final concreting shall be executed at a continuous stretch without interruption. Stoppage of work in between shifts will be permitted only during boring stage of the pile execution if further boring is pending. Thereafter right from boring or chiselling of the final portion of the length of the pile, through subsequent activities of flushing, lowering of reinforcement cage, lowering of tremie, pre-concrete flushing and up to concreting, no halt whatsoever in the execution of the pile will be permitted. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 110 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 8.02.00 In case there is a halt of work during any of these activities except concreting, the CONTRACTOR shall take steps to bore an extended length of further 300mm or as decided by the CONSULTANT, or adopt any other measure as decided by the CONSULTANT. 8.03.00 If there is any stoppage of work during concreting, this pile shall be abandoned altogether. 8.04.00 Costs of remedial measures and their consequences shall be borne by the CONTRACTOR if the stoppage is due to the CONTRACTOR’S act of commission or omission. 9.00.00 MATERIALS 9.01.00 CONCRETE 9.01.01 General 9.01.02 All concrete work shall conform to relevant IS specifications and as described below: 9.01.03 Aggregates a) The CONTRACTOR shall get the source of supply of all aggregates approved by the CONSULTANT prior to commencement of work. Sample. of both fine and coarse aggregates shall be tested for soundness as per IS:2386 in a laboratory approved by the CONSULTANT for each quarry location or source. Aggregates shall be particularly tested for any evidence of expansive reaction between the aggregates and the cement to be used. The costs of supplying sample of aggregate and the costs of all tests thereon shall be born, by the CONTRACTOR. b) Coarse and fine aggregates shall be totally free of chlorides and other deleterious matters. All aggregates shall be washed to the satisfaction of the CONSULTANT. Marine and creek sources of aggregates shall be avoided to the extent possible and shall be used only through written permission of the CONSULTANT. Extra care shall be exercised in this regard if sulphate-resisting cement is used. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 111 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 c) All aggregates brought to site shall be free of, and kept free from deleterious matter. Aggregates, from different sources, of different type and of different sizes shall be stored separately in different stockpiles or different hoppers. Where stored on the ground, care shall be exercised during retrieval, the batch is not contaminated by soil or organic matter. d) Sieve analysis of aggregates shall be conducted at regular intervals to ensure that the grading conforms to that in the design mix. If a change in grading or angularity of coarse aggregates is unavoidable, the mix shall be redesigned. Only 20 mm downgraded aggregates shall be used. 9.02.00 WaterOnly water permitted by the CONSULTANT shall be used for making concrete. All testing of water shall be got done by the CONTRACTOR at no extra cost to the OWNER. 9.03.00 Cement Cement used shall be ordinary Portland cement 43 grade/Sulphate resisting cement conforming to 1S:8112/ 1S:12330 unless specified otherwise in Data SheetA due to deleterious effect of sulphate and chlorides in ground water. The C3A content in cement shall range between 5% and 7% unless approved otherwise by the CONSULTANT. Where Portland pozzolana cement is specified to be used, only cement, which does not contain fly ash as pozzolana, shall be used. All concrete for both piles and pile caps shall be produced only by weighbatching the ingredients as specified. 9.04.00 9.05.00 Concrete shall be of minimum grade designation M25 or as specified in Data Sheet-A. It shall conform to IS:456-2000 9.06.00 The cement content shall not be less than 400 kg/m3. The water cement ratio shall not exceed 0.45, or that specified in Data Sheet-A if necessitated by adverse subsurface environment. The slump as measured at the pile head itself shall range between 150 mm to 200 mm. To achieve the slump within this required range with the water cement ratio within the limit specified special plasticiser admixture shall be used. The plasticiser to be used shall be got approved from the CONSULTANT. Any admixture containing chlorides or nitrates shall not be used. The plasticiser shall be added as per manufacturer’s instructions or as directed by the CONSULTANT. 9.07.00 9.08.00 Cube tests of preliminary mix design as well as works cubes shall be done in a laboratory approved by the CONSULTANT. All such tests including supplying and transporting the cubes to this laboratory and all other related works shall be at the CONTRACTOR’S cost. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 112 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 9.09.00 While evolving a concrete mix, no admixture or plasticiser shall be used. 9.10.00 At least one series of tests for cube strength of concrete shall be conducted for every 20 piles constructed or 50 cubic metres of concrete whichever is least and not less than one set of tests shall be conducted for any one shift’s concreting operations. Each set of tests shall consist of nine work test cubes, field cured. Three cubes shall be tested at 7 days and three at 28 days. The balance three cubes shall be kept for testing at 14 day in case the 7 days test results are not satisfactory. Records of all cube test results shall be communicated to the CONSULTANT identifying the pile being concreted while making the cubes. The CONSULTANT reserves the right to reject piles of deficient concrete strengths. Such rejected piles shall be replaced by the CONTRACTOR with additional piles along with necessary extended pile cap as described by the CONSULTANT and the cost of this additional and extended work shall be wholly borne by the CONTRACTOR. 9.11.00 The CONTRACTOR shall provide at his own cost all labour, materials and equipment necessary for routine site tests on all aggregates, water, slump tests on concrete, cube tests and all other tests as specified and shall carry out the same as required by CONSULTANT. 9.12.00 REINFORCEMENT 9.12.01 All reinforcement shall be as per the approved design. The reinforcement shall be assembled and tied together and made up into cage sufficiently rigid to withstand handling without damage and distortion. Where indicated in Data Sheet-A, the reinforcement bars shall Fe 415 grade TMT-HCR bars. 9.12.02 Where the number and diameters of reinforcement bars change as per the Drawing, laps of reinforcement bars shall be as indicated on the Drawing. Joints in longitudinal bars, if unavoidable, shall be made by lapping. Laps shall be tackwelded as approved by the CONSULTANT to prevent distortion of the reinforcing cage. The number of joints in longitudinal steel bars shall be kept to a minimum and staggered. Joints in reinforcement shall be such that the full strength of each bar is effective across the joint and shall, be made such that there is no detrimental displacement of the reinforcement during the construction of the pile. Mechanical splices, if and as approved by the CONSULTANT may be used for jointing reinforcement bar of samediameters. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 113 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 9.12.03 The projecting lengths of the longitudinal bars beyond the pile cut-off level shall be equal to a minimum of 50 times bar diameter or such length as shown on the Drawings. 9.12.04 The lateral links or helical reinforcement shall fit closely around the main longitudinal bars and be fixed to them by soft annealed 16 gauge black iron wire, the free ends of which shall be turned toward. the centre. 9.12.05 Concrete cover over all reinforcement including lateral links or helicals. shall be 50 mm, unless shown otherwise on the Drawing. Suitable and adequate cover blocks shall be provided. The cover blocks shall be circular with a concentric hole of adequate size to allow lateral reinforcement to pass through and allow free rotation. The cover blocks shall be manufactured of concrete of grade higher than that of concrete designated for the pile, using, the same grade and type of cement. Alternately, the cover block shall be of more durable material approved by the CONSULTANT, which will not lead to corrosion of the reinforcement or spalling of the concrete cover. The cover blocks shall be placed all along the length of the reinforcement cage with adequate number in the upper portion over the length of the temporary casing. The cover blocks shall be aligned for smooth lowering of the cage into the pile bore and for lifting of the temporary casing without displacing the reinforcement cage. from its seated position. 9.12.06 Stiffner bars, spreader forks and lacings within the reinforcement cage shall be provided to prevent twisting or any type of distortion of the reinforcement cage during its lifting, handling and lowering into the pile bore. These shall be placed in a manner and pattern such that the inside dimension of the reinforcement cage is adequate for concentric placement of the tremie pipe and its operation without disturbing the cage during concreting. 10.00.00 TEMPORARY STEEL GUIDE CASING 10.01.00 Temporary steel guide casing for bored cast in situ concrete piles shall have an internal diameter equal to the nominal diameter of the pile. The thickness shall be adequate for strength to withstand driving without damage. Length of each casing component shall be maximum possible. Joints shall be welded, lock seamed or screwed. 10.02.00 Guide casings shall be free from any distortion and buckling and of uniform crosssection throughout. The inside of the guide casing shall be free from projections and encrusted concrete. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 114 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 11.00.00 PERMANENT LINERS 11.01.00 Permanent liners shall be used for bored cast in situ concrete piles where specified. The scope of this specification excludes geo-fabrics as permanent liners and includes only liners of approved rigid material. 11.02.00 The inner diameter of permanent liners shall correspond to the specified nominal diameter of the pile. The liners shall be of mild steel or of material approved by ENG1NEER in writing. Thickness of the liner shall be at least as specified, or more if required to withstand handling, driving etc. without any damage, denting, distortion or buckling. If the CONTRACTOR is of the opinion that a thicker liner than that specified is required he shall get the approval for use of thicker gauge from the CONSULTANT in writing. Liners, which are damaged, distorted, dented or buckled in any manner, shall not be used. 11.03.00 The inside surface of the liners shall be clean and free of any loose scales, rust, soil, debris, encrusted concrete or any projections. 11.04.00 Liner joints shall be welded. It shall be ensured that the vertical axes of the liners being welded coincide and the liners are not welded together with eccentricity. 11.05.01 Where specified, the outer surface of the permanent liner shall be coated or treated accordingly. 12.00.00 BENTONITE DRILLING MUD 12.01.00 Bentonite powder and bentonite suspension fluid shall conform to requirements specified in IS:2911 (Part I/Sec.2). The CONTRACTOR is advised to obtain Manufacturer’s test certificate for each consignment delivered to the site to ensure the conformity of the material delivered. However each batch of bentonite powder delivered and the suspension fluid made there from shall be tested by the CONTRACTOR and results presented to the CONSULTANT. Any batch not conforming to required specifications shall be rejected. The bentonite powder shall be mixed thoroughly with clean, potable water to make a suspension of density as specified. The temperature of the water used and that of the bentonite fluid supplied to the pile bore shall not be lower than 5 Deg.C. Where saline or chemically contaminated ground water occurs, special precautions shall be taken as approved by the CONSULTANT to modify the bentonite suspension or prehydrate the bentoniite with fresh, potable water so as to render the fluid suitable for construction of piles. The pH of the fluid shall range from 9.5 to 12. The bentonite suspension fluid shall be continuously circulated and agitated using circulating pumps to prevent deposition of suspension and coagulation. 12.02.00 Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page115 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 12.03.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 13.00.00 The suspension fluid shall be regularly tested to ensure its suitability for use as drilling mud. The frequency of testing the fluid and the method of sampling shall be proposed by the CONTRACTOR for approval prior to the commencement of the work. The frequency may subsequently be varied as deemed necessary by the CONSULTANT. These tests shall ensure consistency of the fluid properties, after the mixing process blending of freshly mixed bentonite suspension and any process which may be adopted to remove impurities from previously used bentonite suspension. PILE BORING 13.01.00 FORMATION OF PILE BORES 13.01.01 Pile bores for bored cast in situ concrete piles shall be executed upto minimum depth specified on the Drawings or as modified by the CONSULTANT in writing during progress of boring. The pile shall achieve its required capacity to take downward and upward force and horizontal forces in combination as specified. 13.01.02 Pile bores shall be executed by any of the following methods a) Using the Direct Mud Circulation or Reverse Mud Circulation Methods with bentonite slurry as drilling mud and appropriate equipment b) Using percussion type of drilling and bentonite, slurry to stabilize the hole c) Using permanent rigid liners of steel or any other material approved by the CONSULTANT and boring through the liners. The BIDDER shall indicate along with his bid which of the above methods, he proposes to adopt for this work. However the decision of the CONSULTANT regarding the method to be adopted for executing the bores shall be binding on the CONTRACTOR. Use of temporary guide casings through unstable strata is permitted only upto a maximum of 5 m below ground level. The CONTRACTOR shall ensure that bores formed are true to a cylindrical shape to the extent possible and over cutting is minimized.The CONTRACTOR shall also ensure that water cavities behind temporary casings are altogether avoided so as to ensure quality concrete for the pile shaft. Boring shall not be carried out within a distance of five times the diameter of the pile from a pile which has been freshly concreted within the past forty-eight hours. 13.01.03 13.01.04 13.01.05 13.02.00 STANDARD PENETRATION TESTS 13.02.01 The CONTRACTOR shall conduct Standard Penetration Tests (SPT) within the pile bore at pile locations and at depths as indicated on the Drawing or as directed by the CONSULTANT. The procedures for conducting these SPTs in soil and rock shall be as per the relevant IS codes. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 116 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 13.02.03 SPTs shall be conducted as the boring for the pile bore progresses and at the founding level of the pile (pile tip). 13.03.00 BORE LOGS AND EXTRACTED MATERIAL SAMPLES 13.03.01 A complete log of the subsurface profile shall be maintained during execution of boring for each and every pile shaft. A copy of such log shall be submitted to the CONSULTANT for his scrutiny prior to commencement of reinforcement cage lowering. 13.03.02 All through the boring operations, the subsurface material (soil or rock cuttings) as extracted through the flap valve bailers. or wash of circulating mud shall be preserved in polythene bags at regular 0.5 m to 1 m intervals of depth or as directed by the CONSULTANT. The sample shall be labelled, indicating the unique pile number and depth. The labelled sample will be placed in another polythene bag. All these samples shall be handed over to the CONSULTANT. DIRECT MUD CIRCULATION METHOD 13.04.00 13.04.01 13.04.02 13.04.03 13.04.04 13.05.00 13.05.01 13.05.02 The initial boring of about 1.5 m shall be done by bailer and the guide casing shall then be lowered into the bore hole. The bore shall be filled with bentonite slurry fed from bentonite installation. The center line of the guide casing shall be checked with respect to the reference points before proceeding with further boring. Further boring shall proceed with the use of direct mud circulation chisel upto the founding strata. The chisel used to bore the hole, shall be of diameter appropriate for the specified nominal diameter of the hole to be bored. The chisel shall be connected to API rods of adequate diameter and thickness through which bentonite slurry shall be pumped. Bentonite slurry shall be pumped through the chisel rods by means of high pressure pump. The chisel shall have suitable ports for the bentonite slurry to flow out at high pressure. The bentonite slurry and the cuttings, which are carried to the surface by the rising flow of slurry shall pass through a settling tank of adequate size to remove the cuttings and spoils from the slurry before the slurry is recirculated to the pile bore. A suitable bentonite slurry mixing and recirculation plant shall be designed and installed. REVERSE MUD CIRCULATION METHOD The CQNTRACTOR shall adopt Reverse Mud Circulation Method only where strata encountered are such that there is no danger of loosening of the subsoil during the boring operations and the subsoil gradually becomes denser and more compact with progressive depths or where bedrock is being penetrated at shallow depths. This Method shall he adopted only if approved by the CONSULTANT. The Method is essentially the same as the Direct Mud Circulation Method except that the bentonite slurry shall be sucked through the chisel instead of being pumped through it. Except for this, the specifications for direct mud Circulation Method apply here also. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 117 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 13.06.00 BAILER BORING USING BENTONITE SLURRY 13.06.01 This process is essentially the same as the Mud circulation method except that all boring shall be done by flap valve bailer or flap valve bailer and chisel) upto the founding stratum, using bentonite slurry. Bentonite slurry shall be allowed to flow into the casing through pipes or channels, so that the guide casing is always kept filled with bentonite. The material extracted by the bailer shall be left alongside the boring if so directed by CONSULTANT, Fresh bentonite slurry shall be allowed to flow into the casing so that the top level of the bentonite is kept the same at all times. 13.06.02 Except as modified here in above, the specification for Direct Mud Circulation method shall apply to Bailer Boring also. 13.07.00 BORING FOR PILES WITH PERMANENT LINERS 13.07.01 Where specified, permanent liners shall be used for bored cast in situ piles. The permanent liners shall be installed simultaneously as the boring for the pile progresses. 13.07.02 Pile boring shall be done from within the permanent liner by flap-valve bailer boring or by any percussive method or rotary method as approved by the CONSULTANT. to the extent possible, the bottom of the permanent liner shall be driven ahead of the boring except where SPTs are to be conducted. Where SPTs are specified to be conducted, the permanent liner bottom shall be maintained at least 300 mm above the bottom of the bore. 13.08.00 LOSS OF DRILLING MUD WHILE BORING 13.08.01 In the event of a rapid loss of drilling mud in a pile bore, the CONTRACTOR shall immediately draw the attention of the CONSULTANT and take necessary action as approved by the CONSULTANT. FINAL POST-BORE FLUSHING AND CLEANING 13.09.00 13.09.01 On completion of the total length of the pile bore, the bore shall be thoroughly cleaned and flushed. 13.09.02 If the pile bore has been executed by either of the mud circulation methods, fresh bentonite slurry shall be pumped through the chisel resting at the base of the bore to completely remove all cuttings and other loose material from the base. During the flushing the speed of the bentonite circulation pump shall be raised to maintain high pressure. Such flushing shall be continued for at least 20 minutes while occasionally agitating the chisel. Flushing shall be continued beyond 20 minutes if the return slurry indicates presence of cuttings still within the bore. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 118 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 13.09.03 In case the pile bore has been executed by Bailer boring with bentonite Slurry, the bore shall be initially cleaned of loose material by light tamping of the flap-valve bailer. Thereafter the bailer shall be withdrawn and a string of API rods shall be lowered upto the base of the bore and bentonite slurry shall be pumped through under high pressure as in the case of the Mud Circulation Method. Agitation shall be effected by circular movement of the string of rods around the pile bore. Flushing shall be thus continued for at least 20 minutes. Flushing shall continue beyond 20 minutes till the return wash indicates that the bore is clean to the satisfaction of the CONSULTANT. 13.09.04 Where permanent liners have been used, the bore shall be filled with water that has been certified for concreting and a flap valve bailer shall be used to remove the loose material by light tamping. The bailer shall then be withdrawn and a string of API rods shall be lowered down to the base of the bore. The certified water shall then be pumped through the string of rods at high speed for at least 20 minutes. Agitation shall simultaneously be effected by a gentle vertical movement and vigorous circular movement to the rods. Flushing shall continue thus beyond 20 minutes till the return wash indicates that the bore is clean to the satisfaction of the CONSULTANT. The water from within may be pumped out with approval of the CONSULTANT. However no pumping out shell be done if the ground water table is above the bottom of the bile bore and/or if the subsoil around the bottom of the pile bore is likely to be disturbed by pumping out the water. 14.00.00 PLACEMENT OF REINFORCEMENT CAGE 14.01.00 Immediately after successful completion of final post bore flushing and cleaning, the reinforcement cage shall be lowered into the pile bore. All care shall be taken during transporting lifting and lowering of the cage that the cage does not twist or distort out of alignment. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 119 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 14.02.00 The cage shall be lowered into the pile bore by gravity and shall not be forced into the bore. Care shall be exercised that no collapse of any portion of the unlined bore occurs while lowering. In case the total length of the pile is such hat handling of the entire length of the cage becomes unwieldy, the cage shall e fabricated in two lengths. The location of such jointing shall however be got approved by the CONSULTANT in writing. After the first section of the cage is lowered and held with the top of the bars adequately outside the bore, the upper cage section shall be lifted, held vertical and gradually lowered over the lower cage section so that the main longitudinal reinforcement bars of the. two cage sections are aligned for bar jointing of the respective bars of the two cages shall be done as per Clause 8.2.2 above. The integral cage shall then be lowered into the pile bore and into final position and held in place by slings or suitable devices approved by the CONSULTANT. 14.03.00 Longitudinal reinforcement above the ground level shall not be arbitrarily bent for seating the concrete tremie hopper. If the reinforcement cage has been fabricated longer than that required on the Drawing (in view of a shorter pile bore than that envisaged earlier), the excess length shall be cut. Outward flaying of the main reinforcement bars of the cage shall not exceed 5 degrees with the vertical to avoid breaking of the bars while rebending the reinforcement back into position after the concreting. In any case, the internal radius of the bend shall not be less than five times the bar diameter. While flaying the reinforcement cage outwards, it shall be ensured that the cover to reinforcement within the pile bore to be concreted is maintained. 15.00.00 FINAL PRE-CONCRETING FLUSHING 15.01.00 Immediately after the reinforcement cage is positioned, the concrete tremie pipe shall be lowered into the pile bore concentrically within the reinforcement cage, with the bottom of the tremie pipe just above the bottom of the bore. The top of the tremie pipe shall be connected to a high speed bentonite pump and flushing with bentonite slurry shall be resumed. If concreting of the pile bore is to be done by concrete pump, flushing shall be done through a string of API rods lowered into the pile bore concentrically within the reinforcement cage with the bottom of the string of rods just above the bottom of the pile bore. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 120 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 15.02.00 The procedure for flushing shall be the same as that indicated in Clause 9.9 above. At the end of such flushing the CONTRACTOR shall ensure that heavy contaminated bentonite suspension, which could impair free flow of the concrete from the tremie pipe or concrete pump trunk has not accumulated in the bottom of the pile bore. The suspension shall be sampled from the pile bore bottom by a suitable device approved by the CONSULTANT and the density of the suspension checked by a calibrated hydrometer. The density of the sampled suspension shall not exceed 1.2 gm/cc. In case this value is exceeded, flushing shall be resumed as per Clause 9.9 till the suspension is within the desired density range. 16.00.00 PILE CONCRETING 16.01.00 GENERAL 16.01.01 Concreting of pile bores shall be executed only through a tremie system or concrete pump over the entire length of the pile. Tipping in of concrete from ground level or above into the pile bore is prohibited even if the pile bore is dry (as may perhaps be the case for pile bores with permanent liners). 16.01.02 Only freshly mixed concrete shall be used. Placement of the concrete shall be a continuous operation. The CONTRACTOR shall ensure that concrete mixers of adequate capacity are provided at the site with standby, If concrete pump is to be used for concreting a standby pump shall be provided. The pile shall be abandoned if concreting operations are suspended due to any reason by more than 20 minutes. It shall also be ensured that there are no air pockets created within the concrete shaft. 16.02.00 TREMIE CONCRETING SYSTEM 16.02.01 Tremie pipe concreting shall be done as per IS:456 and IS:2911 (Part 1/ Sec.2). The minimum diameter of the tremie pipe shall be 200 mm. The steel hopper at the top of the tremie pipe shall have a volume in excess of the total volume of the tremie pipe below. The neck of the hopper shall be fitted with a steel plate covering the entire opening. Suitable arrangements shall be made to remove the steel plate and uncover the hopper neck aperture when the hopper is full of concrete. The hopper and the entire length of the tremie pipe shall be thoroughly clean and free of any encrusted concrete or internal protusions such as sleeves, collars etc., or any soil or debris. The entire tremie pipe-hopper system shall be watertight. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 121 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 16.02.02 After the final pre-concreting flushing has been successfully executed, the tremie pipe shall not be extracted but shall continue to remain upto the bottom of the pile bore. Suitable ramps or staging shall be provided to facilitate easy and smooth feeding of the hopper with concrete either manually or by mechanised means. The ramps or staging shall be flexible enough to allow concrete feeding if the hopper is raised during concreting. 16.02.03 A sliding plug of polystyrene (or similar material lighter than water and approved by the CONSULTANT) shall be placed in the tremie pipe to prevent direct contact between the first charge of concrete in the tremie and the bentonite slurry. At the commencement of concreting, the steel plate shall first cover the hopper neck while the hopper is completely filled with concrete. The steel plate shall then be removed and the concrete in the hopper allowed to flow into the tremie pipe. Subsequent charges of concrete shall be maintained as continuous as possible until the pile bore is completely concreted as specified in Clause 12.5 below. The tremie pipe shall at all times penetrate the concrete by minimum two metres after placing of the concrete has commenced, and shall not be withdrawn from within the concrete until completion of concreting. Particular care shall be exercised when vertical movement is imparted on the tremie pipe to force the concrete down the tremie pipe. Such movements shall be limited. The CONTRACTOR shall note that the pile shall be abandoned if in the opinion of the ENGNEER, the tremie pipe bottom has been raised above the concrete level within the pile bore. While raising the tremie pipe, care shall be exercised that the reinforcement cage is not disturbed from its position. 16.03.00 CONCRETE PUMP 16.03.01 If the concrete pump is used to feed the hopper of a tremie concreting system, provisions of Clause 12.2 shall apply. 16.03.02 If the concrete pump is used for placing concrete directly into the pile bore, the trunk of the pump shall be placed upto the bottom of the pile bore immediately after the string of API rods used for final pre-concreting flushing have been removed after successful flushing. The trunk shall at all times penetrate the concrete after commencement of concreting by at least two metres and shall not be withdrawn from within the concrete until the completion of concreting. The CONTRACTOR shall note that the pile shall be abandoned if in the opinion of the CONSULTANT, the trunk has been raised above the concrete level within the pile bore. While raising the trunk, care shall be exercised that the reinforcement cage is not disturbed from its position. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 122 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 16.04.00 LIFTING OF TEMPORARY CASING 16.04.01 The temporary casing shall be carefully withdrawn only after the concrete surface in the pile bore has risen to not less than three metres above the bottom of the casing or not less than one metre above the level of ground water whichever is higher. The casing shall be lifted only to the extent that there is minimum one metre of concrete above the casing bottom. The level of concrete shall be checked vis a vis the casing bottom and ground water level by suitable methods as approved by the CONSULTANT. 16.04.02 While withdrawing the temporary casing, care shall be exercised that the reinforcement cage is not pulled out along with the casing. It shall also be ensured that no voids or ground water pockets are formed around the pile shaft during withdrawal. Adequate precautions shall be exercised to ensure that the concrete is not lifted up along with the casing and that no necking or waisting occurs in the pile shaft. Special care shall be exercised when the ground water level is high. During withdrawal, the movement of the temporary casing shall be maintained in an axial direction relative to the pile. 16.05.00 COMPLETION OF CONCRETING 16.05.01 Irrespective of the specified pile cut-off level, concrete shall be poured into the pile bore until all the contaminated concrete at the top of the bore overflows the top of the pile bore and neat concrete appears continuously as overflow. Concreting shall then be terminated after permission of the CONSULTANT. 17.00.00 PILE CUT-OFF AND EXTENSION 17.01.00 Excavation for pile cut-off shall be done by the CONTRACTOR unless indicated otherwise in Data Sheet-A. The extent of excavation shall not exceed the minimum necessary for the required pile cut-off. The CONTRACTOR shall provide adequate side slopes/shoring at no extra cost to the OWNER, in order to provide safe working space for pile cut-off. Excavated material shall not be stacked near the edge of any excavation. The material shall be stacked at spots designated by the OWNER near the excavation within the plant limits at no extra cost to the OWNER. 17.02.00 Pile cut-off to specified levels shown on the Drawing shall be done by the CONTRACTOR for all piles at no extra cost. The CONTRACTOR shall station at site an adequate work force for the same. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 123 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 17.03.00 When cutting off and trimming piles to the specified cut-off level, the Contractor shall take care to avoid shattering or otherwise damaging the rest of the pile. Any cracked or defective concrete shall be cut away and the pile repaired in an approved manner to provide a full and sound section at the cut-off level. 17.04.0 Minimum chipping of the pile shall be 600 mm or till sound concrete is met with or specified cut off level, whichever is greater. While chipping the concrete, care shall be taken to ensure that the reinforcement is not damaged in any way. If the reinforcement is damaged while chipping or bending back, the CONTRACTOR shall rectify the same as directed by the CONSULTANT at no extra cost to the OWNER. If the specified cut—off level is less than 600 mm below the ground level (which is the concrete overflow level after all temporary casings are withdrawn) or if the cut-off level is above the ground level, the concrete shaft shall be chipped by minimum 600 mm or till sound concrete is met with, whichever is greater. Thereafter, if found necessary, additional reinforcement shall be jointed as specified earlier in Clause 8.2.2 above. The pile shall then be built up to the specified cut-off level using suitable circular form work and concrete of grade specified for the pile shaft. 17.05.00 If due to any defective concreting, honeycombing, exposure of reinforcement, snapping of reinforcement bars etc., stripping of pile, concrete is required to be done to a level lower than the specified cut-off level to obtain dense and sound concrete, the pile shall be built up with the good concrete of specified grade for the pile shaft upto the specified cut off level by the CONTRACTOR at no extra cost to the OWNER, Such building up including excavation, concreting, form work and compacted back filling shall be at CONTRACTOR’S cost. 17.06.00 On completing pile cut-off for any pile, all exposed reinforcement surface shall be coated with cement wash at no extra cost to the OWNER. 17.07.00 The CONTRACTOR shall backfill all excavation done by him for pile cut-off to levels specified by the CONSULTANT or as shown on the Drawing. These levels shall be lower than or at least equal to the original working level. 17.08.00 Any extra-excavation and back filling of the same with consolidation shall be at no extra cost the OWNER. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 124 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 18.00.00 TOLERANCES 18.01.00 POSITIONAL. 8.01.01 18.02.00 For a pile cut off at or above ground level, the maximum permitted deviation of the pile centre from the centre-point shown on the Drawing shall be 75 mm in any direction. An additional tolerance for the pile head cut off below ground level will be permitted in accordance with the Clauses 14.2 and 14.3 below. VERTICAL 18.02.01 Tolerance of verticality shall be within 1 in 75 for the completed pile shaft. 18.03.00 RAKER 18.03.01 The equipment governing alignment of the inclined permanent casing and boring tool shall be set to give the correct alignment of the pile to within a tolerance of 1 in 50. 18.03.02 The maximum deviation of the finished pile from the specified rake shall be 1 in 25 for piles raking upto 1:6 and 1 in 15 for pile raking more than 1:6. 18.04.00 CORRECTIVE MEASURES 18.04.01 No forcible corrections to piles to overcome errors of position or alignment shall be attempted. 18.04.02 If after excavation for pile cut off, any pile or piles are found to exceed the specified positional and/or alignment tolerances, these shall be replaced or supplemented by the CONTRACTOR by additional pile(s) as directed by the CONSULTANT at no extra cost to the OWNER. Also if as a result of pile(s) exceeding the specified permissible positional deviations, and/or the consequent addition of any replacement pile(s), any pile cap is required to be enlarged, the extra cost of such pile cap enlargement shall be to the Contractor’s account. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 125 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 19.00.00 ABANDONED PILE BORES AND REJECTED PILES 19.01.00 Abandoned pile bores shall be filled with sand, which constitutes fine aggregate used for making concrete. If a permanent liner has already been driven, the same shall be withdrawn progressively as the sand is poured in. However no attempts shall be made to extract the liner if, in the opinion of the CONSULTANT, this can damage or set out of alignment of any other pile in the vicinity. 19.02.00 No attempt shall be made to forcibly extract a rejected pile shaft. Rejected piles shall be cut off as directed by the CONSULTANT. The CONTRACTOR shall install replacement pile or piles in lieu of rejected pile as directed by the CONSULTANT. 19.03.00 The CONTRACTOR shall not be paid any additional amount for filling up abandoned pile, bores or cutting off rejected piles, provision of extra piles, enlargement of pile cap etc., necessitated due to faulty work of the CONTRACTOR. 20.00.00 PILE CAPACITIES 20.01.00 Safe structural capacity of the pile shall be taken as the load calculated on the basis of permissible concrete stresses as indicated in Data Sheet-A and permissible steel stresses as per 1S:456. 20.02.00 The negative skin friction shall be determined using results of the pull-out test of short piles. Skin friction component of total load carrying capacity shall be determined by conducting initial cyclic pile load tests on piles installed to full length. Also the capacity of piles to resist uplift forces shall he determined by conducting pull-out, tests on piles installed to full length. 20.03.00 Maximum estimated safe axial loads, both downward and upward that the piles are required to take sizewise are listed in Data Sheet-A. The maximum estimated lateral capacities of the piles sizewise are also listed in Data Sheet- A. Pile load tests on both initial piles as well as working piles shall be carried out to establish and prove these capacities. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 126 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 21.00.00 LOAD TESTS 21.01.00 GENERAL 21.01.01 The number of initial test piles and test on working piles shall be as specified in the schedule of items or at the discretion of the CONSULTANT. The CONTRACTOR shall provide everything necessary including equipment, measuring devices, jack, structural framework, kentledges etc. This includes installation of test piles also and concreting of pile cap either temporary or permanent over single or group of piles for testing the piles. The pile cap concreting will not be paid for separately. 21.01.02 Load tests shall in general be carried out as per1S:2911 (Part IV) except as modified herein or directed otherwise by the CONSULTANT. 21.01.03 Piles to be load tested shall either be so designated on the Drawings or specified/selected by CONSULTANT in the field. 21.01.04 Test load shall be applied to the piles by any suitable means preferably by a properly calibrated hydraulic jack with a remote control pump. Test load applied to the piles shall be such that a constant load is maintained under increasing settlement. 21.01.05 The required reaction may be derived from either a loaded platform or anchor piles. Anchor pile, shall not be closer than 6 times the pile diameter on either side. Working piles shall not be used as anchor piles. Anchor piles, if provided, shall be at CONTRACTOR’S cost. 21.01.06 Load tests shall be carried out not earlier than 28 days from the day of casting the pile. Initial load shall be completed well the schedule start regular piles. However routine load test may be concurrently with pile installation operation by maintaining adequate as directed CONSULTANT. 21.01.07 The design and arrangement of application of loading etc., for all types of load tests, shall be submitted by the CONTRACTOR to the CONSULTANT for his approval. 21.01.08 All load tests shall be conducted under the supervision of the CONSULTANT. All responsibilities for conducting the tests safely and properly shall rest with the CONTRACTOR. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 127 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 21.02.00 CALIBRATION OF EQUIPMENTS The CONTRACTOR shall ensure, that all the equipment/instruments are properly calibrated, at the start of the tests, to reflect the correct values. If so demanded by the CONSULTANT, the CONTRACTOR shall have all or such specific instruments tested at an approved testing laboratory at the Contractor's cost and the test report shall be submitted to the CONSULTANT. It the CONSULTANT desires to witness/inspect such tests, the CONTRACTOR shall arrange for this and also provide such access and facilities for inspection which are required. 21.03.00 INITIAL LOAD TESTS 21.03.01 Immediately on mobilization to site, the CONTRACTOR shall prepare to install piles for conducting initial vertical load (downward and pull-out) and lateral pile load tests. 21.03.02 In case the cut off is below ground level, a suitable excavation shall be made to provide access to the level after breaking oft the unsound concrete as specified earlier in Clause 13.0. 21.03.03 For the compression type of test, the pile head shall be cut off level and capped by a R.C. cap to provide horizontal plane bearing surface upon which a steel plate shall be placed. Earth from under the pile cap shall be scooped out so that pile cap has no soil support. Thereafter, the kentledge and all other accessories outside the pit pertaining to and necessary for conducting the test shall be set up. An easy and safe access to the pile test head shall be provided. 21.03.04 It the pile test head is below the ground water level, the CONTRACTOR shall provide suitable sumps and dewater the pit so as to render the pit dry enough, to enable conducting the test. Any dewatering will be considered as part of the test and the CONTRACTOR shall not be separately paid for the same. 21.03.05 The test load shall be so applied that it reaches the pile in a static manner. The loading may be applied directly by kentledge or jacking against a reaction system provided by means of kentledge, tension piles or ground anchors. Where kentledge is used, it shall be supported on a properly designed frame or gantry such that there is no possibility of the load tilting or collapsing. The foundations of this frame or gantry should be sufficiently far way from the test pile so as not to affect its behaviour to any significant extent. Where tension piles or ground anchors are used, they shall be located a minimum distance of six times the test pile size from the centre of the test pile to the centre of the pile/anchor. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 128 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 21.03.06 The displacement of the test pile shall be related to a fixed datum. This may consist of a reference beam (data bar) supported by two foundations positioned outside the zones of influence of the reaction support area. The deflection measuring equipment must be set up in such a way that any tilting of the test pile will not cause errors in the measurements. Dial gauges shall be used for measuring deflection. The least count of the dial gauges shall be at least 0.02mm. At least two but preferably four dial gauges shall be used and shall be placed at diagonally opposite corners. 21.03.07 The reference bars for the dial gauges shall be adequately rigid and on firm supports. The support., for the reference bars shall be so located that they are beyond the zone of influence of the loaded test pile (equal to three times the pile size from pile edge) and the zone of influence of kentledge supports. The bars shall be adequately stiffened and placed on supports in a manner such that any effect due to ambient temperature variations and vibrations due to traffic etc. are minimized. The reference bars and dial gauges shall not be exposed to direct sun and the pit shall be protected by tarpaulin sheets while the test is in progress. 21.03.08 The total test load shall be three (3) times the estimated safe load-carrying capacity of the pile or failure, whichever is earlier, and shall be applied in equal increments of 20 percent of the estimated safe load. Unloading may however be in higher decrements with total number not less than five. At each load increment, pile deflection shall be observed accurate to 0.02 mm at an interval of 1, 5, 10, 15, 25, 35, 50 and 60 minutes and thereafter at half hourly intervals, upto a time when the rate of deflection of the pile top reduces to 0.1 mm in half hour or 0.2 mm. in one hour. The load increment in any case shall be maintained for 1 hour at least. The design load as well as the final load shall be maintained for 24 hours at least or as indicated in Data Sheet-A. At these load increments, after the first hour deflection readings shall be taken at every one hour interval. 21.03.09 During the release stage, each load decrement shall be maintained at least for 30 minutes and readings of deflection noted. When the load is fully released to zero, measurements of rebound shall be continued till the deflection of the pile top is not more than 0.1mm per half hour. 21.03.10 Initial cyclic tests shall be carried out to determine skin friction and point resistance of piles. This shall be carried out as per 1S:2911 (Part-V). However, each cycle of loading and unloading shall be repeated allowing a time Interval of 10 minute. between the end of one cycle and the beginning of the next. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 129 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 21.03.11 For the initial lateral pile load test, pairs of piles for lateral load tests shall be. driven. Lateral load test shall be conducted as per IS:2911 (Part—IV) with horizontal loading increment as specified in Data Sheet-A, stage wise till failure occurs. Load shall be applied at cutoff level. 21.03.12 Piles specified for pull out test, shall be subjected to pull-out force in equal increments of not more than 2.5 tonne till the rise exceeds 12 mm. or specified ultimate pull-out force is reached whichever is earlier. A graph of pull out force and the corresponding rise of pile top shall be plotted immediately. 21.03.13 If the initial test pile(s) which is (are) load tested fails (fail) to attain the specified safe structural capacity of piles and if this can be attributed to defective workmanship and/or negligence on the part of the CONTRACTOR, the OWNER reserves the right to terminate the contract and to award the contract to other parties. In such an event, all costs of mobilization, installation and testing of test pile(s) and any other work in connection with the test pile, shall be borne entirely by the CONTRACTOR. 21.03.15 While executing the pile bore for all test piles, a record of bore log and Standard Penetration Tests shall be maintained over the continuous length of boring in an approved format. Subsoil samples and rock cuttings shall be collected and systematically preserved as per Clause 9.3.2 above. LOAD TESTS ON WORKING PILES 21.04.00 21.04.01 These tests shall be carried out on piles selected by the CONSULTANT after they have been cast. Tests to be carried out on working piles shall essentially be ordinary compression type. The test will be similar to that conducted on initial test piles, except that the capacity of the pile shall be limited to 1.5 times the safe pile capacity, the maximum settlement during test loading not exceeding 12 mm 21.04.02 The working pile shall be considered to have stood the test satisfactorily if total settlement under final test load is not more than 12 mm and net (residual) settlement after removal of test load not more than 6mm. 21.04.03 If the pile does not satisfy these requirements and if this can be attributed to defective workmanship or negligence on the part of CONTRACTOR, all costs of the load test, the cost of providing and installing additional piles, cost of additional or enlarged pile caps and other work necessitated because of the detective pile, shall be at the cost of CONTRACTOR. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 130 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 21.05.00 RECORDS OF LOAD TEST RESULTS 21.05.1 Within 48 hours of completion of each test, the CONTRACTOR shall furnish a copy of all recorded test data to the CONSULTANT. Upon completion of pile, load tests, the CONTRACTOR shall furnish the CONSULTANT at no extra cost with a pile test report in triplicate and this shall include the following information where applicable. a) Identification of working pile/test pile as per Drawing. b) Coordinate axes of pile, elevation of bottom of pile, cut off level of pile, type of pile, pile size. c) Pile Borelog Records d) SPT results e) Deviation from designated location/alignment. f) Jack gauge calibration curves from approved Test House. g) Tabulation of loads and settlement reading. during the loading and unloading of the pile. h) Graphic representation of the test results in the form of time- load – settlement curves. i) Graphic analysis of Initial Cyclic test results to separate skin friction and end bearing as set out in 1S:2911 (Part-IV) j) Remarks concerning any unusual occurrences during installation or test loading of the working 26.00.00 INDIRECT INTEGRITY TESTS FOR PILES 26.01.00 The CONSULTANT may desire to get bored cast in situ piles subject to integrity tests by indirect methods through another agency. The CONTRACTOR shall give all co-operation in getting such tests conducted. The CONSULTANT reserves the right to give due weightage and consideration to results of these tests which will affect the integrity of the installed piles. 21.02.00 Alternately, if indicated in Data Sheet-A and in the Schedule of Quantities. the CONTRACTOR shall arrange to get such tests conducted, all as specified in Data Sheet-A. 23.00.00 INSTALLATION RECORDS 23.01.00 The CONTRACTOR shall submit each working day, detailed pile installation records in duplicate for each pile installed in the enclosed formats. The CONSULTANT’s piling plans will show all piles serially numbered as per the piling layout plan. The cost of all labour. materials and services called for herein shall be included in the CONTRACTOR’S unit rates. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 131 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 23.02.00 A. 10000011 / HB / 11094 The details of the record shall include but not be limited to the list below PILE INSTALLATION RECORD BASIC DATA 1. Piling Layout Drawing No. 2. Pile Number 3. Location Coordinates 4. System/Structure 5. Pile Type: Vertical/Raker 6. Pile Nominal Diameter 7. Pile Tip Elevation 8. Pile Cut-off Elevation 9. Ground Level at Pile Location 10. Grad. of Concrete Specified 11. Reinforcement Details(Draw sketch if complex) 12. Safe Capacity of Pile Specified B. PILE BORE DATA 1. Date and Time of Start 2. Date and Time of Completion 3. Method of Boring 4. Inner Nominal Diameter of Temporary casing/ Permanent Liner 5. Length of Temporary Casing/Permanent Liner 6. Material of Permanent Liner 7. Method of Jointing Temporary Casing/Permanent Liner 8. Treatment to Permanent Liner 9. Length Bored in Soil 10. Length Bored in Rock (The rock shall be as defined in Data Sheet A or Notes to Schedule of Quantities for purpose of measurement). 11. Bore Log and Standard Penetration Tests(Draw sketch or refer to separate sheet) 12. Number of Subsoil Samples/Rock Cuttings collected 13. Ground Water Elevation 14. Any Artesian Conditions 15. Any Bore Collapse and Details 16. Any Loss of Drilling Mud and Detail. 17. Any Other Details or Phenomena Observed. C. FLUSHING RECORD 1. Date and Time of Start of Final Post-bore Flushing 2. Date and Time of Completion of Final Post-bore Flushing. 3. Remark. on inspection of Wash of Post-bore flushing. 4. Date and Time of Start of Final Pre—concreting Flushing. 5. Date and Time of Completion of Final Pre-concreting Flushing. 6. Remarks on Inspection of Wash of Pre-concreting Flushing. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 132 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: D. 10000011 / HB / 11094 CONCRETING RECORD 1. Date and Time of Start of Concreting 2. Date and Time of Completion of Concreting 3. Grade of Cement and Name of Manufacturer 4. Date of Manufacture of Cement. 5. Grade of Concrete as Mixed 6. Grade of Concrete Specified 7. Slump of Mixed Concrete at Pile Head 8. Cube Test Results 9. Method of Concrete Placement in Pile Bore 10. Theoretical Volume of Concrete:(Pile Tip to Top of Pile as Cast) 11. Actual Volume of Concrete : (Pile Tip to Top of Pile as Cast) 12. Ratio of Actual Volume to Theoretical Volume of Concrete : (Express as Percentage) 13. Any Delay. during Concreting and Reasons 14. Overflow Quantity 15. Any Other Details. 24.00.00 CLEAN-UP 24.01.00 All throughout the work, the CONTRACTOR shall take all steps to prevent spillage of bentonite slurry on the areas outside the immediate vicinity of boring. The slurry shall not be allowed to flow into any water courses, nallas, site drains or any public drains. 24.02.00 Any discarded and/or used bentonite shall be removed from the site without any undue delay. 24.03.00 Upon completion of piling work, all casings equipment, construction tools, protective coverings and any debris resulting from the work shall be removed from the premises. 24.04.00 All debris, empty containers, scrap timber etc. shall be removed as directed by the CONSULTANT/OWNER. 24.05.00 Exposed and finished concrete and dowel surfaces shall be left in a clean condition satisfactory to the CONSULTANT. 24.06.00 Any pits made for bentonite mixing shall be excavated and back filled with good earth and consolidated. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 133 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 25.00.00 MEASUREMENTS AND RATES 25.01.00 Rates shall be quoted as indicated for respective items of Schedule of Quantities. 25.02.00 For the purpose of payment and measurement for vertical and raker piles all lengths referred to in the Schedule of Quantities and elsewhere shall be measured as follows a) For pile boring in soil, the length for boring in soil shall be measured along the pile axis from the working ground level to the top of rock, if rock is encountered. The definition of “rock” for this purpose shall be as indicated in Schedule of quantities which shall be reflected in the Pile Installation Record Sheet and endorsed by the OWNER/CONSULTANT. If rock is not encountered, the length for boring in soil shall be measured along the pile axis from working ground level to the tip of the pile as recorded in the Pile Installation Record Sheets and endorsed by the OWNER/CONSULTANT. b) For pile boring in rock alone, the length of chiselling into the rock shall be measured along the pile axis from top of rock (as defined above) upto the tip of the pile, all as recorded in the Pile Installation Record Sheets and endorsed by the OWNER/CONSULTANT. c) For concreting of pile shaft, the lengths of concreting shall be measured along the pile axis from pile cut-off level as specified to the tip of the pile as recorded in the Pile Installation. Record Sheets are endorsed by the OWNER/ CONSULTANT. Nothing extra will be paid for mandatory concreting above pile cut-off. concrete overflow, chipping to cut-off level and building up of pile to cut-off level unless indicated otherwise in Data Sheet-A or Notes to Schedule of Quantities. 25.03.00 The rates for boring in soil and chiselling in rock shall also include for removing excavated muck from the bores and used and/or discarded bentonite from within the area of operation upto a maximum distances of 1000m and disposed off without creating any environmental problems. 25.04.00 Rates for all types of pile load tests shall also account for excavation/shutteeing/shoring back filling and continuous dewatering to keep the excavated observation area dry throughout the setting up and test period. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 134 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 DATA SHEET-A Sl No. Description Type of Cement Type of Concrete Grade of Concrete Dia of piles envisaged Capacity of piles Type of Piles 1 Piling Works at Sulphate Design M30 450 Dia 70 T (ver) Bored KMML Resisting mix 3.5T (hor) cast in EXPANSION Cement 17.5T situ TIO2 PROJECT 43 (uplift) piles Quilon , Kerala grade conforming to IS2911 Reinforcement 2 High corrosion resistant TMT bars (Fe415 TMT-HCR from SAIL/(Fe415-TISCON-TMT bars from TATA) with strength requirement conforming to IS-1786 Geo technical Information Soil data 3 Soil exploration details of BH , located near Notes: 1. The Pile diameters and Capacity envisaged are indicative only. The final design and arriving at the capacity of the piles are the responsibility of the tenderer. 2. Piles shall be designed to take a horizontal load of 5% of its vertical capacity and an uplift of 25% of its vertical capacity. 3. Design calculations for pile shall be submitted and got approved by OWNER/ CONSULTANT 4. For additional information regarding soil data if any required, refer clause number 6.03.00 of piling specification. Cost of additional work of soil investigation shall be born by the tenderer. Ground improvement by driving wooden ballies Wooden ballies shall be of best quality locally available and it shall be approved by the engineer. The wooden ballies shall be of 100mm diameter, 1.5 meter length and it shall be kept at a spacing of 0.5M c/c. The ballies shall be made in the form of truncated cone or a pyramid at driving end and having the end area shall be 25 Sqcm. The length of the truncated cone shall not be less than 150mm. Driving of wooden ballies The driving of wooden ballies shall be done manually or mechanically by dropping hammer over the head. The hammer blows shall be axial to the wooden posts and the ballies shall not be strained to bring it vertical. Proper care shall be taken while driving. To prevent splitting and reduce brooming,, ballies shall be hooped with a suitable MS ring or wrapped with wires. While driving the head shall be further protected by provision of cushion blocks. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 135 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 ROAD AND PAVEMENTS 1.00.01.1 SCOPE OF WORK The work contemplated under these specifications refers to earth work in excavation, forming embankments, soling, WBM. Bituminous Macadam. Wearing course/sealing coat etc. for foad and pavement works. 2.00.01.1 EARTH WORK IN EXCAVATION : 2.01.00 The specifications for “Excavation & Back filling” described earlier shall be generally followed. Forming embankment : 2.02.0 2.02.01 The work shall include preliminaries of clearing site, setting out and preparing the ground and there after forming embankment for the roads, paths etc. With approved material available form excavations under this contract (excavation paid separately under respective items) or elsewhere, spreading in layers, watering and compacting to the required density and lines, curves, grades, chambered cross section and dimensions shown in the plan or as directed by the owner. When the embankment is to be laid on hill sides or slopes, the existing slopes are to be ploughed deeply. If the cross slopes are steeper than 1 in 3, steps with reverse slope shall be cut into the slopes to give proper hold and seating to the bank as directed by the Owner. The top 15cm of soil shall be scarified and watered if directed and compacted to the same density as specified for the embankment before any material is laid for the embankment work. 2.02.02 Only the approved excavated earth shall be placed in the embankments in successive horizontal layers not exceeding 200mm, extending to the full width of the embankment including the slopes at the level of the particular layer and 30 cm, more on both sides to allow compaction of the full specified section. The extra loose stuff at the edges shall be trimmed later after completion of the bank work without extra cost leaving the correct section fully compacted. 2.02.03 Keeping the width of the bank initially less and widening it later by dumping loose earth on the slopes shall not be permitted as the additional width and slopes will remain loose and un-compacted. Similar procedure to extend the embankment by dumping the material longitudinally shall also not be llowed. Each layer of the embankment shall be watered, levelled and compacted as specified here-in-after, before the succeeding layers are placed. The surface of the embankment shall at all times during construction, be maintained in such a manner so as to prevent ponding. Water to be used shall be free from all armful elements which may cause efflorescence etc. and approved by the Owner . Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 136 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 2.02.04 10000011 / HB / 11094 If the material for embankment contains moisture less than the optimum moisture, water shall be added in the 100mm, layers of the embankment to bring moisture uniformly upto requirement. It the excavated material contain more than required moisture, it shall be allowed to dry until the moisture is reduced to required extent. If due to the wetness, the moisture content of the soil cannot be reduced to the appropriate amount by exposure, embankment work shall be suspended till suitable conditions prevail at no extra claim/compensation. 2.02.05 When loose layer is levelled manually or mechanically and moistened or dried to a uniform moisture content suitable for maximum compaction, it shall be compacted by 8 to 10 tonne power roller or sheep foot rollers or heavy hauling or dozing equipment to give the specified 90% of the proctor density, if on testing, the density is found to be less than 90% of the proctor density, the contractor shall do additional compaction necessary to get the specified density after adding water if required. If the density cannot be improved by such reasonable efforts, the work may be accepted as substandard work by the Owner. If he thinks it is not harmful for the purpose and paid for at a reduce rate. Test shall be made to determine the maximum density of the material to be used by the proctor method before starting the work. Density test shall be carried out for the embankment work during the progress of the work. One set of three core samples for every 1000 sqm. (about 1000 sq.yd.) area of each layer of embankment work shall be taken and tested. The average density shall not be less than 90% of the proctor density, obtained in the laboratory. 2.02.06 Arrangement for obtaining the samples and transporting the same to laboratory, shall be made by the contractor his own cost. 2.02.07 Embankment not accessible to rollers, such as those adjoining bridges, culverts and other works shall be carried out independently of the main embankments and shall have the layers placed in 150 mm to 200 mm height and each layer shall to moistened and thoroughly compacted with mechanical or manual tamper. Before placing the next layer, the surface of the under layer shall be moistened and scarified so as to provide a satisfactory bond with the next layer. 2.02.08 The embankment shall be finished and dressed smooth and even, in conformity with the alignment levels and cross section, and dimensions shown on the drawing. On curves, section shall be provided with super elevation and increased width, is shown on the plans as directed by the Consultant. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 137 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 2.02.09 Joining of old and new embankment shall be done by stepping in and overall slope of about 1 to 5. 2.02.10 The contractor shall be responsible for maintaining the embankment work in satisfactory conditions at his own cost till finally accepted including making good any damage. 3.00.00 SUB GRADE : 3.01.00 Preparation of Sub-grade : The surface of the formation for a width of subbase which shall be as per drg. shall first be cut to a depth equal to the combine depth of sub-base and surface courses below the proposed finished level (due allowance being made for consolidation). It shall then be cleaned of all foreign substances. Any ruts or soft yielding patches that appear due to improper drainage conditions, traffic hauling or from any other cause, shall be corrected and the sub-grade dressed off parallel to finished profile. 3.02.00 Consolidation: The sub grade shall be consolidated with a power road roller of 8 to 12 tonnes. The roller shall run over the sub grade till the soil is evenly and densely consolidated and behaves as an elastic mass (the roller shall pass a minimum of 5 runs on the sub grade). All undulations in the surface that develop due to rolling shall be made good with fresh material or quarry spoils as the case may be and the sub grade is re-rolled. 3.03.00 Surface Regularity : The finished surface shall be uniform and conform to the lines, grades and typical cross sections shown in the drawings. When tested with the template and straight edge, the variation shall be within the tolerances specified in the Table below : Permissible tolerances of surface regularity Longitudinal profile Maximum permissible undulation when measured with a 3 metre straight edge Cross profile Maximum permissible variation from specified profile when measured with a camber-template 15 mm 24 mm 3.04.00 Where the surface irregularity of the sub-grade falls outside the specified tolerances, the contractor shall be liable to rectify these with fresh material or quarry spoils as the case may be, and the sub grade rerolled to the satisfaction of the Consultant. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 138 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 4.00.00 SUB-BASES : 4.01.00 Water bound Macadam Sub-base with stone aggregate : Stone aggregate of size 90 mm shall be used. This consists of clean crushed coarse aggregate mechanically interlocked by rolling using power road roller of 8 to 10 t and voids thereof filled with screening and blinding material with the assistance of water, laid on a prepared sub grade/ sub base. 4.01.01 Quantities of Materials : Quantities of coarse aggregate, screening and blinding material required to be stacked for 100mm approximate compacted thickness of WBM sub-base course for 10 sqm. Shall be as per table given below: Coarse Aggregate Classification Size range Grading-1 90mm to Net Qty 1.2 Cum. to .28Cum Stone screenings Grading/Classification and size Type A 13.2mm Net Qty 0.27Cum to Blinding material 0.08 Cum to 0.10 Cum NOTE : Net Quantity = Loose quantity measured in stack minus 7.5% 4.01.02 Preparation of foundation : In the case of an existing unsurfaced road, where new materials is to be laid, the surface shall be scarified and reshaped to the required grade, chambered shape as necessary. Weak places shall be strengthened, corrugations removed and depressions and pot holes made good with suitable materials, before spreading the aggregate for WBM. 4.01.03 Spreading Aggregate : The coarse aggregate shall be spread uniformly and evenly upon the prepared base in required quantities with a twisting motion to avoid segregation. In no case shall these be dumped in heaps directly on the area where these are to be laid nor shall their hauling over a partly completed base be permitted. The aggregates shall be spread uniformly to proper profile by using templates placed across the road six meters part. Where specified, approved mechanical devices may be used to spread the aggregates uniformly. The levels along the longitudinal direction upon which the metal shall be laid, shall be first obtained at site to the satisfaction of Owner and these shall be adhered to . 4.01.04 The surface of the aggregate spread shall be carefully trued up and all high spots by removing or adding aggregate as may be required. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 139 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 4.01.05 The WBM sub-base shall be normally constructed in layers of 115 mm compacted thickness. No segregation of large or fine particles shall be allowed and the coarse aggregate as spread shall be of uniform gradation with no pockets of fine material. 4.01.06 The coarse aggregate shall normally not be spread in lengths exceeding three days average work ahead of the rolling and blending of the proceeding section. 4.02.0 Rolling : 4.02.01 Immediately following the spreading of the coarse aggregate, it shall be compacted to the full width by rolling with either a three-wheel power roller of 8 to 10t capacity or an equivalent vibratory roller. Initially, light rolling is to be done which shall be discontinued when the aggregate is partially compacted with sufficient void space in then to permit application of screenings. 4.02.02 The rolling shall begin from the edges with the roller running forward and backward and adding the screenings simultaneously until the edges have been firmly compacted. The roller shall then progress gradually from the edges to the centre paralled to the centre line of the road and overlapping uniformly each preceding rear wheel track by one half width and shall continue until the entire area of the course has been rolled by the rear wheel. Rolling shall continue until the road metal is thoroughly keyed with no creeping of metal ahead of the roller. Only slight sprinkling of water may be done during rolling, if required. On super cleaved curves, the rolling shall proceed from the lower edge and progress gradually continuing towards the upper edge of the pavement. 4.02.03 Rolling shall not be done when the sub-grade is soft or yielding or when the rolling causes a wave like motion in the sub-base of sub-grade. When rolling develops irregularities that exceed 12mm when tested with a three metre straight edge, the irregular surface shall be loosened and then aggregate added to or removed from it as required and the area rolled until it gives a uniform surface conforming to the desired cross-section and grade. The surface shall also be checked transversely by template for chambered any irregularities corrected in the manner descried above. In no case shall the use of screenings to made up depressions be permitted. Application of screening : After the coarse aggregate has been lightly rolled to the required true surface, screenings shall be applied gradually over the surface to completely fill the interstices. Dry rolling shall be continued while the screening are being spread so that the jarring effect of the roller causes them to settle into the voids of the coarse aggregates. The screenings shall not be dumped in piles on the coarse aggregate but shall be spread uniformly in successive thin layers either by the spreading motion of the hand shovels or a mechanical spreader. Signature & Seal of the Bidder 4.03.0 4.03.01 Attachment 2 Page 140 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 4.03.02 The screening shall be applied at a slow rate (in three or more applications) so as to ensure filling of all voids. Rolling and brooming shall continue with the spreading of the screenings. Either mechanical brooms or hand brooms or both may be used. In no case shall the screenings be applied, so fast and thick as to form cakes, ridges on the surface making the filling of voids difficult, or to prevent the direct bearing of the roller on the coarse aggregates. The spreading, rolling and brooming of screenings shall be performed on sections which can be completed within one day’s operation and shall continue until no more screening can be forced into the voids of the coarse aggregate. Damp and wet screenings shall not be used under any circumstances. 4.04.00 Sprinkling and Grouting : 4.04.01 After spreading the screening and rolling, the surface shall be copiously sprinkled with water, swept and rolled. Hand brooms shall be used to sweep the wet screening into the voids and to distribute them evenly. The sprinkling, sweeping and rolling operations shall be continued and additional screenings applied where necessary until the coarse aggregates are well bonded and firmly set for the entire depth and until a grout has been formed of screenings and wa ter that will fill all voids and form a wave of grout ahead of the wheels of the roller. The quantity of water to be used during the construction shall not be excessive so as to cause damage to the sub-base or sub-grade. 4.05.00 Application of Blinding Material : 4.05.01 After the application of screenings and rolling, a suitable blinding material shall be applied at a uniform and slow rate in two or more successive thin layers. After each application of blinding material, the surface shall be copiously sprinkled with water and the resulting slurry swept-in with hand brooms or mechanical brooms or both so as to fill the voids properly. The surface shall then be rolled by a 8-10 t roller, water being applied to the wheels in order to wash down the blinding material that may get stuck to the wheels. The spreading of blinding material, sprinkling of water, sweeping with brooms and rolling shall continue until the slurry that is formed well, after filling the voids form a wave ahead of wheels of the moving roller. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 141 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 4.06.00 Setting and Drying : 4.06.01 After final compaction of the course, the road shall be allowed to cure overnight. Next morning defective spots shall be filled with screenings or blinding material, lightly sprinkled with water, if necessary and rolled. No traffic shall be allowed till the macadam sets. Surface Evenness: 4.07.00 4.07.01 The surface evenness of completed WBM sub-base in the longitudinal and transverse directions shall be as specified in the table given below: Cross profile of Longitudinal profile Size coarse aggregates 45-90 mm Maximum permissible Maximum permissible undulation when measured variation from specified profile with a 3 metre straight edge when measured with a camber template 15 mm 12 mm The longitudinal profile shall be checked with a 3M long straight edge at the middle of each traffic lane along a line parallel to the centre line of the road. The transverse profile shall be checked with a series of three chamber boards at intervals of 10M. 4.08.00 Rectification of Defective Construction : Where the surface irregularity of the WBM sub-base course exceeds the tolerances specified in the table given above or where the course is otherwise defective due to sub-grade soil mixing with the aggregates, the layer to its full thickness shall be scarified over theaffected area, reshaped with added material or removed and replaced with fresh material as applicable, and recompacted. The area treated in the aforesaid manner shall not be less than 10 sqm. In no case shall depressions be filled up with screenings and blinding material. 5.00.00 RUBBLE SOLING : 5.01.00 Rubble soling for road work including foot paths, culverts, side drains etc. shall be carried out as specified here-in before 3.3 for rubble stone soling, as far as they are applicable, with the following additions. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 142 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 5.02.00 Subgrade for soling shall be prepared by cleaning of all foreign substances including rank vegetation, if any, Any ruls or soft yielding places that appear due to improper drainage conditions, traffic, hauling or from any other cause shall be corrected by filling/cutting upto 150 mm and compacted and the Subgrade dressed off parallel to the finished profile and the same shall beapproved by the Consultant, before laying of soling. Soling shall be lai in regular lines and staggered joints. The stones shall be laid as closely as possible and packed well. The stones shall be so laid as to have their bases and the target area resting on the Subgrade and in contact with each other. 5.03.00 Soling shall be laid to proper gradient and chamber which shall be checked frequently to ensure accuracy. Rolling shall then be carried out by a 8 to 10 t power roller and soling consolidated properly shall be lightly sprinkled juring rolling, if ordered by the Consultant. 5.04.00 The surface thus prepared shall first be passed by the Consultant, after which 40mm to 50mm thick layer of selected hard murrum available from excavation shall be spread over the soling as directed by the Consultant, and rolled again such that the hard murrum gets into the interstices, It shall, however, be ensured that a thin layer of murrum/grit shall remain on the finished surface of soling. 5.05.00 The area of soling actually done of specified consolidated thickness limiting to the dimensions as per drg. shall be measured in square metre upto two decimal places. 6.00.00 WATER BOUND MACADAM : 6.01.00 Metal : Metal required for water bound macadam surfacing shall broken from the first sort rubble. The rubble shall be broken to required size by the contractor at his own cost. However, the metal required for water bound macadam shall conform to IRC specification in all respects. It shall be hard, sound, trap stone metal free from decay and weathering and obtained from approved quarries, and shall be of 50 mm nominal size. Collection of metal : Metal shall be of first sort black trap stone and shall be collected in stacks on level ground and stacked on the sides of the roads as directed. The metal shall be free from all earth, rubbish and vegetable matter and graded before stacking and closely packed in stacks. The metal supplied by the contractor shall be arranged in stacks for measurement. No deductions will be made for voids. The size of stack shall be 1m wide at top 2.2m wide at bottom and 60m high. The length shall be as directed by the Owner. The contractor shall provide the templates required to ensure, compliance with size of stack stipulated. 6.02.00 Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 143 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6.03.00 Supply of Murrum : The contractor shall be permitted to excavate in the selected areas in the township/site of work, as approved by the Consultant, for collection of murrum. The excavation shall be done by the contractor to correct line and level, transport and stack the same at site of work as directed by the Owner. Alternately, the contractor will be permitted to bring from outside, approved graded hard murrum 10mm, down to dust (but not silt) as directed by the Owner and shall also be collected in stacks on level ground along side of the road. 6.04.00 Laying and preparation of water bound macadam surface : 6.04.01 After preparation of the existing surface as specified above, 50mm, size metal collected in stacks shall be spread to uniform thickness over the prepared surface and consolidated to 75mm thickness as specified here in after. 6.04.02 Templates properly made of full width and gauge or templates fitted with central plumb to each of edge fixed with it must be used. The depth of the plank forming the gauge shall be the thickness of the metal layer in loose state so that when the metal has been properly spread, the gauges are buried just flush with the surface. The intermediate work shall be tested with cord stretched between the gauge. Three templates shall be provided and used with a distance of about 7.5m between each but not exceeding 15m. A spirit level shall invariably be used with the templates to ensure that the edges of metalling are truly levelled. The metal shall be spread and rolled with to 10t power roller until well compacted and there is no appreciable movement (in the metal) when walked upon, or no appreciable wave in front of the advancing roller, Rolling shall be done by roller perfectly, by a 8 to 10 t power roller, till proper internal packing of adjacent pieces of stones has been achieved. Excessive dry rolling shall be avoided. 6.04.03 Rolling shall commence from the edge to the centre of the road. In case of super elevated curve, rolling shall commence from the inside edge of the center and progress towards the outside edge. Where the gradient is steeper than 1 in 60, the roller shall run up grade, i.e. rolling shall be started from lower level to upward direction for the 1St rolling. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 144 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6.04.04 While rolling the surface in two or more parts, a strip of about 230mm to 300mm along the predetermined cross section shall be left unrolled while consolidating the first half. This shall be properly jointed when the metal is being spread on the second half and consolidated with it. Care must be taken to avoid the occurrence of a continuous longitudinal furrow along cross section of the road. Full width of road will be rolled at a time. 6.04.05 The metalling shall be moderately kept saturated and rolling continued until consolidation is completed. Just enough watering shall be done so as to flush the metal slurry into the interstices. Care shall be taken to avoid excess water softening the subsoil. The full consolidation stage shall be tested by (a) putting a piece of metal about the size of wall not on the surface and roller passed over it. If it is crushed the surface shall be deemed as well consolidated (b) there shall be no creeping of stone ahead of the roller. 6.05.06 Until the above conditions are satisfied, no blinding or surfacing materials shall be put on the surface. No rolling shall be done where signs of metal crushing are noticed or rolling causes wave like motions in the base course of well compacted. Before starting rolling, the metal shall be dressed accurately to chamber. No fresh metal shall be added once dry consolidation has commenced. The part of the road must be fully racked up so that the metal is thoroughly incorporated into the body of road. 6.06.00 Blinding Course : When the required consolidation has been completed, the blinding material of approved graded murrum/stone grit and dust (unscreened) as specified shall be spread over the surface and brushed backwards and forwards to fill in the surface voids and rolling and watering continued to such an extent that the blinding materials are formed into a slurry and is grouted into the interstices. After the road has been fully consolidated, the surface shall be covered with 12mm layer of murrum/stone grit and dust (unscreened) and road opened to traffic after 4 days. The road shall be kept watered for 14 days or such other period as specified by the Owner. Where tracks are likely to be formed by the traffic on the road, barriers such as tree branches etc. shall be put to divert the traffic. After 15 days, light watering and rolling shall be done. For joints across the road, the end of each layer shall be given a flat slope and well consolidated together and hump formation must be avoided. Damages to the Owner’s Property : Any damage to the departs property due to negligence of the contractor while executing the work shall be made good to the original conditions at his own cost. 6.07.00 Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page145 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 7.00.00 Bituminous macadam and bituminous concrete surfacing for road (general) : 7.00.01 The work covered under these specifications provides for bituminous treatment for roads consisting of providing 38 mm thick bituminous macadam and 12mm thick seal coat or bituminous concrete of thickness as specified in item in the schedule of quantities. 7.00.02 The contractor shall make at his own cost, all the arrangements for controlling the traffic during the execution of the work. All arrangements such as proper barricading of road, diversion of road if necessary, red and green flags during the day, red lights at nights shall be made by the contractor at his own cost to control and safeguard the traffic. 7.01.00 Bituminous Macadam over water bound Macadam : 7.01.01 Preparation of existing water bound macadam surface : a) The existing water bound macadam surface shall be brushed, cleaned properly with wire brushes and coir brooms, so as to free from all loose materials, murrum, earth, silt and caked mud etc. The surface shall then be dusted clean with gunny bags etc. if during the process of cleaning the sub grade (water abound macadam), soft spots and packets, hollows etc. are found, such spots/pockets will be filled with approved precoated bituminous chips, consolidated and finished to proper level, rolled with power roller if necessary. The potholes shall be excavated properly in a rectangular or rhomboidal shape with vertical edges. The bottom and sides shall be cleaned as stated above. The sides and bottom shall then be thoroughly painted with heated 30/40 penetration bitumen. The pot holes shall thereafter be filled with premixed bituminous chips so that after thorough tamping and rolling, the surface is flush with surrounding road surface all as directed by the Owner. It shall be the responsibility of the contractor to ensure that the Subgrade is even and is finished to camber and slope as shown on the drgs. or as directed by the Consultant. b) The surface of the Subgrade shall be checked for its trenches by means of the scratch template resting on side forms having scratch points placed at not less than 200mm. apart and set to the exact profile of the base course. The template shall be drawn along the forms at right angles to the road. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 146 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 c) Unevenness of the surfaces as indicated by the scratch points shall not exceed 10mm in 30m. The area of depression shall then be painted or sprayed with 30/40 penetration bitumen at the rate of 0.75 kg per sqm and the levelling course applied by hand or machine to grade and chamer and rolled. If the depressions are deeper than 50mm, the levelling course shall be applied in two or more layers and rolled as directed by the Consultant. d) The prepared surface shall be closed to traffic and maintained fully clean and no asphalting work shall be started unless this prepared surface is approved by the Consultant. 7.01.02 MATERIALS Representative samples of materials proposed to be used shall be submit ted to the Owner and got approved. No material shall be used unless it is approved by the Consultant. 7.01.03 HOT MIXED HOT LAID BITUMINOUS MACADAM: a) Coarse Aggregate: i) It shall consist of crushed hard trap stone metal, free crom coatings of clay, silt and any objectionable material. Metal brought by contractor for different items of work shall strictly conform to I R C specifications in all respects. The aggregate shall be obtained by crushing approved stones of specified type in mechanical crusher and shall be hard, close grained, sound trap stone metal, free from decay and weathering and obtained from approved quarries. ii) Metal shall be collected in stacks on level ground and neatly stacked at site of mixing. The metal shall be free from all earth, rubbish, vegetation and other foreign matter and graded before stacking and closely packed in stacks. iii) Tests considered necessary shall be carried out in an approved laboratory when the Owner considers the quality to be doubtful or there is dispute about the quality. The cost of testing shall be borne by the contractor. iv) Aggregate grading : The requirements of base course shall be as under: B.S. Sieve Designation 32 mm (about 1.25”) 20 mm (about ¾”) 12 mm (about ½”) 6 mm (about ¼”) No. 10 No. 200 Equivalent I S Sieves 40MM (1.5”) 20 mm 12.5 mm 6.3 mm 1.7 mm 75 micron Passing percentage 100 50 – 100 30 – 60 18 – 30 10 – 20 0–5 Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 147 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 v) The aggregate/chips shall be entirely dry at the time of mixing. b) Bitumen : Bitumen to be used shall conform to I.S. 73.1992 for paving bitumen, with 30/40 penetration and shall be from approved manufacturers.The contractor on demand by the Consultant, obtain and furnish a laboratory test certificate to the effect that the material conforming to the requirement of the specified grade, to the satisfaction of the Owner. Bitumen (30/40 penetration) content 3.7% to 4.7% by weight of the total mix, shall be used in the mixture. c) Tack Coat : Bitumen of the same grade as that used for premix shall be heated to a temperature of 1630 C to 1770C (3250 F to 3500 F) in a bitumen boiler and the hot bitumen shall be applied evenly to the thoroughly cleaned and prepared road surface (as specified here-in-before)@ 7.5 kg per 10 sqm leaving no part of the surface unpainted. Application shall be done by a mechanical pressure sprayer or if permitted, by perforated pouring cans. The tack coat shall be applied just before the macadam is laid. Application of tack coat shall be only slightly in advance of laying premixed chips. In case of surface already asphalted, application of tack coat is not necessary. d) Premixing Chips : i) The bitumen shall be heated to 1630 C to 1770 C (3250 F to 3500 F) in boiler The aggregate of the approved grading or as decided by the preliminary shall be dried and heated in an aggregate drier to a temperature of 1490 C to 1770 C (3000 F to 3500 F) and fed into a twin shaft peddle type mixer at a temperature not less than 1490 C (about 3000 F). The bitumen, the approved aggregate and the filler shall be measured separately and accurately to the proportions in which they are to be mixed and mixed intimately till all the particles are completely coated with bitumen. Asphalt/bituminous mixing plant proposed to be used by the contractor for the preparation of Asphalt/bituminous mixing shall conform to all of the requirements of the job, which shall produce uniform mixtures of the required quality, an got approved by the Owner before mixing. ii) The temperature of the premix bituminous macadam when leaving the mixer shall not be less than 1300 C (about 2800 F) and it shall not be less than 1210 C (about 2500F) at the time of laying. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 148 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 iii) Bituminous macadam shall be transported to site of work in suitable tipping vehicle properly insulated and covered with canvas or other suitable materials to protect the mixture from weather conditions and to retain the heat. The road surface shall be suitably marked to ensure correct and uniform application. Width of macadam to be laid shall be slightly more (not exceeding 50 mm on each side) than the required carriage way as per drawing. Excess on either side shall be neatly cut after full compaction to get final width of carriage way as per drawing. The premixed bituminous macadam shall be laid by a mechanical self powdered spreader and compactor and finished to correct line, level, & final consolidation done by means of power roller not less than 10 tonne. Any irregularities shall be corrected during rolling. e) Compaction : The base bituminous macadam course shall be compacted thoroughly and evenly with 10 to 12 tonne power roller immediately after it is laid. Compacted thickness shall be as specified in schedule of quantity. 7.01.04 The surface shall be checked for correct grade during and after rolling. Any irregularities shall be corrected by adding precoated chips or removing the surplus. The disturbed surface shall be well compacted again. If necessary the roller wheel shall be coated with oil to prevent the coated chip from sticking to the wheels. Rolling shall be continued till no wheel marks are left on the surface. The speed of the roller shall be sufficiently slow to prevent any pushing under the wheels. 8.00.00 HOT MIXED HOT LAID BITUMINOUS CONCRETE WEARING COURSE (SEAL COAT) 8.01.00 Bituminous concrete : Shall consist of mixture of mineral aggregate, sand and filler, graded to fill the voids, mixed with bitumen binder to obtain the maximum stability. It shall be spread and compacted on a prepared bituminous macadam base in conformity with lines, grades and cross section shown in the drawings. The aggregate shall be preheated the temperature specified for the bitumen and the mixture shall be prepared and laid hot. 8.02.00 Coarse Aggregate : Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 149 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 8.02.01 The coarse aggregate brought by contractor shall be I.R.C. hard black trap, crushed in mechanical crushers and shall be clean, strong, tough, dense, close grained, angular but not flaky, and free from soft, decayed, weathered portion, coating of dust, dirt or other objectionable matter. Maximum size of the aggregate shall be suitable for the thickness of the seal coat (12mm/15mm or as specified). 8.02.02 The aggregate grading composition and characteristics of surface (wearing course mix) shall conform to standard code of practice. The mix shall satisfy the following requirements: Bitumen: 7.25 (+/-) 0.25% by weight of total mix. Voids of air in total mix 2% by weight of mix and 4% by volume Specific gravity Marshall stability Flow Water absorption Not less than 2.3 453.6 kg (1000 lb) minimum 1020 0.50% 8.03.00 Fine Aggregate : The fine aggregate shall be clean, natural , river bank or pit sand or quarry sand produced in a crushing plant and satisfying the requirement of the grading of aggregate for the bituminous concrete as stated above or as determined by the preliminary tests. 8.04.00 Filler : The filler shall be dry and clean lime stone powder hydrated lime having calcium oxide content of not less than 60% both passing B S sieve No.8. It shall be free from lumps and loosely bonded aggregation. When tested by laboratory sieves. 100% shall pass through B S sieve No. 14, 80% shall pass through B S sieve No.8 . Fillers shall be added to the aggregate to give the above grading determined by preliminary tests. 8.05.00 Bitumen : Bitumen shall be of 30/40 penetration or such other grade specified by the Owner and shall conform IS 73-1961The contrcator shall indicate the exact grading, bitumen content, voids, specific gravity etc which they propose to adopt for type to treatment offered by them. 8.06.00 Preparation of Base : Dirt, dust and other foreign materials if accumulated shall be cleared off leaving the surface entirely clean. The prepared surface shall be closed to traffic and so maintained fully clean till the seal coat is applied. 8.07.00 Mixing and Laying Wearing Course : Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 150 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 8.07.01 Grade 30/40 bitumen shall be heated to a temperature of 1630 C to 1770 C (3250 F to 3500 F) in a boiler. The aggregate of the suitable approved grading or as decided by preliminary tests, shall be dried and heated in an aggregate drier to a temperature of 1490 C to 1770 C (3000 F to 3500 F) and fed into a twin shaft peddle type mixer at a temperature not less than 1490 C (3000 F). The bitumen, the aggregate and the filler shall be measured separately and accurately to the proportions in which they are to be mixed and mixed intimately till all the particles are completely coated with bitumen. The quantities of aggregate, bitumen and the filler shall be such as to obtain the percentage of each as specified above or decided after tests. Continues batching and mixing plant shall be used. Asphalt/bituminous mixing plant proposed to be used by the contractor for the preparation of asphalt/bituminous mixes shall conform to all of the requirements of the job, which shall produce uniform mixtures of the required quality. 8.07.02 The temperature of bituminous concrete when leaving the mixer shall not be less than 1380 C (2800F) and it shall not be less than 1210 C (2500 F) at the time of laying. 8.07.03 The bituminous concrete shall be transported to the site of work in suitable tipping vehicles properly insulated and covered with canvas or other suitable materials to protect the mixture from weather conditions and to retain the heat. 8.07.04 The mixture shall be spread with mechanical self powered spreader. The bituminous concrete shall be laid to the specified line, curve, grade camber Any irregularities shall be corrected immediately before rolling is started. Before laying the mixture, the faces of the joints shall be painted with a uniform coating of hot bitumen. The bituminous concrete shall be laid to such loose depth as to give a compacted layer of specified thickness as per item in the schedule of quantities. 8.08.00 Compaction : The bituminous concrete layers shall then be allowed to cool sufficiently such that it does not spread under wheel load of 10/12 tonne power roller. The compaction shall be done by the roller till no wheel mark are left on the surface and no further compaction is possible. The road shall be opened to traffic on cooling of the concrete to the atmospheric temperature or after a lapse of 24 to 40 hr after laying. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 151 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 9.00.00 GENERAL REQUIREMENTS FOR BITUMEN MACADAM & SEAL COAT 9.01.00 Testing : The contractor shall have a well equipped testing laboratory with a competent laboratory staff. Daily test (not less than two specimen per day) shall be made by them on the bituminous mixture produced to ensure compliance with these specification and copy of the test results duly signed by the competent authority shall be submitted to Owner for record. Tests shall include water absorption, stability, filler content etc. The contractor shall give all facilities at all items to the Owner or his representative to inspect the work or testing done by him 9.02.00 Weighing : Each lorry leaving the plant must be weighed on a weigh bridge in the presence of the representative of the Owner and a challan must be issued along with the lorry in duplicate showing the weight of the material loaded in the lorry. As and when required, the said lorries shall also be weighed at the Owners weigh bridge or any other weigh bridge approved by the Owner to check the tonnage of the material stated on the challans. In case of short fall, the same shall be made good by the contractor without extra cost. 9.03.00 Testing Surface : The completed surface when ready for acceptance shall be thoroughly compacted, smooth, true to line, grade, camber and free from irregularities when tested by means of a straight edge of 3m long, laid on the finished surface parallel with the centre line of the road, the surface shall in no place vary more than 6mm from the working edge. 9.04.00 Maintenance : It will be binding on the contractor to maintain the road free of cost for a period of 5 (five) years from the date of completion of the work. Security deposit will be released as per clause 17 of general conditions of contract against a guarantee bond for the maintenance period of five years against the following defects. 9.05.00 The defects in the bituminous paving which the contractor may be called upon to rectify are of the following type a) Deformation of bituminous pavement resulting in waves or ruts b) Cracking of bituminous pavement resulting in admission of water to the subgrade and the deterioration of the bituminous pavement adjoining the cracks. c) Disintegration/Revealing of bitumen pavement resulting in the formation of pot holes. d) Polishing of the bitumen pavement under traffic resulting in a surface on which the vehicles are liable to skid. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 152 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 9.06.00 Defects in areas in bitumen pavement under guarantee shall, when they exceed the limits specified below, be remedied immediately by the contractor. The limiting valves of the defects shall be the following a) Deformation : 25mm in 3 m b) Cracks : 1500 mm in lengths and 3mm in width c) Disintegrated revealed patches : 2.00 sqm and/ or 12mm in depth. 10.00.00 IS / IRC CODES IRC:37 Guidelines for design of flexible pavements IRC:73 Geometric design of roads IS – 73 Paving Bitumen IS – 702 Industrial Bitumen IS – 1201 Methods of testing tar and Bituminous materials Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 153 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 TECHNICAL SPEC. FOR WOODEN WORK, CARPENTRY & JOINERY 1.00.00 SCOPE This shall include supply, fitting and fixing of timber frames to doors and windows with M.S. Holdiasts, panelled or flush doors, windows, shutters, etc. as shown in drawings, including a prime coat of approved paint, varnish or fixing of plastic laminate where called for. This shall also include the supply and fixing of all hardware and fixtures. 2.00.00 2.01.00 CODES AND STANDARDS All applicable standards, acts and codes of practice referred to shall be the latest editions including all applicable official amendments and revisions. A complete set of all these documents shall generally be available at site, with the Contractor. In case of conflict between this specification and those (IS Standards, Codes etc.) referred to in clause 2.03.00 the former shall prevail. Some of the applicable Indian standards, Codes, etc. are referred to here below: 2.02.00 2.03.00 IS: 204 (Part 1991 1) IS: 204 (Part 1992 2) IS: 205 1992 IS: 206 1992 IS: 207 1964 IS: 208 1996 IS: 281 1991 IS: 287 1993 IS: 303 IS: 362 IS: 363 IS: 364 IS: 401 IS: 451 IS: 452 IS: 453 IS: 723 1989 1991 1993 1993 2001 1999 1973 1993 1972 IS: 729 1979 Specification for Tower bolts- ferrous metals ; Part – 1992 : Non ferrous metals) Specification for Tower bolts- Non ferrous metals) Specification for Non-ferreus metal butt hinges Specification for Tee and strap binges Specification for Gate and shutter hooks and eyes Specification for Door handles Specification for Mild steel sliding door bolts for use with padlocks. Recommendation for maximum permissible moisture contents of timber used for different purposes. Specification for Plywood for general purpose Specification for Parliament hinges Specification for Hasps and staples Fanlight catch Code of practice for preservation of timber Technical supply condition for wood screws Specification for Door springs, rail-tail type Specification for Double acting spring hinges Specification for Steel counter sunk head wire nails Specification for Drawer locks, cup board locks, and box locks Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 154 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: IS: 848 1974 IS: 851 1978 IS: 852 1994 IS: 1019 IS: 1141 IS: 1200 (Pt. XIV) IS: 1200 (Pt. XXI) IS: 1328 IS: 1341 IS: 1378 IS: 1658 IS: 1659 IS: 1823 IS: 1868 IS: 1911 IS : 2191 (Part 1) 1974 1993 1984 1973 1996 1992 1987 1977 1990 1980 1996 1967 1983 IS : 2191 1983 (Part 2) IS: 2202 (Part 1999 1) IS: 2202 (Part 1983 2 IS: 2209 1976 IS: 2380 1977 (parts 1 to 21) IS: 2380 (Part 1981 22) IS: 2380 (Part 1981 23) IS: 2681 1993 10000011 / HB / 11094 Specification for Synthetic resin adhesives for plywood (Phenolic & Aminoplastic) Specification for Synthetic resin adhesive for construction work (non structural ) in wood Specifications for animal glue for general wood working purposes. Specification for Rim latches Code of practice for seasoning of timber Method of measurement of Building and Civil Engineering works - Glazing Method of measurement of Building and Civil Engineering works- Wood work and joinery Specification for Veneered decorative plywood Specification for Steel Butt hinges Specification for Oxidized copper finishes Specification for Fiber hard board Specification for Block boards Specification for Floor door stoppers Specification for Anodic coating on Aluminium Schedule of unit weights of building materials Specification for wooden flush door shutters (cellular & hollow core type) – plywood face panels Specification for wooden flush door shutters (cellular & hollow core type) - Particle board face panels and hard board Specification for wooden flush door shuters (solid core type) – plywood face panels Specification for wooden flush door shuters (solid core type) – Particle board face panels and hard board Specification for Mortise locks (vertical type) Method of test for wood particle board and boards from lignocellulosic materials Method of test for wood particle board and boards from lignocellulosic materials – Determination of surface gulability Method of test for wood particle board and boards from lignocellulosic materials – Vibration test for particle boards Non ferrous metal sliding door bolts (aldrops) for use with pad locks Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 155 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: IS: 2835 IS: 3087 IS: 3097 10000011 / HB / 11094 1987 Flat transparent sheet glass (3rd Revision). 1985 Specification for wood particle board (medium density) for general engineering purpose 1980 Specification for Veneered particle boards (1st Revision) 1980 Method of test for vulcanized rubbers Hardness IS: 3400-(Pt.IV) 1987 Method of test for vulcanized rubbers Accelerated aging IS: 3400-(Pt.IX) 1978 Method of test for vulcanized rubbers Relative density and density IS: 3564 1986 Specification for Door closers (Hydraulically regulated) IS: 3618 1966 Phosphate treatment of iron and steel for protection against corrosion IS: 3813 1967 Specification for ‘C’ hooks for use with swivels IS: 3818 1992 Specification for Continuous (Piano) hinges IS: 3847 1992 Specification for Mortise night latches IS: 4020 (Part 1 to 16) 1998 Methods of tests for wooden flush Doors (Type tests) IS: 4021 1995 Specification for Timber door, window and ventilator frames IS: 4827 1983 Electroplated coating of nickel and chromium on copper and copper alloys IS: 4948 2002 Specification for Welded steel wire fabric for general use. IS: 4992 1975 Specification for Door Handles for mortise locks (vertical type) IS: 5187 1972 Specification for Flush bolts IS: 5523 1983 Method of testing anodic coating on aluminium & its alloys. IS: 5930 1970 Specification for Mortise latch (vertical types) IS: 6318 1971 Specification for Plastic window stays & fasteners IS: 6607 1972 Specification for Rebated mortise locks (vertical type) IS: 6760 1972 Specification for Slotted countersunk head wood screws IS: 7196 1974 Specification for Hold fasts IS: 7197 1974 Specification for Double action floor springs (without oil check) for heavy doors IS: 7534 1985 Specification for Mild steel bolts with holes for padlocks IS: 3400-(Pt.II) Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 156 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 3.00.00 3.01.00 3.01.01 MATERIALS Timber Unless otherwise specified, all timber shall be best quality well seasoned Grade I teakwood free from large or loose knots, cracks or other defects. Where specified, timber shall be treated with approved wood preservative before use. Before starting the carpenter’s work, the Contractor shall have the rough timber approved by the Engineer. Size of doors and windows frame shall be 100 x 60mm.3.02.00 Laminated Plastic Sheets 3.02.01 All laminated plastic sheets shall be minimum 1.5 mm thick and shall be ‘Formica’, ‘Decolam’ or approved equivalent make. The colour, pattern, finish and texture shall be approved by the Engineer and the bulk supply procured in sheet sizes which will ensure the least number of joints in one surface. Flush doors Flush door shall be solid core doors with commercial or decorative faces and hardwood edges. It shall have 3 layer flat pressed teak wood particle board (Commercial veneer) bonded with BWP type phenol formaldehyde conforming to lS:848 and total thickness of shall be 35 mm. The board core shall conform to lS:3087 type - 1. The door shall be given 35 x 12 mm teak wood beading all around as per drawings and as directed by the Engineer. 3.03.00 3.03.01 3.04.00 Fittings and Fixtures 3.04.01 Fixtures and fittings for doors, windows, furniture etc. shall be as shown on drawing and as directed by the Engineer. These shall be of heavy type, best quality and from approved manufacturer. 4.00.00 JOINERY 4.01.00 General 4.01.01 The work shall be done by skilled carpenters as per details shown on drawings or as instructed by the Engineer. Framing timber and other work shall be closed fitting with proper wood joinery, accurately set to required lines or levels and rigidly secured in place. 4.01.02 The surface of frames etc. which will come in contact with masonry after fixing, shall be given two coats of approved paint before fixing. Mastic caulking shall be done after fixing external door and window frames. Special care shall be taken to match the grain of timber of plywood which will be subsequently polished. Screwing or nailing will not be permitted to the edge plywood or chip board sheets. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 157 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 4.01.03 Fixing of frames and partitions shall generally be with 25 mm x 6 mm x 225 mm long M.S. Hold fasts at bifurcated end and grouted with 1:2:4 cement concrete, The gap between masonry and external door and window frame shall be caulked with mastic. M.S. grills or guard bars shall be provided to windows where called for in the specification. 4.02.00 Finish 4.02.01 All carpentry work after finishing shall be sand papered smooth, A prime coat of paint shall be given after inspection by the Engineer to all surfaces other than those which shall be subsequently polished or covered with laminated plastic sheet. 4.03.00 Surface Treatment 4.03.01 When shown on drawings decorative ply or laminated plastic sheets shall be bonded under pressure to the surface to be finished. The adhesive used shall be of a approved brand and brought to site in sealed containers. The rate of application and the length of time for which the pressure is to be applied shall be as per the manufacturer’s instructions. The edge of sheets shall be protected by teak lipping or beveled as shown on drawings. 4.04.00 Preservative 4.04.01 Where required as per the drawings or by the Engineer, timber shall be treated with specified preservative strictly in accordance with the manufactuer’s instructions and to the satisfaction of the Engineer. 05.00.00 FITTINGS AND FIXTURES : 5.00.01 The work covered under these specifications consist of supplying different types of fittings and fixtures required for teak wood door shutters etc complete in strict accordance with these specifications and drawings/samples approved. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 158 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 05.00.02 All fittings and fixtures shall be of heavy quality brass anodised aluminium, iron oxidised (M.S) or as specified. These shall be well made, reasonably smooth and free from sharp edges, corners, flaws and other defects. Screws holes shall be counter sunk to suit the heads of the specified screws. All hinges pins shall be of steel for brass hinges and aluminium alloy NR-6 or steel pins for aluminium hinges with nylon washers or as specified. All riveted heads pertaining to hinge pins shall be well formed Screws supplied for fittings shall be of the same metal and finish as the fittings. However brass cadmium plated / chromium plated screws shall be supplied with aluminium fittings. Samples of each fixture / fitting shall be furnished by the contractor for the approval of the Engineer-in-Charge and got approved from him before placing bulk order for purchase. The fittings and fixtures to be incorporated in the work shall be strictly according to the approved sample. Fittings shall be fixed in proper position as shown in the drawing and as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. These shall be truly vertical or horizontal as the case may be. Screws shall be driven home with a screws driver and not hammered in. Recess shall be cut to the exact size and depth of fittings and fixtures & shall be done in a workman like manner and any damages (one either to fittings and fixtures or the shutter frames etc.) should be rectified by the contractor at his own cost. 05.01.0 BUTT HINGES : 05.01.01 Brass and aluminium hinges shall be manufactured from the extruded sections and shall be free from cracks and other defects. M.S. butt hinges shall be cranked and manufactured from M.S. Sheets. All butt hinges conform to latest I.S. specifications. The size of butt hinges shall be taken as the length of the hinge. Width of the hinge shall be measured from the centre line of hinge pin to end of flange. 05.02.00 PARLIAMENTARY HINGES : 05.02.01 These shall be manufactured from extruded section for brass and aluminium from M.S. sheets for iron oxidised and shall be free from cracks and other defects. The size of the parliamentary hinges shall be taken as the width between open flanges, while the depth shall be as specified. 05.03.00 PIANO HINGES : 05.03.01 These shall be conformed I.S. specifications for Piano ninges and shall be either brass oxidised, aluminium anodised, iron oxidised (M.S.) or as specified. Piano hinges shall be fixed in the entire length of the cupboard shutters in a single piece. No joints are allowed. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 159 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 05.04.00 TOWER BOLTS : 05.04.01 The tower bolts shall be of the following types : a) M.S. semi barrel tower bolt with m.s. sheet pressed barrel and G.I. bolt or with m.s. barrel and m.s. sheet bolt. b) Oxikdised brass barrel tower bolt with brass sheet barrel and rolled or drawn brass bolt. c) Anodised aluminium tower bolt with barrel and bolt of extruded sections of aluminium alloy. In case of M.S. tower bolt plates and straps after assembly shall be firmly revetted or spot welded properly. The knobs of brass tower bolts shall be cast and the bolt fixed into the knob firmly as per I.S. specifications. The tower bolt shall be finished to correct shape and pattern so as to have a smooth action. Wherever specified, aluminium barrel tower bolts shall be manufactured from extruded sections of barrel and bolts. Knobs shall be properly screwed to the bolt and reveted at the back. The size of the tower bolt shall be taken as the length of barrel without top socker. 5.04.02 5.04.03 5.04.04 5.05.00 FLUSH BOLTS : 5.05.01 These shall be cast brass and shall be finished chromium plated / oxidised, as specified. The size of the flush bolt shall be taken as the length of the flush plate without top socket. 5.06.00 ALDROPS : 5.06.01 These shall be oxidised brass or anodised aluminium, iron oxidised or as specified and shall be capable of smooth sliding action and shall be as per I.S. 2681-1964. Brass sliding door bolt (aldrop) shall be made from rolled brass. The hasp shall be of cast brass and screwed to the bolt in a workman like manner. Alternatively the hasp and the bolt may be in one piece. Bolts shall be finished to shape and threaded with worth standard and provided with round brass washers and nuts of square or hexagonal shape. All components shall be smooth and polished. The leading dimensions of aldrop shall be as the length of the bolt and specified diameter. DOOR HANDLES – BOW / PLATE HANDLES : 5.07.00 5.07.01 These shall be of cast brass of specified size, shape and pattern as approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. Brass handles shall be finished bright, chromium plated or oxidised as specified. Aluminium or iron oxidised (m.s) handles shall be of specified size, shape and pattern. The size of the handle is taken as the inside grip of the handle. In case of iron oxidised handles, the same shall be manufactured from m.s. sheet pressed into oval section as per I.S. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 160 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 5.08.00 MORTISE LOCK : 5.08.01 Mortise lock with latches and a pair of level handles shall be 6 levers, with zinc alloy pressure die cast / brass or as specified body of approved quality, and shall be right or left handed as specified. The pair of handles shall be either brass chromium plated or anodixed aluminium of approved shape and pattern or as specified. It shall be of the best Indian make of approved quality. The size of the lock shall be determined by its length. The lock for single leaf door shall have plain face and that for double leaf door a rebated face. Level handles with springs shall be mounted on plates and shall be of approved quality, anodised aluminium or as specified. HYDRAULIC DOOR CLOSER : 5.09.00 5.09.01 Hydraulic door closer shall be of approved quality and make. The operation of the Hydraulic door closer shall be very smooth. 5.09.02 This should be of H.D.-66 for external / main doors and elegant – 63 for all internal doors. The overall height should not be more than 170 mm. for H.D.-66 and 160 mm. for elegant-63 base shall be 110 x 60 mm. for H.D.-66 and 100 x 55 mm. for elegant - –3 weighing not less than 4.5 kg. For H.D. – 66 and 4 kg. For elegant – 63. Speed of the Hydraulic door closer shall be adjustable and latch closing also shall be adjustable type. Suspension and lubrication of door closer shall be in perfect line and level. 5.10.00 The contractor shall provide for all the incidentals required for fixing these fixtures and fittings such as cadmium plated screws etc. Fittings and fixtures shall be fixed securely in a workman like manner all as directed by the Engineer-in-Charge. Any of the fixture damaged during the fixing shall be removed and new one fixed in their place and the surface of joinery made good where affected, at his own expense. Mortise plates shall be used over holes where the bolts enter in the wood work. Metal sockets shall be provided to all bolts where the shoot enter brick, stone, concrete etc. The incidental fixtures like mortise plates, metal sockets, screws etc. shall not be paid for separately 6.00.00 Acceptance Criteria 6.01.00 Door and Window Frames 6.01.01 All frames shall be square and flat at the time of delivery and shall be checked for dimensions and corner angles. After fixing they shall be in a true vertical plane. All external door and window frames shall be caulked with mastic. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page161 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6.02.00 Door and Window Shutters 6.02.01 These shall be of proper size, shape and design and free of warps. When fixed to frames these shall operate smoothly without jamming and all latching or locking devices shall engage properly without under pressure. 6.03.00 Door and window fittings 6.03.01 One set of all approved door and window fittings shall be submitted to the Consultant/Owner for reference and comparisons with the fittings being provided. TECHNICAL SPEC FOR ALUMINIUM WORKS 1.00.00 1.01.00 SCOPE The work in general shall consist of fabrication, supplying, erecting and installing of all aluminum doors, windows, ventilators, louvers, glazed partitions etc. as stipulated here or elsewhere in these specifications with all materials complete including labour and equipment. 2.00.00 GENERAL: 2.01.00 The contractor shall submit 6 copies of shop drawing covering all types of work under this specification before manufacture. The drawing shall show all dimensions, member designations details of construction, installation, relating to adjoining and related work etc The work shall be carried out as per approved shop drawings relevant detailed approved shop drawings. 2.02.00 The contractor shall submit 6 copies of shop drawings covering all type/details of work and generally shown in architectural drawings and envisaged under these specifications before manufacture. The drawings shall show all dimensions details of constructions, installation of fixtures and relation to adjoining and related works. No fabrication work shall be undertaken prior to obtaining approval of the shop drawings from the Consultant/Owner/Owner/Owner. The Contractor shall intimate at the time of tendering the type of sections he proposes to use on the works. 3.00.00 CODES AND STANDARDS 3.01.00 All applicable standards, acts and codes of practice referred to shall be the latest editions including all applicable official amendments and revisions. A complete set of all these documents shall generally be available at site, with the Contractor. 3.02.00 In case of conflict between this specification and those (IS Standards, Codes etc.) referred to in clause 3.03.00 the former shall prevail. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 162 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 3.03.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 Some of the applicable Indian standards, Codes, etc. are referred to here below: IS : 733 1983 Specifications for wrought aluminum and aluminum alloy bars, rods, sections (for general engineering purposes) IS : 1081 1960 IS : 1868 1996 Code of practice for fixing and glazing of metal (steel and aluminum) doors, windows & ventilators Specifications for anodised coatings on aluminum and its alloys 4.00.00 MATERIALS 4.01.00 Aluminum alloy for extruded sections for the above work shall correspond to I.S 733 (extruded sections shall conform to IS Designation HE 9 – WP. Hollow sections shall conform to IS Designation HV9-WP) and shall be anodised before incorporating in the work. The door, window, ventilator, glazing framework, beadings, hinges, pegstays, stiles, mullions, beadings, transoms and handles etc shall be of aluminum anodised section as shown in detailed approved drawings. All aluminum sections shall be from approved reputed manufacturer. 4.02.00 The contractors can also propose nearest alternative section they manufacture/posses without changing the elevation, structural stability and functional requirement. Consultant/Owner/Owner/Owner reserves the right to accept the alternative section or otherwise. The sections shall be structurally suitable to withstand all the loads; the members have to sustain. 4.03.00 Counter sunk screws, nuts, bolts, washers, rivers and other miscellaneous fastenings devices shall be of approved brass cadmium plated or stainless as specified in the approved drawing. Each door leaf shall be prepared to receive glazed panel of required thickness. 4.04.00 Glazing shall be done with neoprene dry set glazing gasket (of best quality and approved make) with snap – in – beveled white anodised matt finish aluminium metal glazing stops inside and outside, Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 163 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 5.00.00 FABRICATION: 5.01.00 Doors 5.01.01 The frames shall be manufactured square and flat, the corners of the frame being fabricated to true right angle. All the fixed, sliding and opening frames shall be constructed of sections, which have been to length, mitred, welded and mechanically fixed at the corners. Where hollow sections are used with welded joints, argon-arc welding or flash butt welding shall be employed (Gas welding or brazing not to be done). In case welded joints are used, anodising shall be done after fabrication as a whole. All welding shall be on unexposed sides in order to prevent pitting / discoloration of other surface imperfections after fixing etc. 5.01.02 5.01.03 Necessary allowance shall be made while manufacturing the aluminum door entrances, wall spans and glazing for receiving plaster. Field fabrication of frames shall be done only if permitted by Consultant/Owner/Owner/Owner. 5.01.04 A thick layer of clear transparent lacquer based on methacrylates or cellulose butyrate shall be applied on the finished sections of the aluminum work by the contractor to protect the surfaces from wet cement, lime, dirt, dust etc during the construction activities. The size for door, window or ventilator frames shall not vary by more than (+/-) 1.5 mm. 5.01.05 All aluminum surfaces in contact with masonry or concrete shall be given a thick coat of bitumastic paint. After fabrication, aluminum sections shall be protected from construction hazards that may damage their appearance or finish. All exposed surfaces of aluminum door entrance shall be protected by masking tape during transshipment and erection 5.02.00 Windows, Ventilators and glazing 5.02.01 The frames shall be manufactured square and flat. The corners of the frames shall be fabricated to true right angles. All the fixed, sliding, openable frames shall be constructed from sections, which have been cut to length, mitred and mechanically jointed or welded at the corners. 5.02.02 Where hollow sections are used with welded joints, argon are welding or flash butt welding shall be employed (Gas welding or brazing not to be done). Subdividing bars of units shall be tennoned and rivetted into the frames. In case welded joints are used, all welding shall be on unexposed sides in order to prevent pitting, discoloration and other surface imperfections after finishing. 5.02.03 The dimensions shown in the drawing are overall heights and widths to the outside of frames of aluminum windows. The side-hung shutters shall have projected friction type hinges of aluminum alloy. Concealed projected hinges having structural stability and of good quality will also be considered only after the inspection of the sample submitted by the Contractor Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 164 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 5.02.04 The necessary pegstays, handles, window fasteners etc shall be of aluminum. The handle shall be mounted on a handle plate riveted to the opening frame. The pegstays shall be 300 mm. Long or as required complete with peg and locking bracket and shall have holes for keeping the shutter open in three different positions. Field fabrication of frames shall be done only if permitted by consultant/Owner/Owner/Owner. 5.02.05 The complete fabricated assembly shall be anodised in approved satin finish with minimum film thickness of 0.015 mm for the entire surface. A thick layer of clear transparent lacquer based on methacrylate or cellulose butyrate shall be applied on the finished sections of the aluminum windows etc. by the supplier to protect the surfaces from wet cement, lime, dirt, dust etc during the installation. The lacquer coating shall be removed after installation is complete, if approved by the Consultant/Owner/Owner/Owner and all sections of the windows shall be protected by PVC film covering 6.00.00 HARDWARE: 6.01.00 All sections and hardware shall have anodic film and cover a minimum thickness of 0.015 mm 6.02.00 All doors shall have offset pivots; double action (180 minimum swing) floor springs with oil check boxes of approved manufacture. All doors shall have 4 lever concealed brass body mortise lock without handles as per manufactures design, with concealed flush C.P. brass tower bolts provided at suitable locations. All doors shall have push plates of design shown in the approved drawing as described in the schedule of quantities. All entrances shall be without thresholds. 6.03.00 All cutouts, recess, mortising or milling and operations required for fixing the hardware shall be accurately made reinforced with pacing plate as required to ensure adequate strength of the connection. 6.04.00 All the hardware accessories shall be of best-approved type and of anodised finish same as of rate frames and other sections. Each lock shall be supplied with two stainless steel keys and each key shall be with number stamped thereon according to the number on doors so installed. 6.05.00 All hardware shall be free from defects which may affect the appearance and serviceability. All hardware shall be fixed after obtaining the prior approval of the Engineer-in-charge. 6.06.00 Approved samples of hardware shall be kept in the custody of the Engineer-in-charge. Working and moving parts of lock sets shall be accurately fitted to smooth, close bearings and shall be free from rattle. 0 Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page165 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6.07.00 The floor springs shall be of heavy-duty type and should allow door operation smoothly. 6.08.00 The contractor shall furnish a guarantee for all finishing and quality of hardware covered under this section and which shall remain free from defects of any kind, either materials and / or workmanship for a period of one year (unless otherwise specified) from the date of competition/handling over of work. 6.09.00 The contractor shall repair of replace any and all defective work and damage caused, at any time or times during that period within 3 days from the written notice. This shall be done without any extra cost to the Owner. 7.00.00 FIXING 7.01.00 The frames shall be accurately fixed in the flooring/brick masonry or R.C.C works. The fixing of the frame shall be done with cadmium plated brass counter sunk screws driven on to the teak wood rough ground, or fixed to the wall with hodfasts as directed by the Consultant/Owner/Owner/Owner, and as shown in approved drawings. 7.02.00 All aluminum works shall be fixed in position as per relevant Indian Standard Specifications and code of practice for fixing and glazing of aluminum work. Joints between metal and masonry shall be neatly painted with matching cement and excess materials shall be removed. 7.03.00 Fixing of aluminum door entrances, hardware etc shall be done in best workmanship like manner true to line, level, plane, plumb etc and all as directed by the Consultant/Owner/Owner/Owner. Breaking of floor for providing floor springs and restoration of the floor finishes to the original specification and finishes and minor additions and alternations to the openings shall be deemed to have been included in the quoted rates. 7.04.00 All aluminum windows shall be fixed in position as per IS 1081. All joints between metal and masonry / rough ground wooden frame shall be fully caulked with music or ploysulphidc compound in order to ensure watertight joints. Joints shall be neatly painted with matching cement and excess materials shall be removed. Hardware shall be fixed in workman like manner all as directed by the Consultant/Owner/Owner/Owner. 7.00.00 HANDLING AND STORAGE All aluminum doors, windows, etc. shall be packed and crated properly before dispatch, to ensure that there will be no damage to the fabricated materials. Loading into wagons and trucks shall be done with all care to ensure safe arrival of materials at site in undamaged condition. All doors, windows etc. shall be stored under cover in a way to prevent damage or distortion. ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA 8.00.00 9.01.00 For Fabricated Items a) Overall dimension shall be within + 1.5 mm of the size b) Mullions, transoms etc. shall be in one length and permissible deviations from straightness shall be limited to n 1.5 mm from the axis of the member. c) Door and window shutters shall operate without jamming. The clearance at head and jamb for door shutters shall not exceed 1.5 mm. For double leaf doors, the gap at the meeting of stiles shall not be more than 1.5mm. d) Door leaves shall be undercut wherever required. e) Doors, windows, frames etc. shall be on a true plane, free from warp or buckle. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 166 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 f) All welds shall be dressed flush on exposed and contact surfaces. g) Correctness of location and smoothness of operations of all shop installed hardware and fixtures. h) Provision for hardware and fixtures to be installed at site. i) Glazing clips, fixing devices etc. shall be supplied in adequate Numbers j) Shop coats shall be properly applied. k) Glazing beads shall be cut with mitered corners. 9.02.00 For Installed Items a) Installations shall be at correct location, elevation and in general, on a true vertical plane. b) Fixing details shall be strictly as shown on drawings. c) Assembly of composite units shall be strictly as per the drawings with mastic caulking at transoms and mullions, gaskets, weather strips etc. complete. d) All frames on external walls shall be mastic caulked to prevent leakage through joint between frames and masonry. e) All openable sections shall operate smoothly without jamming. f) Locks, fasteners etc. shall engage positively. Key shall be noninterchangeable. g) Cutting to concrete or masonry shall be made good and all abrasions to shop paint shall be touched up with paint of same quality as shop paint. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 167 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 TECHNICAL SPECS FOR STEEL DOORS, WINDOWS, VENTILATORS & LOUVERS 1.00.00 SCOPE The work in general shall consist of supplying, erecting and installing of all metal doors, windows, ventilators, louvers, glazed partitions etc. as stipulated here or elsewhere in these specifications with all materials complete including labour and equipment. 2.00.00 GENERAL: 2.01.00 The contractor shall submit 6 copies of shop drawing covering all types of work under this specification before manufacture. The drawing shall show all dimensions, details of construction, installation, relating to adjoining and related work etc 3.00.00 CODES AND STANDARDS 3.01.00 All applicable standards, acts and codes of practice referred to shall be the latest editions including all applicable official amendments and revisions. A complete set of all these documents shall generally be available at site, with the Contractor. In case of conflict between this specification and those (IS Standards, Codes etc.) referred to in clause 3.03.00 the former shall prevail. 3.02.00 3.03.00 Some of the applicable Indian standards, Codes, etc. are referred to here below: IS : 1038 1983 Specifications for Steel doors, windows and ventilators IS : 1081 1960 Code of practice for fixing and glazing of metal (steel and aluminium) doors, windows & ventilators IS : 1361 1978 Specifications for Steel windows for industrial building IS: 1477 2000 Code of practice for painting ferrous metals in buildings - Pretreatment (Part 1) IS: 1477 2000 Code of practice for painting ferrous metals in (Part 2) buildings - Painting IS: 2074 1992 Specifications for ready mixed paint, air drying, red oxide zinc chrome, priming IS: 3564 1996 Specifications for hydraulically regulated door closers IS : 4351 2003 Specifications for Steel door frames IS : 7452 1990 Specifications for Hot rolled steel sections for doors, windows and ventilators Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 168of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 4.00.00 MATERIALS 4.01.00 Steel sections used for fabrication of doors, windows, etc. shall be standard rolled steel section specified in IS:1038, lS:1361 and IS:4351 or as specified in drawing. The Mild Steel sheets for frames, shutters, louvre blades etc. shall be of approved quality and of gauge mentioned in this specification. Hardware and fixtures of the best quality from approved manufacturers shall only be used. The Contractor shall specifically state the particular manufacturer’s materials he proposes to use. All hardware and fixtures shall be able to withstand repeated use. Door closers shall conform to IS:3564 and shall be suitable for doors weighing 61-80 kg unless otherwise stated. Each closer shall be guaranteed against manufaturing defect for one year and any defect found within this period shall be rectified or the closer replaced free of charge. Concealed door closes shall be either floor mounted or transom mounted, suitable for installation with metal doors. It shall conform to the performance requirements and endurance test stated in IS:3564 - Appendix A. 4.02.00 The Contractor shall submit samples of each type of hardware to the Consultant/Owner/Owner/Owner. .The approved samples shall be retained by the Consultant/Owner/Owner/Owner for comparison with bulk supply. The mastic for caulking shall be of best quality from a manufacturer approved by the Consultant/Owner/Owner/Owner. 5.00.00 FABRICATION 5.01.00 Door Frames 5.01.01 Frames shall be reinforced for door closers. They shall be mortised, reinforced, drilled and tapped for hinges, lock and bolt strikes. Flush butt welding to form a solid fused joint, so that all frames are square and flat shall be used with sections cut to required length and mitred. Rubber door silencers shall be furnished for the striking jamb. Loose “T” masonry anchors shall be provided. Frames shall finish flush with floor and adjustable floor anchors shall be supplied. Frames shall be brought to site with floor ties/weather bars installed in place. 5.02.00 Double Plate Flush Door Shutters Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 169 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 5.02.01 Door shutters shall be 45 mm thick, completely flush design and shall comprise of two sheets of 18G steel sheets, rigidly connected and reinforced inside with continuous vertical 20G stiff ners, spot welded in position at not more than 150 mm on centres. Both edges of doors shall be joined and reinforced full. height by steel channels placed immediately inside and welded to the door faces. Top and bottom of doors shall be reinforced horizontally by steel channels running full width of door. Doors shall not have more than 2.5 mm clearance at jambs and head, shall have proper level on lock stiles and rails to operate without binding, and shall be reinforced at corners to prevent sagging or twisting. Pairs or double doors shall have meeting stile edges beveled or rebated. 5.02.03 Doors shall be mortised, reinforced, drilled and tapped in shop for hinges, locks and bolts. They shall also be reinforced for closer, push-plates and other surface hardware where necessary. Any drilling and tapping required for surface hardware shall be done at site. Wherever required, provision shall be made for fixing glazing, vision panels, louvers etc. Glazing mouldings shall be of 18G mild steel or extruded aluminum sections with profiles shown in drawings and suitable for fixing 6 mm glass. Louver blades shall be V or Z shaped and made out of 16G sheets. 5.03.00 Sliding Doors 5.03.01 Sliding doors shall be either single or double plate construction as required and made out of 18 Gauge steel sheets with adequate stiffeners. The Contractor shall specify the weight of the door in his shop drawing and submit the manufacturer’s catalogue of the sliding gear he proposes to use. Where shown on the drawings the Contractor shall make provisions for openings in the door for monorail beams. Door shall close positively to exclude rain water from seeping in. Sliding doors shall withstand specified wind loads without buckling or jamming. The door shall slide freely under all ambient conditions. Steel Windows, Sashes, Ventilators etc. 5.04.00 5.04.01 These shall conform in all respects to IS:1038, lS:7452 and lS:1361 and are as shown on drawings. The details as called for in the above codes shall be applicable for coupling mullions, transom, weather bars, pivot arrangements for ventilators etc. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 170 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 5.04.02 5.04.03 5.04.05 10000011 / HB / 11094 Windows: Window shutters shall be hung on projecting hinges. One leaf of the hinges shall be welded into a slot in the outer frame and the other leaf of the hinges riveted to the opening shutters. Hinges may be of the friction type in which case the window shall not be fitted with peg stay. In case of non-friction projecting hinges, a brass or bronze three holes peg stays 300mm. Long with pegs and brackets, welded or riveted to the frame shall also be provided. Handles shall be of brass or bronze, and shall be mounted on a mild steel handle plate welded to the shutter in such a way that it should be fixed after the shutter is glazed. The handles shall have a two point nose which shall engage with brass, bronze or aluminium alloy as specified, striking plate, on the fixed frame so that it can hold the shutters in a slightly openable as well in a fast position. Top hung ventilators: These shall be fixed with plain hinges, riveted to the fixed frames or welded to it after cutting a slot in it. A peg stay 300mm long of brass or bronze with three holes, as in case of windows shall be provided. The locking bracket shall either be fitted to the fixed frame or to the ventilators. Centre Hung Ventilators: These shall be hung on two pairs of brass of lead / tin/ bronze cup pivots, riveted to the inner and outer frame of the ventilates to permit these to swing through an angle of approximately 85 deg. The opening portion of the ventilators shall be so balanced that it remains open at any desired angle under normal weather condition. 5.04.05 A bronze or brass spring catch shall be provided at the top centre of the ventilator. A brass cord pulley wheel in a mild steel or malleable iron brackets, shall be fitted with screws or welded at the sill and a cord eye shall be fixed to inner frame of ventilators to facilitate opening of ventilators. 5.05.00 All welds shall be flush butt welded to form a solid fused joint so that all frames are square and flat. Where composite unit openings are shown on drawings, the individual window units shall be jointed together with requisite transoms and mullions. All windows shall be inside glazed, fixed with metal glazing beads. All windows, ventilators, sashes shall be fixed with handles, peg stays etc. of approved make and best quality. Pressed Steel Louvers The louver blade shall be ‘Z’ shaped and made out of 18G sheets in EZ7 steel frames. The frames shall be of ISMC 100. Fabrication drawings shall be submitted by the contractor which shall also inclusive weights of the materials used and got approved from the Consultant/Owner/Owner/Owner. 5.06.00 5.07.00 5.07.01 5.08.00 Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 171 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6.00.00 6.01.00 SHOP COAT OF PAINT Unless otherwise specified in Sub-section, the shop paint for steel doors, windows, ventilators, louvers etc. shall be best quality Zinc Chromate primer paint from approved manufacturer conforming to lS:2074. All surface shall be thoroughly cleaned of rust, grease, loose mill scales and foreign matter as per IS:1477 Part-I, and given one coat of shop paint. Portions like mullions, transom etc. which will be inaccessible after assembly of units shall be given an extra coat of paint before assembly. 6.02.00 All steel doors, windows, etc. shall have one shop coat and one site coat of Zinc chromate paint (Primer) conforming to IS:2074 with a pigment to be specified by the Consultant/Owner/Owner/Owner and two coats of synthetic enamel paint of approved quality and conforming to relevant l.S. Code, unless specified otherwise in these specifications. Wherever required, all steel doors, windows, etc. shall be hot dip galvanized to give a coating weight of 460 gms to 610 gms per sq.m. One coat zinc chromate primer coat shall then be applied as shop paint. 7.00.00 HANDLING AND STORAGE All metal doors, windows, etc. shall be packed and crated properly before despatch, to ensure that there will be no damage to the fabricated materials. Loading into wagons and trucks shall be done with all care to ensure safe arrival of materials at site in undamaged condition. All metal doors, windows etc. shall be stored under cover in a way to prevent damage or distortion. 8.00.00 ASSEMBLY AND ERECTION 8.01.00 In general, the fixing of metal doors, windows ventilators, louvers, etc. shall conform to IS:1081. The Contractor shall assemble and install all steel doors, windows, sashes, fixed metal louvers, etc. including transoms and mullions for composite units in respective places keeping proper lines and levels, and in approved workmanlike manner, to give trouble free and leak-proof installation. If required by the Consultant/Owner/Owner/Owner, the installation shall have to be carried out under the supervision of the manufacturer’s staff. The contractor shall take every precaution against damage of the components during installation. Necessary holes chases etc. required for fixing shall be made by the contractor and made good again as per original, after installation. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 172 of 219 172 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 8.02.00 After installation of metal doors, windows, etc. all abrasions to shop-coat of paint shall be retouched and made good with the same quality of paint used in shop-coat. 8.03.00 All coupling mullions, transoms, frames. etc. in contact with unpainted steel and other members, shall be well embedded in mastic. The contractor shall bring to the site the mastic cement in original sealed containers of manufacturer and shall apply it as per the instructions. Door shutters, partitions, hardware fixtures etc. shall be fixed only after major equipments have been installed in rooms. Wherever required, nylon cords of approved quality shall be supplied alongwith pivoted sashes and shall be of adequate length to terminate one meter from the floor. Loose ends of cords shall end in metal or plastic pull as approved by the Consultant/Owner/Owner/Owner. 8.04.00 9.00.00 ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA 9.01.00 For Fabricated Items a) Overall dimension shall be within + 1.5 mm of the size b) Mullions, transoms etc. shall be in one length and permissible deviations from straightness shall be limited to n 1.5 mm from the axis of the member. c) Door and window shutters shall operate without jamming. The clearance at head and jamb for door shutters shall not exceed 1.5 mm. For double leaf doors, the gap at the meeting of stiles shall not be more than 1.5mm. d) Door leaves shall be undercut wherever required. e) Doors, windows, frames etc. shall be on a true plane, free f warp or buckle. f) All welds shall be dressed flush on exposed and contact surfaces. g) Correctness of location and smoothness of operations of all shop installed hardware and fixtures. h) Provision for hardware and fixtures to be installed at site. i) Glazing clips, fixing devices etc. shall be supplied in adequate numbers j) Shop coats shall be properly applied. k) Glazing beads shall be cut with mitered corners. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 173 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 9.02.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 For Installed Items a) Installations shall be at correct location, elevation and in general, on a true vertical plane. b) Fixing details shall be strictly as shown on drawings. c) Assembly of composite units shall be strictly as per the drawings with mastic caulking at transoms and mullions, gaskets, weather strips etc. complete. d) All frames on external walls shall be mastic caulked to prevent leakage through joint between frames and masonry. e) All openable sections shall operate smoothly without jamming. f) g) Locks, fasteners etc. shall engage positivel Key shall be non-interchangeable. Cutting to concrete or masonry shall be made good and all abrasions to shop paint shall be touched up with paint of same quality as shop paint. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 174 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 TECHNICAL SPECS FOR : GLASS & GLAZING 1.00.00 1.01.00 2.03.00 SCOPE The work in general shall consist of supplying and fixing all glass and glazing including all clips, putty, mastic cement etc. wherever required as shown on drawings. CODES AND STANDARDS All applicable standards, acts and codes of practice referred to shall be the latest editions including all applicable official amendments and revisions. A complete set of all these documents shall generally be available at site, with the Contractor. In case of conflict between this specification and those (IS Standards, Codes etc.) referred to in clause 2.03.00 the former shall prevail. Some of the applicable Indian standards, Codes, etc. are referred to here below: IS : 419 1967 Putty for use on window frames IS : 1960 Code of practice for fixing and glazing metal (steel & aluminium) doors, windows and ventilators 1081 IS : 1987 Flat transparent sheet glass 2835 IS : 1988 Code of practice for glazing in building 3548 IS : 1994 Figured rolled and wired glass 5437 IS : 2000 Specification for transparent float glass 14900 3.00.00 MATERIALS 3.01.00 The Contractor shall supply and install all glass and glazing as required for various doors, windows, sashes, ventilators, and fixed louvers, miscellaneous glazing and partitions, unless otherwise stated, from approved manufacture having uniform refractive index and free from flaws, specks and bubbles. The glass shall be brought to site in the original packing from the manufacturer and cut to size at site. The cut edges shall be straight and free from chips, spall or any other damages. 2.00.00 2.01.00 2.02.00 Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 175 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 3.02.00 3.03.00 3.04.00 3.05.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 The glass shall be plain float glass from approved manufacture, as specified and it shall be free from bubbles, flaws specs, waves, air holes, distortion, scratches or other defects. The glasses in bulk quantities shall be brought to site in Makers original packings and Makers guarantee shall be produced if called for by the Consultant/Owner/Owner. The glass shall be of required thickness as mentioned in the items of schedule of quantities and / or drawing or as directed by the Consultant/Owner/Owner. The contractor shall submit the sample of the glass which he proposes to use on the work and only such approved quality of glass shall be used in the works. The glass brought to site shall be protected against damages. Wherever frosted (obscure) glass is mentioned in the item of schedule of quantities and / or shown in drawings, the glass shall be of sand blown pattern and shall also be got approved by the Engineer-in-Charge. After the inspection is over and permitted by the Consultant/Owner/Owner, glass panes shall be cleaned off any labels paints smears and spots and shall be washed from both the sides and all glazing left elar, perfect and free from rattling. The contractor shall provide all the scaffolding tools and plants for fixing the glass panes at his own cost. In case of steel Glare reducing (tinted) or heat absorbing glass shall be “Calores” of Hindustan Pilkington or approved equivalent and special care shall be taken to grind smooth and round off the edges before fixing. Clear glass shall be flat drawn and shall be at least 4 mm thick, Conforming to lS:2835. Sheet glass for doors shall be minimum 6.3 mm thick. 3.06.00 Wired glass shall be 6 mm thick rolled glass with centrally embedded 24 G wire mesh of Georgian type. This may be of clear or coloured glass, as required by Engineer and shall conform to 3.07.00 3.08.00 3.09.00 lS:5437. Obscure glass shall have a cast surface on one side. Coloured and figured glass shall be as per approved sample. In general, the putty shall conform to lS:419 and be of best quality from approved manufacturer. it shall be brought to site in the manufacturer’s original packing. Quick setting putty shall be used for windows and sashes except when glare reducing glass is used where it shall be of non-setting type. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page176 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 3.10.0 Neoprene gaskets with snap-fit glazing shall be fixed as per manufacturer’s instruction and shall fit firmly against the glass to give a leak proof Installation. 4.00.00 FIXING 4.01.00 The glass shall be cut to the required sizes of panels where it is to be fitted and it shall be so cut that it fits properly in the frames without rattling. Pre-measurement of each panel prior to the cutting of glass is essential. 4.02.00 The beading shall then be fixed to glass panes and screwed at close intervals not more than 10 cm. from each corner and the intermediate not more than 20 cm. apart. When glass panes are fixed with wooden beadings having mitred joints or aluminium beading thin layer of glazier putty shall be applied covering the area in contact between the glass and sashbars and beadings. In case of louvers, all the exposed edges of the glass shall be ground properly 4.03.00 All glazing clips, bolts, nuts, putty, mastic cement, etc. as required shall be supplied by the Contractor. All glass shall be thoroughly cleaned before placing in positions. Each glass pane shall be held in place by special glazing clips of approved type. As specified in relevant l.S. Codes, four glazing clips shall be provided per glass pane, except for large panes where six or more clips shall be used as per Engineer’s instructions. All holes that may be necessary for holding the clips, glazing beads and all other attachments shall be drilled by the Contractor. Glass pane shall be set without springing, and shall be bedded in putty and back putted, except where mouldings or gaskets are specified. Putty, mastic cement etc. shall be smoothly finished to a true even line. Obscure and figured glass shall be set with smooth. side out. 4.04.00 4.05.00 4.06.00 After completion of glazing work, the Contractor shall remove all dirt, stains, putty etc. clean the glass panes and leave the work in perfectly acceptable condition. All broken, cracked or damaged glass shall be replaced by new ones Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 177 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 4.07.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 The beading shall be of teak wood of superior quality timber in case of teak wood doors and windows and / or required sizes mentioned in the items of schedule of quantities and / or shown in drawing. In case of steel doors and windows the beading shall be anodised aluminium beading of channel section as per size mentioned in the item and / or shown in the drawing. The junction of the beadings shall be mitre jointed. 5.00.00 ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA a) All installations shall be free from cracked, broken or damaged glass. Edges of large panes of thicker glass and heat absorbing glass shall be inspected carefully for chipped, cracked or unground edges. b) Glazing shall be carefully done to avoid direct contact with metal frames. c) All glass shall be embedded in mastic or fixed by neoprene gaskets to give a leak-proof installation. d) At completion, the panes shall be free from dirt, stains, excess putty etc. and to complete satisfaction of the Engineer. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page178 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 `TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS FOR ANTITERMITE TREATMENT 1.00.00 GENERAL 1.00.01 Pre-constructional anti – termite treatment is a process in which soil treatment is applied to a building in early stages of its construction. The purpose of antitermite treatment is to provide the building with a chemical barrier against the sub-terranean termites. 1.00.02 Antitermite treatment being a specialized job, calls for through knowledge of the chemicals, soils, termite to be dealt with and the environmental conditions, in order to give effective treatment and lasting protection to the property undergoing treatment. It is therefore, imperative that the works of antitermite treatment should be got executed through specialized agencies only. The specialized agency should be preferably a member of the Indian Pest Control Association and shall have sufficient experience of carrying out similar works of magnitude envisaged in this tender. 1.00.03 The pre-constructional soil treatment is required to be applied during the construction stages of the sub-structure upto plinth level. The contractor has to be watchful of the various stages of substructure works and arrange to carry out the soil treatment in time after proper co-ordination with other constructors if any, working at site. 1.00.04 The scope of pre-constructional anti-termite treatment covers the soil treatment with approved chemicals in water emulsion in foundation trenches for columns, plinth beams, pile caps, brick walls, service trenches, lift pits, steps, ramps etc., in top surfaces of plinth filling, at junction of walls and floor, in expansion joints etc., in stages as detailed in this specifications and drawings, unless otherwise stipulated, the anti-termite treatment will be carried out as per IS : 6313 (Part-II) and / or as per direction of the Consultant/Owner. 2.00.00 CODES & STANDARDS The relevant Indian Code for Antitermite treatment is given below: IS 6313 2001 Antitermite measures in building (Part 2) construction chemical treatment 3.00.00 3.01.00 – Pre SITE PREPARATION In order to ensure uniform distribution of the chemical emulsion and to assist penetration, the following site preparation shall be carried out : a) Remove all trees, stumps, logs or roots from the building site. b) Remove all concrete from work if left anywhere, levelling pegs, timber off-cuts and other builders debris from the area to be treated. c) If the soil to be treated is sandy or porous, preliminary moistening will be required to fill capillary spaces in soil in order to prevent the loss of emulsion through piping or excessive percolations. d) In the event of water logging of foundation, the water shall be pumped out before application of chemical emulsion and it should be applied only when the soil is absorbent. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 179 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 e) On clays and other heavy soils where penetration is likely to be slow and on sloping sites, where run-off of the treating solution is likely to occur, the surface of the soil should be scarified to a depth of 75 mm at least. f) All sub floor levelling and grading should be completed, all cutting, trenches and excavations should be completed with back filling in place, borrowed fill must be free from organic debris and shall be well compacted. If this is not done supplementary treatments should be made to complete the barrier. 4.00.00 4.01.00 CHEMICAL TO BE USED The effectiveness of chemical depends upon the choice of the chemical, the dosage adopted and the thoroughness of application. The chemical solutions or emulsions are required to be dispersed uniformly in the soil and to the required strength so as to form an effective chemical barrier which is lethal and repellent to termites. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 180 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 4.02.00 The following chemical in water emulsion, after approval from the Consultant/Owner, shall be used uniformly over the area to be treated. Chlropyrophos 4.03.00 The contractor should produce voucher (s) for the chemical purchased and should get verified the sealed container(s) of the specified chemical from the Consultant/Owner in-Charge before preparing the emulsion / use for the treatment. 5.00.00 MODE AND RATE OF APPLICATION : 5.01.00 The chemical emulsion as stated above will be applied uniformly by sprayers at the prescribed rates as detailed below in all the stages of the treatment. 5.02.00 Treatment in Foundation Trenches: In case of normal wall load bearing structures, column pits, wall trenches and basement, the treatment shall be at a rate of5 ltrs./sqm of surface area of the bottom and sides to a height of atleast 300 mm. After the foundation work, the sides shall be treated at a rate of 7.5 ltrs./sqm of vertical surface of substructure on each side. After the earth filling is done, treatment shall be done by rodding the earth at 150 mm centers close to wall surface and spraying the chemical with the above dose i.e. 7.5 ltrs./sqm. In case of framed structure, the treatment shall start at a depth of 500mm below ground level. From this depth the backfill around the columns, beams and R.C.C. basement walls shall be treated at a rate of7.5 ltrs./sqm of the vertical surface and at a rate of 5 ltrs / sqm for the horizontal surface at the bottom in the trenches / pits 5.03.00 Treatment on Top Surfaces of Plinth Filling : The top surface of the filled earth within plinth walls shall be treated with chemical emulsion at the rate of 5 litres / sqm of the surface area before sub-base to floor is laid, if filled earth has been well rammed and the surface does not allow the emulsion to seep through, holes upto 50 to 75mm deep at 150mm centers both ways shall be made with crow bars on the surface to facilitate saturation of the soil with the emulsion. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 181 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 5.04.00 Treatment at Junction of Walls and Floors : Special care shall be taken to establish continuity of the vertical chemical barrier on the inner wall surfaces from the finished ground level (or from level where the treatment had stopped) upto the level of the filled earth surface. To achieved this a small channel 30 x 30 mm shall be made at all the junctions of wall / column with floor (before laying sub-grade) and rod holes made in the channel upto the finished ground level at 150 mm apart and the iron and moved backward and forward to break the earth and chemical emulsion poured along the channel at a rate of 7.5 litres (or at recommended quantity) per sqm. of the vertical wall / column surfaces so as to soak the soil right up to the bottom. The soil shall be tamped back into place after this operation. 5.05.00 Treatment for Expansion Joints : The soil beneath the expansion joints shall receive special attention when the treatment under 5.02.00 above is in progress. This treatment shall be supplemented by treating through the expansion joint after sub-grade has been laid at the rate of 2 litres per metre length of expansion joint. 6.00.00 PRECAUTIONS 6.01.00 Utmost care shall be taken to see that the chemical barrier is complete and continuous. Each part of the area shall receive the prescribed dosage of chemical emulsion. The treatment should not be carried out when it is raining or when the soil is wet with rain or sub-soil water. 6.02.00 6.03.00 Once formed, the treated soil barrier shall not be disturbed. If by chance, treated soil barriers are disturbed, immediate steps shall be taken to restore the continuity and completeness of the barrier system. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 182 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 7.00.00 HEALTH HAZARDS AND SAFETY MEASURES 7.01.00 All the chemicals mentioned above are poisonous and hazardous to health. These chemicals can have an adverse effect upon health when absorbed through the skin, inhaled as vapours or spray mist or swallowed. Persons handling or using these chemicals should be warned of these dangers and advised that absorption through the skin is the most likely source of accidental poisoning. They should be cautioned to observe carefully the safety precautions given in 7.02.00 to 7.05.00 particularly when handling these chemicals in the form of concentrates. 7.02.00 These chemicals are usually brought to the site in the form of emulsifiable concentrates. The containers should be clearly labeled and should be stored carefully so that children and pets cannot get at them. They should be kept securely closed. 7.03.00 Particular care should be taken to prevent skin contact with concentrates. Prolonged exposure to dilute emulsions should also be avoided. Workers should wear clean clothing and should wash thoroughly with soap and water specially before eating and smoking. In the event of severe contamination, clothing should be removed at once and the skin washed with soap and water. If chemicals splash into the eyes they shall be flushed with plenty of soap and water and immediate medical attention should be sought. 7.04.00 The concentrates are oil solutions and present a fire hazard owing to the use of petroleum solvents. Flames should not be allowed during mixing. 7.05.00 Care should be taken in the application of chemicals / soil – toxicants to see that they are not allowed to contaminate wells or springs which serve as source of drinking water. 8.00.00 GUARANTEE 2.00.01 The contractor has to furnish the guarantee for 10 (ten) years from the date of completion of work, stating that in case of reappearance of termites within the building area due to defective materials or workmanship or due to any other reasons, the contractor will carry out the necessary post constructional treatment to keep the entire area free from termite, once again, without any extra cost of the Department during the guarantee period. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 183 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 TECHNICAL SPECS FOR PAINTING, WHITE DISTEMPERINGAND OTHER FINISHING WORKS WASHING, 1.00.00 SCOPE 1.01.00 This Specification covers painting, white washing. polishing, distempering etc. of both interior and exterior surfaces of masonry, concrete, plaster, plaster of Paris, structural and other miscellaneous steel items, rain water down comer, floor and roof drains, waste and service water pipes, and other ferrous and nonferrous metal items as indicated elsewhere in these specifications or as directed by the Engineer. 1.02.00 If surface to be finished cannot be put in suitable condition for painting by customary preparatory methods, the Contractor shall notify the Engineer in writing or assume responsibility for and rectify and unsatisfactory finishing. Before commencing painting, the Contractor shall obtain the approval of the Engineer in writing regarding the scheduling of work to minimise damage, disfiguration or staining by other trades. He shall also undertake normal precautions to prevent damage, disfiguration or staining to work of other trades or other installations. 2.00.00 CODES AND STANDARDS 2.01.00 All applicable standards, acts and codes of practice referred to shall be the latest editions including all applicable official amendments and revisions. A complete set of all these documents shall generally be available at site, with the Contractor. 2.02.00 In case of conflict between this specification and those (IS Standards, Codes etc.) referred to in clause 2.03.00 the former shall prevail. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 184 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 2.03.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 Some of the applicable Indian standards, Codes, etc. are referred to here below: 75-1973 77-1976 102-1962 103-1962 Linseed oil, raw and refined Linseed oil, boiled, for paints Ready mixed paint, brushing, red, lead, nonsetting, priming Ready mixed paint, brushing, white lead, for priming and general purposes 104-1979 Specification for ready mixed paint, brushing, zinc chrome, priming 133-1993 Enamel, interior (a) under coating (b) finishing colour as required 137-1965 Ready mixed paint, brushing, matt oregg-shell flat, inishing, itterior, to Indian Standard Colour, as required 158-1981 Ready mixed paint, brushing, bituminous, black lead free acid alkali, water and heat resisting for general purposes. 168-1993 Ready mixed paint, air drying for general purpose. 217-1988 Cut back bitumen 218-1983 Creosote and anthrakene oil for use as wood preservatives 290-1961 Coal tar black paint 337-1975 Varnish, finishing interior 338-1952 Varnish, under coating exterior, natural resin 339-1952 Varnish, under coating, exterior, synthetic resin 340-1978 Varnish, mixing 341-1973 Black Japan, type A, E, & C 345-1952 Wood filler, Transparent, liquid 347-1975 Varnish, shellac for general purpose 348-1968 French polish 419-1967 Putty for use of window frames 427-1965 Distemper, dry, colour as required 428-1969 Distemper, oil emulsion colour as required 524-1983 Varnish, finishing, exterior, synthetic 525-1968 Varnish, finishing, exterior and general purposes 533-1973 Gum spirit of turpentine (oil of turpentine) 712-1984 Specification for building limes 1200-(Pt.- Method of measurements of plastering and pointing XII)-1976 Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 185 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 1200-Pt.XIII)-1987 1200-(Pt.XV)-1987 IS : 1477 (I and II) 2095-1982 2096-1992 2339-1963 IS : 2395 (I and II) 2547-1976 2932-1994 2933-1975 5410-1992 5411-(Pt.I)-1974 6278-1971 IS : 13467 BS : 5493 10000011 / HB / 11094 Method of measurements of white washing, colour washing, distempering and other finishes Methods of measurements of painting, polishing & varnishing. Code of Practice for painting of ferrous metals in building Gypsum plaster boards. Asbestos cement flat sheets. Aluminium paint for general purposes, in dual container Code of Practice for painting concrete, masonry and plaster surface Gypsum building plaster Enamel synthetic, exterior (a) Under coating (b) Finishing. Enamel, Exterior (a) Under coating (b) Finishing Cement paint, colour as required Plastic emulsion paint for interior use Code of practice for white washing & colour washing Specification for chlorinated rubber for paints Code of practice for protective coating of Iron & Steel structure against corrosion Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 186 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 3.00.00 MATERIALS 3.01.00 Materials shall be of highest grade products of well-known approved manufacturer and shall be delivered to the site in original sealed containers, bearing brand name, manufacture’s name and colour shade, with label intact and seals unbroken. All materials shall be subject to inspection & approval by the Engineer. It is desired that materials of one manufacturer only shall be used as far as possible and paint of one shade be obtained from the same manufacturing batch. 3.02.00 All paint shall be subjected to analysis from random samples taken at site from painters bucket, if so desired by the Engineer. 3.03.00 All prime coats shall be compatible to the material of the surface to be finished as well as to the finishing coats to be applied. All unspecified materials such as shellac, turpentine or linseed oil shall be of the highest quality available and shall conform to the reputed recognised manufacturer’s and shall be approved by the Engineer. 3.04.00 All colour shall be as per painting schedule and tinting and matching shall be done to the satisfaction of the Engineer. In such cases, where samples are required, they shall be executed in advance with the specified materials for the approval of the Engineer. 4.00.00 WHITE WASHING 4.01.00 Shall be done from pure shell lime or fat lime, or a mixture of both as instructed by the Engineer, and shall conform to IS: 712. Samples of lime shall be submitted to the Engineer for approval, and lime as per approved sample shall be brought to site in unslaked condition. After slaking, it shall be allowed to remain in a tank of water for two days, and then stirred up with a pole, until it attains the consistency of thin cream. 100 grams of gum to 6 litres of white wash water and a little quantity of indigo or synthetic ultramarine blue shall be added to the lime. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 187 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 ] REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 5.00.00 WATERPROOF CEMENT PAINT 5.01.00 Shall be made from best quality white cement and lime resistant colours with accelerators, waterproofing agents and fungicides. The paint shall conform to IS: 5410. 6.00.00 ACRYLIC EMULSION PAINT 6.01.00 Shall be water based acrylic copolymer emulsion with rutile titanium dioxde and other selected pigments and fungicide. It shall exhibit excellent adhesion to plaster and surface and shall resist deteoration by alkali salts. The paint film shall allow the moisture in wall to escape without peeling or blistering. The paint, after it is dried, shall be able to withstand washing with mild soap and water without any deterioration in colour, or without flaking, blistering or peeling. SYNTHETIC ENAMEL PAINT 7.00.00 7.01.00 8.00.00 8.01.00 Shall be made from synthetic resin and drying oil with rutile titanium dioxide and other selected pigments to give a smooth, hard, durable and glossy finish to all exterior and interior surfaces. white and pastel shades shall resist yellowing and darkening with aging. The paint shall conform to IS: 2932 and IS: 2933. DRY DISTEMPER Dry distemper of required colour conforming to IS:427 and of approved brand and manufacturer shall be used. The primer where used shall be cement primer or distemper primer. The shade shall be got approved from the Engineer. Dry distemper as required shall be stirred slowly and in clean water using 0.6 litre of water per kg of distemper or as specified by the manufacturer. Distemper shall not be mixed in larger quantity than is actually required for one days work. Warm water shall preferably be used. The treatment shall consists of a priming coat of whiting followed by the application of two or more coats of distemper till the surface shows an even colour. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 188 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 9.00.00 OIL BOUND DISTEMPER 9.01.00 Oil bound distemper (IS:428-1969) of approved brand and manufacturer shall be used. Any unevenness in surface shall be made good by applying putty. The patched surface shall be allowed to dry thoroughly before the coat of distemper is applied. One coat of distemper properly diluted with thinner as specified by the manufacturer applied with brushes in horizontal strokes followed immediately by vertical ones together will constitute one coat. Two or more coats of distemper as found necessary shall be applied to obtain even shade. 10.00.00 COLOUR WASH 10.01.00 It shall be done with mineral colours, not affected by lime added to white wash. No colour wash shall be done until a sample of the colour wash to the required tint or shade has been approved by the Engineer. The colour shall be of even tint or shade over the whole surface. If it is blotchy or otherwise badly applied, it shall be redone by the Contractor at no extra cost to Owner. 11.00.00 CHLORINATED RUBBER BASED PAINT 11.01.00 11.02.00 Chlorinated rubber is the product obtained from the reaction of chlorine with rubber. The product contains an average chlorine content of about 65%. Chlorinated rubber shall be formulated with resins (for adhesion and gloss), plasticizers (for flexibility and toughness), pigments (for colour), stabilizers and solvents (for fluidity). This shall meet the general requirements of IS:13467 & BS:5493. 12.00.00 STORAGE 12.01.00 The Contractor shall arrange for safe and proper storage of all materials and tools. Paints shall be kept covered at all times and mixing shall be done in suitable containers. All necessary precautions shall be taken by the Contractor to prevent fire. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 189 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 13.00.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 PREPARATION OF SURFACE 13.01.00 Before starting the work the Contractor shall obtain the approval of the Engineer regarding the soundness and readiness of the surface to be painted on. 13.02.00 Masonry, Concrete and Plastered Surfaces shall be free from all oil, grease, efflorescence, mildew, loose paint or other foreign and loose materials. Masonry cracks shall be cleaned out and patch filled with mortar similar to the original surface and uniformly textured. Where this type of resurfacing may lead to the finishing paint being different in shade from the original surfaces, the resurfaced area shall be treated with minimum one coat of cement primer which should be continued to the surrounding area for a distance of minimum 100 mm. 13.03.00 Surface with mildew, efflorescence shall be treated as -below. a) Mildew: All mildewed surfaces shall be treated with an pproved fungicide such as ammoniacal wash consisting of 7 gm of copper arbonate dissolved in 80 ml liquid ammonia and diluted to 1 litre with water or 2.5 per cent magnesium silico-fluoride solution and allowed to dry thoroughly before paint is applied. b) Efflorescence: All efflorescence shall be removed by scrubbing the affected surfaces with a solution of muriatic acid in water (1 : 6 to 1 : 8) and washed fully with clear water and allowed to dry thoroughly. 13.04.00 Metal Surfaces 13.04.01 All metal surfaces shall be absolutely clean, dry and free from wax, grease or dried soap films. All steel and iron surfaces in addition shall be free from rust. All galvanized iron surfaces shall be pretreated with a compatible primer according to the manufacturer’s direction. Any abrasion in shop coat shall be touched up with the same quality of paint as the original coat. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 190 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 14.00.00 APPLICATION 14.01.00 The method of application shall be as recommended by the manufacturer in case of selection of special shades and colour (not available in standard shades) the Contractor shall mix different shades and prepare test panels of minimum size 1 metre square as per instruction of the Engineer and obtain his approval prior to application of finishing paints. 14.02.00 Proper tools and implements shall be used. Scaffoldings if used shall be independent of the surface to be painted to avoid shade differences of the freshly repaired anchor holes. Painting shall be done by skilled labourers in a workman like manner. All materials shall be evenly applied, so as to be free of sags, runs, crawls or other defects. All coats shall be of proper consistency. In case of application by brush, no brush marks shall be visible. The brushes shall be clean and in good condition before application of paint. 14.03.00 All priming undercoats for painting shall be applied by brush only and rollers, spray equipments etc. shall not be used. 14.04.00 No work shall be done under conditions that are unsuitable for production of good results. No painting shall be done when plastering is in progress or is drying. Application of paint which seals of surface to moisture shall be done after the moisture on and under the surface has dried out. 14.05.00 All coats shall be thoroughly dry before being sand papered or before the succeeding coat is applied. Coats of painting as specified are intended to cover surfaces perfectly. 14.06.00 In case the surface is not covered properly by applying the specified number of coats, further coats shall be applied by the Contractor when so directed by the Engineer, without any extra cost to Owner. All primers and undercoats shall be tinted to approximate the colour of the finishing coats. Finished coats shall be of exact colour and shade and as per approved samples and finish shall be uniform in colour and texture. All parts of mouldings and ornaments shall be left clean and true to finish. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 191 of Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 14.07.00 White Washing: The surface where white washing is to be applied shall be cleaned of all loose materials and dirt. All holes and irregularities of the surface shall be filled up with lime putty and shall be allowed to dry up before application of the lime solution. One coat of white wash shall consists of one stroke from top downwards, another from bottom upwards over the first stroke and another from left to right before the previous one dries up. Second coat shall be applied after the first dries up completely and similarly the third coat shall be applied and in case the Engineer feels that one or more coats are required the Contractor shall do so without any extra cost to the Owner. No brush marks shall show on the finished surface. The inner plastered surfaces of walls shall be given three or more coats of white washings. 14.08.00 Waterproof Cement Paint: Surface to be coated with cement paint shall be washed and brushed down. As soon as the moisture has disappeared, the surface shall be given one coat of paint. Care shall be taken so that the paint does not dry out too rapidly. After 4 to 6 hours, the water shall be sprinkled over the surface to assist curing and prevent cracking. After the first coat has dried (24 to 48 hours) the second coat shall be applied. In a similar manner the finished surface shall be kept moist by occasional sprinkling with water for seven days after painting. 14.09.00 Acrylic Enamel Paint: Lime gauged cement plastered surfaces shall not be painted for at least one month after plastering. A sample patch shall be painted to check alkali reaction if so desired by the Engineer. Painting shall be strictly as per manufacturer’s specification. Minimum two coats shall be applied. 14.10.00 Synthetic Enamel Paint: Shall be applied on properly primed surface. Subsequent coats shall not be applied till the previous coat is dry. The previous coat shall be lightly sand papered for better adhesion of subsequent coats. Minimum two coats shall be applied. 14.11.00 Dry Distemper: The treatment shall consists of a priming coat of whiting followed by the application of two or more coats of distemper till the surface shows an even colour as per manufacturer’s instruction. The entire surface shall be coated with the mixture uniformly, with proper distemper, in horizontal strokes followed immediately by vertical ones which together shall constitute one coat. Subsequent coats shall be applied only if the previous coat has dried. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 192 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 14.12.00 Oil Bound Distemper: Any unevenness in the surface shall be made good by applying putty. The patched surface shall be allowed to dry thoroughly before coat of distemper is applied. One coat of distemper properly diluted with thinner as specified by the manufacturer shall be applied with brushes in horizontal strokes followed immediately by vertical ones which together will constitute one coat. Two or more coats of distemper, as found necessary shall be applied to obtain even shades. 14.13.00 Colour Washing: For new work, the priming coat shall be of white wash with lime or with whiting. Two or more coat shall than be applied on the entire surface till it represents a smooth and uniform finish. The finished dry surface shall not be powdery and shall not readily come off on hand when rubbed. Indigo (neel) shall however, not be added. 15.00.00 PAINTING OF IRON & STEEL WORKS 15.01 .00 Paint to be used for various items of work shall be of best quality and shall be obtained ready mixed in sealed containers from approved manufacturer. The contractor shall obtain the Engineer’s approval for the make and colour of the paint he proposes to use. All surfaces shall be thoroughly cleaned of all dirt, loose particles and rust, and approved prior to application of paint. Workmanship shall conform to lS:1477 (Part - I & III). 15.02.00 15.03.00 Specific number of coats shall be applied and at least 24 hours shall elapse between the applications of successive coats. No painting shall be carried out on exterior work in wet weather or on surfaces which are not entirely dry. 16.00.00 CHEMICAL RESISTANT PAINT 16.01.00 17.00.00 17.01.00 For chemical resistant paint stipulation of BS: 5493 shall also be followed. PROTECTION Furniture and other movable objects, equipments, fittings and accessories shall be moved, protected and replaced upon completion of the painting work. All stationary items of equipments shall be well covered so that no paint can fall on them. All protection shall be as per instruction of the Engineer. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 193 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 18.00.00 CLEANING UP 18.01.00 The Contractor shall, upon completion of painting etc. remove all marks and make good the surface, where paint has been spilled, splashed or splattered, including all equipments, fixtures, glass, furniture, fittings etc. to the satisfaction of the Engineer. 19.00.00 ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA a) All painted surfaces shall be uniform and pleasing in appearance. b) The colour, texture etc. shall match exactly with approved samples. c) All stains, splashes and splatters of paints shall be removed from surrounding surfaces. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 194 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 TECHICAL SPECIFICATIONS FOR : FLOORING & ALLIED WORKS 1.00.00 SCOPE 1.01.00 This specification covers furnishing, installation, finishing, curing, testing, protection, maintenance till handing over various types of floor finishes and allied items of work as listed below: a) In situ Terrazzo finish b) Integral finish to concrete base. d) Metallic hardener like ‘Ironite’ finish e) IPS Flooring f) Terrazzo Tiled finish g) Glazed tile finish h) Acid resistant tile finish i) PVC tile finish 2.00.00 General 2.01.00 Base: The base to receive the finish either formed concrete sub-base or floor slab covered under other relevant specifications. 2.02.00 Commencement, scheduling and sequence of the finishing works shall be planned in detail and must be specifically approved by the Engineer, keeping in view the activities of other agencies working in the area. However, the contractor shall remain fully responsible for all normal precautions and vigilance to prevent any damage whatsoever till handing over. 2.03.00 Only workers specially experienced in particular items of finishing work shall be engaged; where such workers are not readily available, with the Engineer’s permission, experienced supervisors recommended by the manufacturer shall be engaged. In particular cases where the Consultant/Owner so desire, the Contractor shall get the finishing items installed by the manufacturer. 2.03.00 The surface to the treated shall be thoroughly examined by the Contractor. Any rectification necessary shall be brought to the notice of the Consultant/Owner and his approval shall be obtained regarding method and extent of such rectification work. For all types of flooring, skirting, dado and similar works the base to receive the finish shall be adequately roughened by chipping, raking out joints and cleaning thoroughly all dirt, grease etc., with water and hard brush and (detergent if required, unless otherwise directed by the manufacturer of any special finishing treatment, the base shall be thoroughly soaked with water and all excess water mopped up. The surface shall be done dry where adhesive are used for fixing the finishes. Prior to commencement of actual finishing the approval of the Consultant/Owner shall be taken as to the acceptability of the surface. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 195 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 3.00.00 CODES AND STANDARDS 3.01.00 All applicable standards, acts and codes of practice referred to shall be the latest editions including all applicable official amendments and revisions. A complete set of all these documents shall generally be available at site, with the Contractor. 3.02.00 In case of conflict between this specification and those (IS Standards, Codes etc.) referred to in clause 3.03.00 the former shall prevail. 3.03.0 Some of the applicable Indian standards, Codes, etc. are referred to here below: IS :1237 Specification for Cement concrete flooring tiles IS : 1443 Code of practice for laying and finishing of cement concrete flooring tiles. : 2114 Code o f practice for laying in situ terrazzo floor IS : 2571 Code o f practice for laying-in-situ concrete flooring IS : 5318 Laying of flexible sheet and tile flooring IS: 4441 Code o f practice for use of silica type chemical resistant mortar IS : 4457 Specification for Ceramic unglaged vitreous acid resistant tiles. IS : 13753Specification for dust pressed ceramic tiles with water absorption of E> 10% Group (B IiI) IS : 13753Specification for dust pressed ceramic tiles with water absorption of 6% <E< 10% Group (B II b) IS : 13753Specification for dust pressed ceramic tiles with water absorption of 3% <E< 6% Group (B II a) IS : 13753Specification for dust pressed ceramic tiles with low water absorption of E< 3% Group (B I) Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 196 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 4.00.00 4.01.00 4.02.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 MATERIALS Materials required for individual finishing items are specified under respective items. In general, all such materials shall be as per relevant IS Codes where available. In all cases these materials shall be of the best quality available indigenously unless specified otherwise. The materials for finishing items must be procured from wellreputed specified manufacturers and on the basis of approval of samples by the Engineer. The materials shall be ordered, procured and stored well in advance to avoid compulsion to use substandard items to maintain the construction schedule. 5.00.00 INTEGRAL FINISHING TO CONCRETE BASE 5.01.00 While the surface of the concrete laid as per specification for “castin situ concrete and allied works” has been fully compacted and levelled but the concrete is still ‘green’ a thick slurry made with neat cement shall be applied evenly and worked in with iron floats. When the slurry starts to set, it shall be pressed with iron floats, to have a firm compact smooth surface without any trowel mark or undulations. This finish shall be as thin as possible by using 2.2 Kg of cement per sqm. of area. The surface shall be kept in shade for 24 hours and then cured for at least 7 days continuously by flooding with water. The surface shall not be subjected to any load or abrasion till 21 days after laying. As desired by the Engineer, the surface, while still ‘green’ shall be indented by pressing strings. The markings shall be of even depth, in straight lines and the panels shall be of uniform and symmetrical patterns. 6.00.00 6.01.00 IN-SITU TERRAZZO FINISH It shall consist of an underbed and a topping laid over an already laid and matured concrete base. Thickness Unless otherwise specified the total thickness of the finish shall be minimum 50mm for horizontal and 25 mm for vertical surface of which the topping shall be not less than 12 mm and 10mm respectively. While the topping shall be of uniform thickness the thickness of underbed may vary, to provide necessary slopes. The vertical surface shall project out 6 mm from the adjacent plaster or other finishes. Necessary cutting into the surface receiving the finish shall be done to accommodate the specified thickness. 6.02.00 6.02.01 Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 197 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6.02.02 All junctions of vertical with horizontal shall be rounded neatly to uniform radius of 25 mm. 6.03.00 Mix 6.03.01 Underbed : the underbed for floors and similar horizontal surface shall consist of a mix of 1 part cement, 2 part sand and 4 parts stone chips by volume. For vertical surfaces the mix shall consist of 1 part cement to 3 parts of coarse and by volume. The stone chips shall be 12.5mm down well graded. Just sufficient water shall be added to give a workable consistency. 6.03.02 Topping : The mix for the topping shall be composed of cement, colour pigment, marble powder and marble chips. Proportions of the ingredients shall be such as to produce the terrazzo of colour, texture and pattern approved by the Engineer. The cement shall be grey, to which pigment shall be added to achieve the desired colour. To 3 parts of this mixture 1 part marble powder by weight shall be added and thoroughly mixed dry. To 1 part of this mix, 1.5 parts of marble chips by volume shall be added and thoroughly mixed dry again. The pigment added shall conform to the relevant Indian Standard specification and must be stable and non fading. It must be very finely ground. The marble powder shall be from white marble and shall be finer than I S Seive No. 30. the size of marble chips may be between 3 mm to 20 mm. Sufficient quantity to cover each visible area shall be prepared in one lot to ensure uniform colour. Sufficient water to make it just workable shall be added, to a quantity of mix that can be used up immediately before it starts to set. Laying 6.04.00 6.04.01 The underbed shall be laid in panels. The panels shall not be more than 5 sq.m. in area of which no side shall be more than 2.5 m long. For exposed locations the maximum area of a panel shall be 2.0 sq.m. The panels shall be laid in alternate bays or chequered board pattern. No panels shall be in contact with another already laid until the latter has contracted to the full extent. 6.04.02 Dividing strips made of aluminium shall be used for forming the panels. The strips shall exactly match the total depth of underbed plus topping. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 198 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 6.04.03 After laying, the underbed shall be levelled compacted and brought to proper grade with a screed or float. The topping shall be laid after about 24 hours while the underbed is still somewhat ‘green’ but firm enough to receive the topping. A slurry of the mixture of cement and pigment already made shall be spread evenly and brushed in just before laying the topping. The topping shall be rolled for horizontal areas and thrown and pressed for verical areas to extract all superfluous cement water and to achieve a compact dense mass fully bonded with the underbed. The surface of the topping shall be trowelled over, pressed and brought to a smooth dense surface showing a minimum 75% area covered by marble chips in an even pattern of distribution. 6.05.00 Curing: The surface after laying shall be left for about 12 to 18 hours and then cured by allowing water to stand on the surface or by covering with wet sack for four days. Grinding and Polishing 6.06.00 6.06.01 When the surface has sufficiently hardened it shall be watered and ground evenly with rapid cutting coarse grade (No. 60) grit blocks, till the marble chips are exposed and the surface is smooth. Then the surface shall be thoroughly washed and cleaned. A grout, with already prepared mixture of cement and pigment shall be applied to fill up all pinholes. 6.06.02 This surface shall be cured for 7 days by keeping it moist and then ground with fine grit block (No. 120). It shall again be cleaned with water, the slurry applied again to fill up pinhole that might have appeared and allowed to be cured again for 5 days. Finally the surface is ground a third time with very fine grit blocks (No. 320) to get smooth surface without any pinhole. The grinding shall be done by a suitable machine. Where grinding machine cannot be used hand grinding may be allowed when the first rubbing shall be with carborundum stone of coarse grade (No. 60), second rubbing with medium grade (No. 80) and final rubbing and polished with fine grade (No. 120). The surface shall be cleaned with water, dried and 4 covered with oil free clean sawdust. The final polishing shall be postponed until just before handing over, if desired by the Engineer. Just before handing over, the surface shall be dusted with Oxalic acid at the rate of 0.33 gm per sq. m., water sprinkled on it and finished by buffing with felt or hessain bobs. The floor be cleaned with soft moist rag and dried. 6.06.03 Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 199 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 7.00.00 7.01.00 7.02.00 7.02.01 7.03.00 7.03.01 7.04.00 7.04.01 7.04.02 7.05.00 7.05.01 7.05.02 10000011 / HB / 11094 METALLIC HARDENER FINISH It shall consist of an underbed and a topping (incorporating iron particles) laid over an already laid and matured concrete base. Thickness: Unless otherwise specified the total thickness of the finish shall be minimum 50mm for horizontal surface of which topping shall not be less than 12 mm. While topping shall be of uniform thickness, the underbed may vary in thickness to provide necessary slope. The vertical surface shall project 6 mm from adjacent plaster or other finishes. Necessary cutting into the surface receiving the finish shall be done to accommodate the specified thickness. Material: The hardening compound shall be uniformly graded iron particles, free from non-ferrous metal impurities, oil, grease, sand, soluble alkaline compounds orother injurious materials. When desired by the Engineer, actual samples shall be tested. Mix The underbed for floor and similar horizontal surfaces and for vertical surface shall be as per clause 6.03.01 of this section. Proportion of metallic hardener shall be as specified or as indicated by the manufacturer. However, in absence of any such direction 1 part metallic hardener shall be mixed dry with 4 parts cement, by weight. To this mixture 6 mm nominal size stone chips shall be added in proportion of 1 part cement mixed with hardener to 2 parts of stone chips by volume and uniformly mixed. Minimum quantity of water shall be added to make it workable. Laying The concrete floor shall be laid in panels of 1m x 1m or as directed by the Engineer. Alternate panels shall be laid on one day followed by the other group of alternate panels the next day. The edges of the panels shall be supported either by wooden strips or flat angle iron pieces fixed in position property. The concrete floor shall be laid upto the required grade. The forms if any shall remain sufficiently projecting to take the finish. The surface shall be roughened by wire brush as soon as possible. The junction of floor and walls, floors and dado or skirting shall be rounded off as directed. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 200 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 7.05.03 Wooden strips or flat iron pieces shall be removed from their places before the succeeding alternate layers are laid. The finish shall be laid while the concrete underbed is still very ‘green’ within about 3 hours of laying of the later. The finish shall be of uniform thickness and even dense surface without trowel marks, pinhole etc. The topping layer shall be pressed firmly and worked vigorously and quickly to secure full bond with the concrete base. Just when the initial set starts the surface shall be finished and smoothened with steel trowel. The finish floor shall be cured for 7 days by keeping it wet. 8.00.00 IPS FLOORING (Concrete Floor finish with floating Coat of Neat Cement) It shall consist of an underbed and topping laid on an already laid and matured concrete base. Thickness It shall have thickness of 50 mm for horizontal and 20 mm for vertical surfaces unless otherwise specified. All junctions between vertical and horizontal work shall be rounded neatly to a uniform radius of 25 mm. 8.01.00 8.02.00 8.02.01 8.03.00 8.03.01 8.04.00 8.04.01 8.05.00 Underbed Mix The underbed for floor and similar horizontal surfaces consists of a mix of 1 part cement, 2 parts sand and 4 parts stone chips by volume. For vertical surfaces the mix shall consist of 1 part cement to 3 parts sand by volume. The sand shall be coarse. The stone chips shall be 12.5 mm down well graded. Only sufficient water to be added to give a workable consistency. Topping Mix The topping shall be floating coat of neat cement using not less than 2.2 kg of cement per sq. m. area. Laying Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 201 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 8.05.01 The IPS flooring including the underbed shall be laid in alternate bays or in chequered board pattern. No panel shall be cast in contact with another already laid till the contraction of the latter has already taken place. The maximum area of each panel shall be 5 m x 5m. A cement grout shall be applied and worked in to the surface to receive the finish, the underbed then laid, compacted and levelled to proper grade with a screed or float. The requisite slope as shown in the drawings or directed by the Consultant/Owner shall also be provided in under bed only maintaining a minimum thickness of 25 mm at the edges. The topping shall be applied evenly on the underbed while it is not fully set but firm enough and rolled and pressed to get full bond. The topping shall be trowelled to a dense finish to the satisfaction of the Engineer. After the surface is sufficiently set, the finished floor shall be kept moist for 7 days for curing. 9.00.00 TERRAZZO TILE FINISH 9.01.00 These shall include terrazzo tiles finish over already laid and matured base of concrete or masonry by means of underbed cement : sand (1:4) mortar. 9.02.00 Thickness 9.02.01 The total thickness including the underbed shall be minimum 50 mm for floors and 32 mm for walls unless otherwise specified. The skirting, dado and similar vertical surfaces shall project out 6 mm uniformly from the adjacent plaster or other wall finishes. The necessary cuttings into the surface receiving tiled finish, to accommodate the specified thickness shall be done. 9.03.00 Terrazzo Tiles 9.03.01 The tiles shall, unless specifically permitted in special cases, be machine made, under quality control in a shop. The tiles shall be pressed hydraulically to a minimum of 140 kg. per sq. cm. Each tile shall bear on its back permanent and legible trade mark of the manufacturer. All angles of the tiles shall be right angles, all edges sharp and true, colour and texture of the wearing face uniform throughout. Tolerance on length, breadth and thickness of tiles shall be as specified in lS:1237 latest edition. Wearing faces of the tile shall be plane, free from pinholes and other blemishes. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 202 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 9.03.02 9.03.03 10000011 / HB / 11094 The tiles shall be composed of a backing and topping. The topping measured as per IS:1237 (latest edition) shall be of uniform thickness not less than 8 mm. The total thickness including the topping shall be as specified but not less than 20 mm in any case. The backing shall be composed of 1 part ordinary grey cement 2 parts of sand and 3 parts of stone chips by weight mixed with water. The topping shall be, as specified under Clause 6.03.00 of this section. The tiles shall be cured at the shop for at least 14 days before delivery to the site. First grinding shall be given to the tiles at the shop before delivery. Tiles shall be packed properly to prevent damage during transit and storage. The tiles must be stored carefully to prevent staining by damp, rust, oil and grease, or other chemicals. Tiles made in each batch shall be kept and used separately so that colour of each area of the floor may remain uniform. The manufacturer shall supply alongwith the tiles the grout mix containing cement and pigment in exact proportions as used in topping of tiles. The container for the grout mix shall be suitably marked to relate it to the particular type and batch of tiles 9.04.00 Mix : Underbed 9.04.01 9.05.00 The underbed for floor and similar horizontal surfaces shall be 1 parts cement : 2 parts coarse sand : 4 parts stone chips by volume (12.5 mm nominal size), mixed with sufficient water. For skirting and dado and all vertical surface it shall be 12 mm thick and composed of 1 part cement and 3 parts coarse sand by volume. Laying 9.05.01 The underbed mortar shall be evenly spread and brought to proper grade and consolidated to a smooth surface. The surface shall be roughened for better bond. Before the underbed had time to set and while it is still fairly moist but firm, cement shall be hand dusted over it or a cement slurry applied and the tiles shall immediately be placed upon and firmly pressed by wooden mallet on to the underbed until it achieves the desired level. The tiles shall be kept soaked for about 10 minutes just before laying. The joints between tiles shall be as close as possible and not more than 1.5 mm wide. Special care shall be taken to check the level of the surface and the lines of the joints frequently so that they are perfect. When tiles are required to be cut to match the dimensions, these shall be sawn and edges rubbed smooth. The location of cut tiles shall be planned in advance and approval of the Consultant/Owner shall be taken. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 203 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 9.05.02 At the junction of horizontal surface with vertical surface the. tiles on the former shall enter at least 12 mm under the latter. After fixing, the floor shall be kept moist and allowed to mature undisturbed for 7 days. Heavy traffic shall not be allowed. If desired dividing strips as specified under Clause 6.04.00 may be used for dividing the work into suitable panels. 9.06.00 Grinding and Polishing 9.06.01 Procedure shall be same as Clause 6.06.00. Only grinding shall not 10.00.00 10.01.00 10.02.00 10.02.01 10.02.02 10.03.00 10.03.01 commence earlier than 14 days after laying of tiles. GLAZED TILE FINISH This finish shall be composed of glazed earthware tiles of approved make and quality, with an underbed laid over a concrete or masonry base. Thickness The total thickness shall be minimum 20 mm including the underbed. The tile finish on vertical surface shall project out 6 mm uniformly from the adjacent plaster or other wall finishes. The necessary cutting into surface receiving the finish, to accommodate the specified thickness shall be done. Tiles - Glazed The tiles shall be of earthware, covered with glaze, white or coloured, plain or with designs, of 150 mm x 150 mm nominal sizes and 5 mm thick unless otherwise specified.. The tolerance shall be + 1.5 mm for length and breadth and + 0.5 mm for thickness. Specials like internal and external angle beads, covers, cornices, corner pieces etc. shall match. The top surface of the tiles shall be glazed with a gloss or matt unfading stable finish as desired by the Engineer. The tiles shall be true in shape and size. The colour shall be uniform and fractured section shall be fine grained in textures, dense and homogenous. The tiles shall be strong. and free from flaws like cracks, chips craze, spacks, crawlings etc. and other imperfections. The edges and the underside of the tiles shall be completely free from glaze and the underside shall have ribs or indentations for better anchorage with the fixing mortar. The coloured tiles, when supplied shall preferably come from one batch to avoid difference in colour. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page204 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 10.04.00 Mix - Underbed 10.04.01 The mix for the under bed shall consist of 1 part cement and 3 parts coarse sand by weight mixed with sufficient water or any other mix if specified. 10.05.00 Laying: Same as Clause 9.05.00. 10.06.00 Finishing 10.06.01 The joints shall be cleaned and flush pointed with white cement and cured for 7 days by keeping it wet. The surface shall be cleaned with soap or suitable detergent, washed fully and wiped with soft cloth to prevent scratching before handing over. PVC TILE FINISH (Rubberised) 11.00.00 11.01.00 This shall include various types of tiles manufactured from rubber, set with an adhesive on a concrete or masonry base. An underbed may be required to obtain a satisfactory surface and grade. 11.02.00 Thickness 11.02.01 The thickness of the tiles shall be 3mm unless otherwise specified. The thickness including underbed shall be 50 mm for floors and 30 mm for walls, unless otherwise specified. 11.03.00 Tiles 11.03.01 Unless otherwise required the tiles shall be square and of approved dimensions. The tolerance in dimensions shall be +/-1.5 mm. 11.03.02 The face of the tiles shall be free from porosity, blisters, cracks, embedded foreign matter or other physical defects which affect appearance or serviceability. All edges shall be cut true and square. The colour shall be non-fading and uniform in appearance, insoluble in water and resistant to alkalis, cleaning agents and all usual floor polishes. 11.04.00 11.04.01 Finishing If any adhesive marks are present on the surface a soft cloth soaked in solvent shall be used to wipe them off. The surface shall be cleaned with soft soap, dried and polished or sealed with an approved type of polish or sealant just before handling over. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 205 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 12.00.00 ACID RESISTANT TILE FINISH 12.01.00 This finish shall be composed of ceramic unglazed vitreous tiles of approved make and quality, with an underbed laid over a concrete or masonry base. The tile are laid with chemical resistant mortars. 12.02.00 Thickness 12.02.01 The total thickness shall be minimum 25 mm including the underbed. The tile finish on vertical surface shall project out 12 mm uniformly from the adjacent plaster or other wall finishes. The necessary cutting into surface receiving the finish, to accommodate the specified thickness shall be done. Tiles – Ceramic unglazed vitreous acid resistant shall generally conform to IS: 4457. 12.02.02 12.03.00 12.03.01 The tiles shall be of vitreous ware and shall be free from deleterious substances. The acid resistant shall be determined in accordance with appendix –F of IS: 4457. The size of tile shall be 150 mm x 150 mm or 200 mm x 200 mm nominal sizes and 12 mm thick unless otherwise specified.. The tolerance shall be +/- 2.5 % for length, breadth and thickness. Specials like internal and external angle beads, covers, cornices, corner pieces etc. shall match. The tiles shall be true in shape and size. The colour shall be uniform and fractured section shall be fine grained in textures, dense and homogenous. The tiles shall be strong. and free from flaws like cracks, chips craze, spacks, crawlings etc. and other imperfections. The edges and the underside of the tiles shall be completely free from glaze and the underside shall have ribs or indentations for better anchorage with the fixing mortar. The coloured tiles, when supplied shall preferably come from one batch to avoid difference in colour. 12.04.00 Mix – Underbed & Mortar 12.04.01 The mix for the under bed and joint filling mortar shall be also of chemical resistant type conforming to IS: 4441. 12.05.00 Laying: The laying shall be done by approved specialist agency as per recommendation of manufacturer. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page206 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 13.00.00 10000011 / HB / 11094 ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA The finish shall be checked specially for a) Level, slope, plumb as the case may be b) Pattern, and symmetry c) Alignment of joints, dividing strips etc. d) Colour, texture e) Surface finish f) Thickness of joints g) Details of edges, junction etc h) Performance i) Precautions specified for durability TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS FOR : SOLING & HARDCORE 1.00.00 GENERAL 1.01.00 The work covered under this specification includes all type of soling work either by rubble stones laid under floors / hard core under foundations, hand packed, complete as per under mentioned specification and applicable drawings. 2.00.00 RUBBLE STONE SOLING 2.01.00 The rubble stone shall be of best variety of black trap / granite / basalt or other approved variety of stone available locally. The stone shall be hard, durable, free from defects and of required size and shall be approved by the Engineer in-charge before incorporation in the work. 2.02.00 Preparation of Surface & laying: 2.02.01 The bed on which rubble soling is to be laid shall be cleared of all loose materials, levelled, watered and compacted and got approved by the Engineer In-charge before laying rubble soling. Cable or pipe trenches if shown in the drawing and as required by the Engineer in-charge shall be got done before the soling is started. 2.02.02 Over the prepared surface, the stone shall be set as closely as possible and well packed and firmly set. The stones shall be of full height and shall be laid so as to have their bases of the largest area resting on the sub-grade. Soling shall be laid in one layer of 230mm or 150mm or other specified thickness and no stones shall be less than 230mm or 150mm depth or specified thickness of soling with a tolerance of 25mm. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 207 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 2.02.03 After packing the stones properly in position, the interstices between them shall be carefully filled with quarry spoils of stone chips of larger size possible to obtain a hard, compact surface. Spreading of loose spoils or stone chips is prohibited. 2.02.04 The entire surface shall be examined for any protrusions and the same shall be knocked off by a hammer and all interstices shall be filled with approved murrum. Excess murrum if any over the surfaces shall be removed. Unless otherwise specified, the murrum shall be supplied by the contractor at his own cost from the selected areas. The surfaces shall then be watered and consolidated with mechanical or sufficiently heavy wooden tampers and log- rammers as approved by the Engineer in-charge to give the required slope or level and dense sub-base. After compaction, the surface shall present clean look. Adequate care shall be taken by the contractor while laving and compacting the rubble soling to see that concrete surfaces in contact with soling are not damaged. 3.00.00 HARD CORE FOR FOUNDATIONS 3.01.00 Where specifically mentioned in the drawings, hard core layer shall be provided as a preparatory surface to receive blinding concrete/ leveling course. 3.02.01.1 Hard core layer shall comprise of well graded broken stones 80mm nominal size with the following gradation: IS Sieve designation 80 mm 63 mm 40 mm 20 mm 10 mm % passing 100 85-100 0-30 0-5 0-5 3.03.00 The hard broken stones layer shall be directly placed over the compacted layer of under lying soil in layers. The stones shall be hand packed and crevices filled with broken stones. 3.04.00 Each layer shall be covered with clean river sand and thoroughly worked into the crevices with a water jet. Additional layers of sand shall be placed on top and worked into the void spaces. The process shall be repeated until no more sand and water get into the voids. earth rammer shall be used to compact each layer if directed by Consultant/Owner. 3.05.00 3.06.00 The thickness and area covered beyond the blinding concrete shall be as indicated in the drawings or as indicated by Consultant/Owner. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 208 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 TECHNICAL SPECS FOR DRAINAGE, SANITATION AND WATER SUPPLY 1.00.00 SCOPE This section covers the drains/Pipes for foul water, surface water and sewage together with all fittings and fixtures and inclusive of ancillary works, such as connections, manholes and inspection chambers used within the building and from the building to the connection to Owner’s main sewer line manholes stipulated here or elsewhere in these specifications The scope is also inclusive of design supply erection of all the tanks, pipes, fittings etc. required for the water supply to be taken from the terminal point to the respective buildings. 2.00.00 INSTALLATION 2.01.00 Surface Drainage The Contractor shall construct the entire drainage scheme as per the drawings. Necessary slopes shall be provided in longitudinal drain. 2.02.0 General All pipelines, locations of fittings and fixture etc. shall be as per approved drawings or as directed by the Consultant/Owner. Correctness of lines, plumb, orientation, symmetry and levels shall be strictly ensured. All items shall be fully secured against movement in any direction and so located as to allow maintenance where desired by the Consultant/Owner. All pipelines and fittings fixtures shall be installed leak proof. When the works under scope of this specification connect with others the connections shall be such as to prevent any splashing or emission of foul odour and gases. a) Polyethylene water Tank Tanks shall meet the requirements of IS: 12701. Virgin HDPE granules of approval grade, suitable for drinking water shall be used for making the tank. Carbon black shall be added with the granules. Tanks shall be single piece, seamless construction, moulded by rotational moulding. Shape of tank shall be cylindrical - vertical type with corrugation along the length and bottom of the Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 209 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 tank. Tank shall have closed top provided with lid. However, for storage inside, the rectangular loft tank of approved colour shall be provided. Tank shall be provided with all fittings for inlet, overflow, outlet pipes and ball valves including mosquito proof coupling. Tank shall be leak proof. Tank shall be installed with proper support and anchorage for installation and it shall be carried out according to the recommendation of clause No. 13 of IS: 12701-1989. 2.04.0 Rainwater Down Corners Rainwater down corners shall be standard Cast Iron Pipes conforming to IS: 1230. Rainwater down corners shall run along and be secured to wall, column etc. Where desired by the Consultant/Owner these may have to be installed in chases cut in the structure. All pipes shall be well secured and supported by adequately strong brackets. The brackets may be wrought iron davis type, split ring type or perforated strap iron type as approved by the Consultant/Owner. For vertical runs each pipe shall hang freely on its bracket fixed just below the socket. Suitable spacer shall be provided against the vertical surfaces to which the pipe is fixed. All bends and junctions shall be supplied with water tight cleanouts. All horizontal pipes shall have a minimum fall of 1 in 100. 2.06.00 Soil and Drainage Pipes 2.06.01 Gradients If not specified the minimum gradients of soil and drainage pipe line shall be as follows 100 mm nominal dia 1 in 35 150 mm nominal dia 1 in 65 230 mm nominal dia 1 in 120 300 mm nominal dia 1 in 200 2.06.02 Relation with Water Supply Pipeline Under no circumstances, unless specifically cleared by the Consultant/Owner in special cases, drainage and soil pipes shall be allowed to come close to water supply pipelines. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 210 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 2.06.03 Laying Each separate pipe shall be individually set for line, level, plumb etc. Where lengths of sewer or drain pipes are laid in trench, properly painted sight-rails shall be fixed across the trench at a height, equal to length of the boning rod to be used, above the required invert level of the drain or sewer at the point, where the sight is fixed. More sight rails shall be required at manholes, changes of gradient and intermediate positions if the distance of sighting is too far, which shall not be more than 15.0 m apart. The excavation shall be boned in at least once in every 1.8 m. The foot of the boning rod shall be set on a block of wood of the exact thickness of the wall of the pipe. Each pipe shall be separately and accurately boned between sight rails. 2.06.04 For water pipelines, meticulous care shall be taken to avoid chances of airlock and water hammer. The layout of pipe work shall be such that there is no possibility of backflow towards the source of supply from any cistern appliances whether by siphonage or otherwise. Where desired by the Consultant/Owner, pipes shall be concealed in masonry or concrete of the structure. Chases, openings, conduits as necessary shall be cut or left in the masonry or concrete. Clamps and fittings shall be as per the standard practice and approved by the Consultant/Owner. 2.06.05 Support and Protection to Pipelines All drainage and sewer pipes shall be laid with socket leading uphill. Preferably the pipes shall rest on solid and even foundations for the full length of the barrel. However, the pipe manufacturer’s instructions as approved by the Consultant/Owner shall be followed in the matter of support and jointing. Cast Iron pipes and concrete pipes may be supported on suitable concrete or brick support, where specified. The supports shall be unyielding and strong enough. At least one support shall be located close to each joint. Spacing of intermediate supports shall be as desired by Consultant/Owner. Pipes shall be secured to the supports by approved means. Anchoring of pipes where necessary shall be achieved by suitable concrete encasing designed for the expected thrust. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 211 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 2.06.06 10000011 / HB / 11094 Entry Into Structures For entry of the pipelines into any building or structures suitable conduits under the structures, or sleeves shall be used. The conduits and sleeves shall be such as to allow easy repair and replacement of the pipes. When openings or chases are required to be made in the structure for entry of pipelines, locations and sizes shall be marked and checked by the Consultant/Owner. After laying of the pipeline the openings and chases shall be mended. 2.06.07 Ducts Where solid, waste and ventilating pipes are accommodated in ducts, access to cleaning eyes shall be provided. Connection to drain shall be through a gully with sealed cover to guard against ingress of sewer gas, vermin or backflow. 2.06.08 Traps and Ventilating Pipes Pipes for carrying of the waste from water closets and waste water and overflow water from baths, wash basins, sinks to drains shall be trapped immediately beneath such fixtures. Traps shall have minimum water seal of 50 mm and shall be ventilated whenever such ventilation in necessary to maintain water seal of the trap. Ventilating pipes shall be carried up vertically from the drain to a height of at least 600 mm above the outer covering of the roof of the building or as shown on drawings. All vertical ventilating, antisyphonage and similar pipe shall be covered on top with a cowl. The cowl shall be made of C.I. 2.06.09 Manholes and Inspection Chambers The maximum distance between manholes shall be 30 metres unless specially permitted otherwise. In addition, at every change of alignment, gradient or diameter there shall be a manhole or inspection chamber. The distance between manhole or inspection chamber and gully chamber shall not exceed 6 metres unless desired otherwise. Manhole shall be constructed so as to be watertight under test. The benching at the sides shall be carried out in such a manner as to prevent lodgment for any splashing in case of accidental flashing of the chamber. The channel or drain at the bottom of chamber shall be plastered with 1:2 cement sand mortar and finished smooth to the grade. The channels and drains shall be shaped and laid to provide smooth flow. Connection to existing sewer lines shall be through a manhole. Manholes shall be provided with C.I. standard covers. The covers shall be close fitting so as to prevent gases from coming out. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 212 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 2.06.10 10000011 / HB / 11094 Jointing Jointing of laid pipes shall be so planned as to avoid completely any movement or strain to the joints already made. If any joint is suspected to be damaged it shall be opened out and redone. All joints between pipes, pipe fittings and manholes shall be gastight when above ground and watertight when underground. Method of jointing shall be as per instruction of the pipe and fittings manufacturer and as approved by the Consultant/Owner. However in the absence of any instruction available from the manufacturer, methods as detailed hereunder shall be used. a) Cast Iron Pipes Socket and spigot pipes shall be joined by cast lead joints. The spigot shall be centered in the socket of the next pipe by tightly caulking in sufficient turns of tarred gasket or hemp yarn to have unfilled half the depth of socket. When the gasket or hemp yarn has been caulked tightly, a jointing ring shall be placed round the barrel and tightened against the face of the socket to prevent airlock. Molten lead shall then be poured in to fill the remainder of the socket and caulked with suitable. tools right round the joint to make up for shrinkage of the molten metal on cooling and shall be finished 3 mm behind the socket face. In special cases if flanged joints are accepted by the Consultant/Owner, the joints shall be made leak proof by inserting approved type of rubber or other gasket not less than 1.5 mm thick. The bolts shall be secured in stages to avoid uneven strain. Damaged gasket shall be replaced. b) G.I. Pipes Threads shall be cut with sharp tools, and before jointing, all scales shall be removed from pipes by suitable means. The screw threads of the pipe shall be cleaned out and the joints made by screwing the fittings after treating the threads with approved pipe jointing compound. Once a joint has been screwed up it shall not be backed off unless the threads are re-cleaned and new compound applied. c) Glazed Stoneware Pipes Tarred gasket or hemp yarn soaked in thick cement slurry shall first be placed round the spigot of each pipe and the spigot Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 213 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 2.09.00 Installation All plumbing fittings and fixtures shall be installed in most workman like manner by skilled workers. Those shall be prefect in level, plumb, plane, locations and symmetry. All items shall be securely anchored to wall and floors. All cuttings in walls and floors shall be made good by the Contractor. 3.00.00 TESTING AND ACCEPTANCE 3.01.00 All pipes, fittings and fixtures shall be inspected, before delivery at the site to see whether they conform to accepted standards. The frequency of testing and sampling as given Table - I of this Section, The pipes shall again be inspected on site before laying by sounding to disclose cracks. All defective items shall be clearly marked and forthwith removed from the site. 3.02.00 Testing of Pipelines for Drainage & Sanitation Comprehensive test of all pipe lines shall be made by simulating conditions of use. The method of actual tests shall be decided by the Consultant/Owner. All test date shall be recorded and submitted to the Consultant/Owner for review and Instruction. The Consultant/Owner’s discretion regarding tolerance shall be final. General guidance for the test are given below :a) Smoke Test All soil pipes, waste pipes, vent pipes & all other pipes when above ground shall be approved gas tight by a smoke test conducted under a pressure of 25 mm of water and maintained for 15 minutes after all trap seals have been filled with water. The smoke is produced by burning oily waste or tar paper of similar material in the combustion chamber of a smoke machine. Chemical smoke is not allowed. b) For Straightness i) It shall be checked by inserting at the high end of the sewer or drain a smooth ball of a diameter 1.3 mm less than the pipe bore. In the absence of obstruction, such as yarn or mortar projecting through the joints, the ball will roll down the invert of the pipe and emerge at the lower end; and ii) By means of mirror at one end of the line and lamp at the other end. If the pipeline is straight, the full circle of light may be observed. The mirror will also indicate obstruction in the barrel if the pipeline is not straight. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page214 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 3.03.00 Testing of Water Mains after Laying After laying and jointing, the main shall be slowly and carefully charged with water, so that all air is expelled from the main, by providing 25 mm inlet with a stop-cock, allowed to stand full of water for a few days if time permits, and then tested under pressure. The test pressure shall be 5 Kg/sqcm. or double the maximum working pressure, whichever is greater. The pressure shall be applied by means of a manually operated test pump, or in the case of long mains or mains of a large diameter by a power driven test pump provided that the pump is not left unattended. In either case due precaution shall be taken to ensure that the required test pressure is not exceeded. Pressure gauges shall be accurate and shall preferably have been recalibrated before the test. The pump having been stopped, the test pressure shall maintain itself without measurable loss for at least five minutes. The end of the mains shall be closed by fitting a watertight expanding plug and plug shall be secured by struts to resist end thrust of the water pressure in the mains. 3.04.00 Testing of Service Pipes and Fittings The service pipes shall be slowly and carefully charged with water allowing all air to escape avoiding all shock or water hammer. 3.05.00 Fixture etc. All fixtures and fittings shall be connected by Water tight joints. No dripping shall be accepted. 4.00.0 IS CODES Some of the applicable Indian Standards, Codes are referred to here below: Latest editions shall always be referred. IS : 1172 Basic requirements for water supply, drainage and sanitation. IS 1200 (Part-XVI) Laying of water and sewer line including appurtenant items. (Part-XIX) Waters supply, plumbing and drains. IS 1239 (Pt. I & II) Mild Steel Tubes and Mild Steel Tubulars and other wrought Steel Pipe fittings. IS 3486 Cast Iron Spigot and Socket drain pipes IS : 3589 Electrically welded steel pipe for water, gas and sewage (200 mm to 2000 mm nominal diameter). IS : 1537 Vertically cast iron pressure pipe for water, gas and sewage. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 215 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 IS : 1742 Code of practice for building drainage. IS : 5329 Code of practice for sanitary pipe work above ground for building IS : 1538 Cast iron fittings for pressure pipes for water, gas and sewage. IS : 1230 Cast iron rainwater pipes and fittings. IS : 1729 Sand cast iron spigot and socket soil, waste and ventilating pipes, fittings and accessories. IS : 1626 Asbestos cement building pipes, gutters. IS : 2065 Code of practice for water supply in building. IS : 1726 Cast iron manhole covers and frames intended for use in drainage works. IS : 5961 Cast iron gratings for drainage purposes. IS : 5219 (Part - I) ‘P’ and ‘S” traps, cast copper alloy traps IS : 771 Glazed fire dry sanitary appliances IS : 772 General requirements of enameled cast iron sanitary appliances IS : 774 Flushing cistern for water closets and urinals (Valve less Siphonic type) IS : 775 Cast iron brackets and supports for wash basin and sinks. IS : 2548 Plastic water closet seats and covers. IS: 2527 Code of practice for fixing -‘rainwater gutters and downpipes for roof drainage. IS :1068 Chromium plating IS: 1073 Ball valves including floats for water supply purpose. Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 216 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 LIST OF RECOMMENDED MAKES/ MANUFACTURERS 1.00.00 GENERAL 1.01.00 The makes and manufacturers shall be preferably from the following list. In case the same is not available in the market or incase of change in trade name, equivalent makes/ re-designated manufacturer shall be used with the approval of Consultant/Owner. In case of items not covered in the list, the material shall be best available in the market and each item should have BIS certification mark. Description Manufacturers 1 TILES 7 i) Terrazzo and cement tiles M/s. NITCO; M/S. NEC; M/S. BHARAT M/s. NIMCO; M/S. G.K.BANSAL M/s. MAHAL ii) White glazed tiles M/s. H R Johnson; M/s. Parasuram Pottery works Ltd, M/s. Somani Pilkington , Kajaria, iii) PVC tiles M/s. Bhor, M/s. Premier Vinyl Flooring Ltd 2 METALLIC HARDENR FLOOR : M/s. Triveni Color Industries (Floornate) M/s. Heatly & Gresham (India) Ltd M/s. De-Rust Chemical Corporation of inida (Ferronite) M/s. Cement Research Corporation Pvt Ltd. (Stilonite) 3 WOODEN DOORS /BLOCK : BOARDS / PLYWOOD/PARTICLE BOARD M/s. Indian Plywood Mfg. Co. Ltd M/s. Kit Ply Industries Ltd; M/s. Nuboard M/s. Sitapur, M/s. Kutty Flush Doors M/s. Mysore Plywood Ltd; M/s. Gee Doors M/s. Shankar Ramachandra & Brothers, Pune M/s. Joinery Manufacturer; M/s Northern Doors M/s. Wood Designs, Bangalore M/s. Wood India, Calcutta; M/s Sejpal & Others M/s Pioneer Timber product, Chandigarh or equivalent approved manufacturer M/s. Sen Harvic; M/s AGEW; M/s Sentianal M/s. Hopes Metal; M/s. Multiwyn or equivalent approved manufacturer 4 STEEL DOORS & WINDOWS 5 ROLLING SHUTTERS M/s. SwastikRollling Shutters & Engg. Co. (P) Ltd M/s Hercules Rolling Shutters & Engg Works or equivalent approved manufacturer 6 ALUMINIUM DOORS, WINDOWS, WALL SPANS M/s. Ajit India; M/s. Alumilite; M/s. Indal; M/s. Jindal; M/s. Jupiter Windows GLASS : (Plain/Frosted, Bajra etc.) M/s Triveni: M/s Shree Vallabh: Garless, M/s Asahi Or equivalent approved manufacturer Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page217 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 8 HARDWARE FITTINGS & FIXTURES: 10. WATERSTOPS: (PVC/RUBBER) 11. EXPANSION JOINT AND TARFELT WATERPROOFING 12. INTEGRAL WATER: PROOFING COMPOUND CEMENT BASED: WATERPROOFING TREATMENT 13. 10000011 / HB / 11094 M/s Jayant Metal Manufacturing Co. M/s Shalimar Hardware. M/s Everite. M/s Garnish Traders: M/s Saifec Tube & hardware mart: M/s Tahil Sons: M/s Diamond Hardware; M/s Navbhara; M/s Zacfa; M/s Safe Enterprises; M/s Hardwyn Traders; M/s Godrej & Boyce mfg. Ltd. M/s Des Lock Industries; M/s Explorer Engineers (P) Ltd. or equivalent approved manufacturer. M/S Omai Plastics (P) Ltd. M/s Basecon; M/s Pask; M/s Asian Engg. Products; M/s RC Enterprises; M/s Capnhans India Ltd; M/s Fixopan Engrs. Pvt. Ltd. or equivalent approved manufacturer. M/s Shalitex; M/s Tiki Tar industries; M/s STP Ltd. (Ms Shalimar Tar Products); M/s Lloyd Insulation (I) Or equivalent approved manufacturer. Accoproof, Cico; Impermo Or equivalent approved manufacturer. M/s India Waterproofing Co.; M/s All India Waterproofing Co; M/s Likproof India Pvt. Ltd.; M/s Modern Waterproofing Co.; M/s Nina Industries. 14. PAINTS AND VARNISH 15. CEMENT BASED: M/s Snowcem India ltd. (Super Snowcem, WATER PRO OF PAINTS & RESIN SandtexMatt); BASED THERMO PLASTIC PAINTS M/s Nitco Paints Pvt. Ltd. (Nitcocent); M/s Hindustan Colour Chemical Industries; M/s Terraco (Terraccin & Terracoat); M/s Jayant Colour & Chemicals Industries; M/s Surfa Coat Pvt. Ltd. or equivalentapproved manufacturer. M/s Asian Paints; M/s Goodlas Nerolac; M/s Garware Paints Ltd.; M/s I.C.I. Paints; M/s BergerPaints; M/s Jenson Nicholson; Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 218 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 16. PRESSED STEEL DOOR: FRAMES 17 18 FALSE CEILING / PANELING DECORATIVE LAMINATES 19 PVC/ FRP DOORS 20 DOOR CLOSERS 21 SEALANTS 22 CONCRETE PAVER BLOCKS 23 SANITARY APPLIANCES 24 CP BRASS FITTINGS 10000011 / HB / 11094 M/s Sen Harvic; M/s Techome; M/s Nishan Solid door frames (Solidor); M/s Anjali Enterprises; M/s Sunbeam M/s Madhu Industries, Bangalore or equivalent approved manufacturer. Decolam, Formica & Rammica Rajashri plastic, Thermodeck Everite, GoleterEngineering, Amar, A.K.Industries, Hardiwyn, Vigvijay, Dewan Industries GE Silicon, Bostik Basant Belton, Adideep Interlock Pavers, PVt. Ltd., Pave Stone Marketting (P) Ltd., Designers Pavings & Tiles Pvt. Ltd., Bessers Concrete Paver Blocks. Parraware, Hindustan Jaquar MBM, GEM, Techno, Lalsons Neta, Plumber Signature & Seal of the Bidder Attachment 2 Page 219 of 219 Hindustan Petroleum Corporation Ltd. Mundra Delhi Pipeline, MDPL Operations H.O- Jaipur-302017 REFERENCE NO: 10000011 / HB / 11094 25 CP BRASS WASTE Jaquar, ESSO, COUPLING, BOTTLE GEM, Kingston, TRAPS 26 27 28 29 PVC flushing cisterns Mirror Plastic sheet and cover Stainless Sink Hindustan Pilkinton, Modigaurd, Asahi 38 Nirali, Dayana, AMC, etc. GI Pipes ITC, TATA, Jindal Zenith, Ambica GI Mallable fittings PEC, MJM. Bimal GM gate/ Globe Neta, valves Sant, NEW Ball Valves MBM, A-I (js), Techno CI water quality pipes CI soil quality pipes IISCO, Neco SW Pipes & Gulley Perfect, Kashmira, or approved equivalent traps RCC Hume Pipes Indian Hume Pipes,] Pranali Premier HDPE Pipes & fittings Prince, Gautam 39 40 41 42 CPVC pipes & fittings Modular floors CI manhole covers PVC storage tanks 43 CEMENT ACC, BIRLA PLUSGUJARAT AMBHUJA RAJASHREE, ZUARI, L&T (ULTRA TECH CEMENT) 44 REINFORCEMENT STEEL 45 ADMIXTURES SAIL, TATA STEEL, RINIL FOSROC, SIKA, ROFF, Krishna concem 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 Sintex, Century, Polycon Signature & Seal of the Bidder